UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
Form 20-F
¨ | Registration statement pursuant to Section 12(b) or 12(g) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 |
or
x | Annual report pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 |
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006
or
¨ | Transition report pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 |
For the transition period from/to
or
¨ | Shell company report pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 |
Date of event requiring this shell company report:
Commission file number 00012033
TELEFONAKTIEBOLAGET LM ERICSSON
(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)
LM ERICSSON TELEPHONE COMPANY
(Translation of Registrants Name Into English)
Kingdom of Sweden
(Jurisdiction of Incorporation or Organization)
SE-164 83 Stockholm, Sweden
(Address of Principal Executive Offices)
Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of Each Class | Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered | ||
American Depositary Shares | The NASDAQ Stock Market LLC | ||
B Shares | The NASDAQ Stock Market LLC | * |
* | Not for trading, but only in connection with the registration of the American Depositary Shares representing such B Shares pursuant to the requirements of the Securities and Exchange Commission. |
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:
None
Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act:
None
Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuers classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the Annual Report:
B shares (SEK 1.00 nominal value) |
14,823,478,760 | |
A shares (SEK 1.00 nominal value) |
1,308,779,918 | |
C shares (SEK 1.00 nominal value) |
0 |
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes x No ¨
If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Yes ¨ No x
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant: (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes x No ¨
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer. See definition of accelerated filer and large accelerated filer in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
x Large accelerated filer ¨ Accelerated filer ¨ Non-accelerated filer
Indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow. Item 17 x Item 18 ¨
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). Yes ¨ No x
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
ii | ||
Operational Review* |
||
21 | ||
23 | ||
25 | ||
42 | ||
44 | ||
48 | ||
126 | ||
133 | ||
149 | ||
150 | ||
156 | ||
158 | ||
160 | ||
Managements Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting |
186 | |
187 |
*) | In this chapter, we use a non-GAAP financial measure called cash flow before financial investing activities. We believe that cash flow before financial investing activities is a measure that provides relevant information for analysts, investors and other interested parties in the telecommunications industry. Accordingly, we have presented cash flow before financial investing activities to enhance the readers understanding of our performance in 2006, 2005 and 2004. Cash flow before financial investing activities is defined as cash flow from operating activities less cash used to acquire intangible assets and property, plant and equipment. However, our definition of cash flow before financial investing activities may not be directly comparable to other similarly titled measures used by companies. |
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
FORM 20-F 2006 CROSS REFERENCE TABLE
Our Annual Report on Form 20-F consists of the Swedish Annual Report for 2006, with certain adjustments to comply with U.S. requirements, together with certain other information required by Form 20-F which is set forth under the heading Supplemental Information. The following cross reference table indicates where information required by Form 20-F may be found in this document.
Form 20-F Item Heading |
Location in this document |
Page Number | ||||||
PART I |
||||||||
1 |
Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisors |
Not applicable |
||||||
2 |
Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable |
Not applicable |
||||||
3 |
Key Information |
|||||||
A |
Selected Financial Data |
Three-Year Summary |
23 | |||||
Supplemental Information |
||||||||
Exchange Rates |
187 | |||||||
Five-Year Summary |
198 | |||||||
B |
Capitalization and Indebtedness |
Not applicable |
||||||
C |
Reason for the Offer and Use of Proceeds |
Not applicable |
||||||
D |
Risk Factors |
Risk Factors |
126 | |||||
4 |
Information on the Company |
|||||||
A |
History and Development of the Company |
Board of Directors Report |
||||||
Summary |
25 | |||||||
Acquisitions and Divestitures |
102 | |||||||
Capital Expenditures |
31 | |||||||
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements |
||||||||
Note C26 Business Combinations |
102 | |||||||
Note C32 Events After the Balance Sheet Date |
117 | |||||||
Information on the Company |
||||||||
General Facts on the Company |
133 | |||||||
History and Development |
134 | |||||||
B |
Business Overview |
Information on the Company |
133 | |||||
C |
Organizational Structure |
Information on the Company |
||||||
Organization |
137 | |||||||
Supplemental Information |
||||||||
Investments |
199 | |||||||
D |
Property, Plant and Equipment |
Information on the Company |
||||||
Manufacturing and Assembly |
147 | |||||||
4A |
Unresolved staff comment |
Not applicable |
||||||
5 |
Operating and Financial Review and Prospects |
|||||||
A |
Operating Results |
Board of Directors Report |
||||||
Goals, Strategy and Financial Results |
27 |
ii
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Form 20-F Item Heading |
Location in this document |
Page Number | ||||||
A |
Operating Results Contd |
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements |
||||||
Note C20 Financial Risk Management and Financial Instruments |
93 | |||||||
Supplemental Information | ||||||||
Operating Results |
187 | |||||||
B |
Liquidity and Capital Resources |
Board of Directors Report |
||||||
Balance Sheet and Cash Flow |
30 | |||||||
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements |
||||||||
Note C19 Interest-Bearing Liabilities |
92 | |||||||
Note C20 Financial Risk Management and Financial Instruments |
93 | |||||||
Note C25 Statement of Cash Flows |
101 | |||||||
C |
Research and Development, Patents and Licenses |
Board of Directors Report |
||||||
Research and Development |
32 | |||||||
Information on the Company |
||||||||
Research and Development |
142 | |||||||
Intellectual Property and Licensing |
143 | |||||||
D |
Trend Information |
Board of Directors Report |
||||||
Market Environment and Trend information |
26 | |||||||
Goals, Strategy and Financial Results |
27 | |||||||
E |
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements |
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements |
||||||
Note C20 Financial Risk Management and Financial Instruments |
93 | |||||||
F |
Tabular Disclosure of Contractual Obligations |
Board of Directors Report |
||||||
Material Contracts and Contractual Obligations |
33 | |||||||
6 |
Directors, Senior Management and Employees |
|||||||
A |
Directors and Senior Management |
Corporate Governance Report 2006 |
||||||
Members of the Board of Directors |
171 | |||||||
Company Management |
175 | |||||||
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements |
||||||||
Note C32 Events after the Balance Sheet Date |
117 | |||||||
B |
Compensation |
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements |
||||||
Note C29 Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management |
105 |
iii
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Form 20-F Item Heading |
Location in this document |
Page Number | ||||||
C |
Board Practices |
Corporate Governance Report 2006 |
||||||
Board of Directors |
164 | |||||||
Members of the Board of Directors |
171 | |||||||
Company Management |
175 | |||||||
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements |
||||||||
Note C29 Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management |
105 | |||||||
Note C32 Events after the Balance Sheet Date |
117 | |||||||
D |
Employees |
Board of Directors Report |
||||||
Employees |
38 | |||||||
Information on the Company |
||||||||
Human Resources |
146 | |||||||
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements |
||||||||
Note C29 Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management |
105 | |||||||
E |
Share Ownership |
Share Information |
||||||
Shareholders |
153 | |||||||
Corporate Governance Report 2006 |
||||||||
Members of the Board |
171 | |||||||
Company Management |
175 | |||||||
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements |
||||||||
Note C29 Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management |
105 | |||||||
7 |
Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions |
|||||||
A |
Major Shareholders |
Share Information |
||||||
Shareholders |
153 | |||||||
B |
Related Party Transactions |
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements |
||||||
Note C30 Related Party Transactions |
115 | |||||||
C |
Interests of Experts and Counsel |
Not applicable |
||||||
8 | Financial Information | |||||||
A | Consolidated Statements and Other | Consolidated Financial Statements | 42 | |||||
Financial Information | Please see also Item 17 cross references |
|||||||
Board of Directors Report | ||||||||
Legal and Tax Proceedings |
38 | |||||||
Supplemental Information | ||||||||
Dividends |
190 |
iv
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Form 20-F Item Heading |
Location in this document |
Page Number | ||||||
B | Significant Changes | Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements |
||||||
Note C32 Events after the Balance Sheet Date |
117 | |||||||
9 | The Offer and Listing | |||||||
A | Offer and Listing Details | Share Information | ||||||
Offer and Listing Details |
151 | |||||||
B | Plan of Distribution | Not applicable | ||||||
C | Markets | Share Information | ||||||
Stock Exchange Trading |
150 | |||||||
D | Selling Shareholders | Not applicable | ||||||
E | Dilution | Not applicable | ||||||
F | Expenses of the Issue | Not applicable | ||||||
10 | Additional Information | |||||||
A | Share Capital | Not applicable | ||||||
B | Memorandum and Articles of Association | Supplemental Information | ||||||
Memorandum and Articles of Association |
189 | |||||||
C | Material Contracts | Board of Directors Report | ||||||
Material Contracts and Contractual Obligations |
33 | |||||||
Acquisitions and Divestitures |
32 | |||||||
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements |
||||||||
Note C32 Events After the Balance Sheet Date |
117 | |||||||
D | Exchange Controls | Supplemental Information | ||||||
Exchange Controls |
193 | |||||||
E | Taxation | Supplemental Information | ||||||
Taxation |
194 | |||||||
F | Dividends and Paying Agents | Not applicable | ||||||
G | Statement by Experts | Not applicable | ||||||
H | Documents on Display | Information on the Company | ||||||
Documents on Display |
134 | |||||||
I | Subsidiary Information | Not applicable | ||||||
11 | Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures |
Board of Directors Report | ||||||
About Market Risks | Risk Management |
35 | ||||||
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements |
||||||||
Note C20 Financial Risk Management and Financial Instruments |
93 | |||||||
12 | Description of Securities Other than Equity Securities |
Not applicable |
v
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Form 20-F Item Heading |
Location in this document |
Page Number | ||||||
PART II | ||||||||
13 | Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies |
Not applicable | ||||||
14 | Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds |
Not applicable | ||||||
15 | Controls and Procedures | |||||||
A | Disclosure Controls and Procedures | Corporate Governance Report 2006 |
||||||
Disclosure Controls and Procedures |
181 | |||||||
B | Managements annual report on internal control over financial reporting | Managements Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting |
186 | |||||
C | Attestation report of the registered public accounting firm | Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm | 42 | |||||
D | Changes in internal control over financial reporting not applicable | Corporate Governance Report 2006 Disclosure Controls and Procedures |
181 | |||||
16 |
Reserved |
|||||||
A |
Audit Committee Financial Expert |
Corporate Governance Report 2006 | ||||||
The Audit Committee |
168 | |||||||
B |
Code of Ethics |
Corporate Governance Report 2006 | ||||||
High Standards in Business Ethics |
160 | |||||||
C |
Principal Accountant Fees and Services |
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements |
||||||
Note C31 Fees to Auditors |
117 | |||||||
Corporate Governance Report 2006 | ||||||||
Audit Committee Pre-Approval Policies and Procedures |
180 | |||||||
D |
Exemptions from the Listing Standards for Audit Committees |
Corporate Governance Report 2006 | ||||||
Independence Requirements of the Board |
182 | |||||||
E |
Purchase of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers |
Not applicable | ||||||
PART III |
||||||||
17 |
Financial Statements |
Consolidated Income Statement | 44 | |||||
Consolidated Balance Sheet | 45 | |||||||
Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows | 46 | |||||||
Consolidated Statement of Recognized | ||||||||
Income and Expense | 47 | |||||||
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements |
48 | |||||||
18 |
Financial Statements |
Not applicable | ||||||
19 |
Exhibits |
|||||||
Exhibit 1 |
Articles of Association, incorporated by reference to our Form 6-K dated May 16, 2006. |
|||||||
Exhibit 2 |
Not applicable | |||||||
Exhibit 3 |
Not applicable |
vi
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Form 20-F Item Heading |
Location in this document |
Page Number | ||||||
Exhibit 4.1 |
Memorandum of Agreement, dated 25 October 2005, Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson and Marconi Corporation plc incorporated by reference to our Form 20-F dated May 18, 2006 |
|||||||
Exhibit 4.2 |
Agreement and Plan of Merger Between Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (Publ), Maxwell Acquisition Corporation and Redback Networks Inc. Dated as of December 19, 2006 |
|||||||
Exhibit 5 |
Not applicable | |||||||
Exhibit 6 |
Please see Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements, Note C1 Significant Accounting Policies |
48 | ||||||
Exhibit 7 |
For definitions of certain ratios used in this report, please see Three-Year Summary |
23 | ||||||
Exhibit 8 |
Please see Supplemental Information, Investments |
199 | ||||||
Exhibit 9 |
Not applicable | |||||||
Exhibit 10 |
Not applicable | |||||||
Exhibit 11 |
Our Code of Business Ethics and Conduct is included on our web site at http://www.ericsson.com/about/code_business_ethics/index.shtml |
|||||||
Exhibit 12 |
302 Certifications | |||||||
Exhibit 13 |
906 Certifications | |||||||
Exhibit 14 |
Not applicable | |||||||
Exhibit 15.1 |
Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm |
vii
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS
SEK million |
2006 | Change from 2005 |
20051) | 20042) | ||||||||
Net sales |
177,783 | 17.1 | % | 151,821 | 131,972 | |||||||
Operating income |
35,828 | 8.3 | % | 33,084 | 26,706 | |||||||
Operating margin |
20.2 | % | 21.8 | % | 20.2 | % | ||||||
Net income |
26,436 | 8.1 | % | 24,460 | 17,836 | |||||||
Earnings per share, diluted, SEK |
1.65 | 7.8 | % | 1.53 | 1.11 | |||||||
Cash dividends per share, SEK |
0.50 | 11.1 | % | 0.45 | 0.25 | |||||||
YEAR-END POSITION |
||||||||||||
Total assets |
214,940 | 2.7 | % | 209,336 | 186,186 | |||||||
Working capital |
82,926 | -3.8 | % | 86,184 | 69,268 | |||||||
Capital employed |
142,447 | 6.8 | % | 133,332 | 115,144 | |||||||
Stockholders equity |
120,113 | 18.2 | % | 101,622 | 80,445 | |||||||
Interest-bearing liabilities and post-employment benefits |
21,552 | -30.2 | % | 30,860 | 33,643 | |||||||
Net cash |
40,728 | -19.6 | % | 50,645 | 42,911 | |||||||
RATIOS |
||||||||||||
Return on equity |
23.7 | % | 26.7 | % | 24.2 | % | ||||||
Return on capital employed |
27.4 | % | 28.7 | % | 26.4 | % | ||||||
Equity ratio |
56.2 | % | 49.0 | % | 43.8 | % | ||||||
Capital turnover, times |
1.3 | 1.2 | 1.2 | |||||||||
Inventory turnover, times |
5.1 | 5.0 | 5.7 | |||||||||
Accounts receivable turnover, times |
3.9 | 4.1 | 4.1 | |||||||||
STATISTICAL DATA, YEAR-END |
||||||||||||
Number of employees |
||||||||||||
Worldwide |
63,781 | 13.8 | % | 56,055 | 50,534 | |||||||
Of which in Sweden |
19,094 | -9.8 | % | 21,178 | 21,296 | |||||||
Export sales from Sweden, SEK million |
98,694 | 5.1 | % | 93,879 | 86,510 |
1) | Ericsson has adopted the new option in IAS 19 as from January 1, 2006. 2005 has been restated accordingly. |
2) | 2004 has been restated in accordance with IFRS, using the optional exemptions in IAS 39. Selected financial data for 2003 and 2002 have been omitted because such information cannot be restated in accordance with IFRS without unreasonable effort and expense. |
NET SALES:
Good growth, mainly driven by mobile networks, professional services and acquired Marconi sales.
OPERATING MARGIN:
Best-in-class operating margin reflects scale advantage and operational excellence.
NET INCOME:
SEK 26.4 billion is the highest in Ericssons history.
1
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
CASH DIVIDENDS:
SEK 0.50 proposal is double the level paid for 2004.
NET CASH:
Strategic acquisition of Marconi assets reduces net cash.
2
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
THIS IS ERICSSON
Founded in 1876, Ericsson is a leading provider of communications networks, related services and handset technology platforms. Through our Sony Ericsson joint venture, we are also a major provider of handsets. Our experience building networks in more than 175 countries gives us unique customer and consumer insights, and our extensive portfolio of telecommunication solutions and intellectual property offer a true business advantage. We are committed to working with our customers and partners to expand the borders of telecommunications for the benefit of people everywhere.
OUR VISION
Our vision is to be the prime driver in an all-communicating world.
This means a world in which all people can use voice, data, images and video to share ideas and information whenever and wherever they want.
WHY INVEST IN ERICSSON?
Global leader
We are a leading supplier of systems and services to most of the worlds largest mobile and fixed network operators. Ericsson has a long history of innovation and an industry-leading R&D program that focuses on being first to market with new solutions based on open standards.
Solid financial performance
2006 is the third consecutive year in which Ericsson has reported good sales growth and best-in-class operating margin. Cash flow before financial investing activities was SEK -2.6 billion. Excluding major acquisitions/divestitures, we generated however a healthy cash flow from operations of SEK 12.2 billion. The dividend has increased over each of the past two years and the Board has proposed a further 11 percent increase for 2006.
Long-term growth
We are gaining market share in mobile and fixed networks as well as in services. Our professional services business is experiencing particularly strong growth and generating a return on capital employed well above the group average. Moreover, we anticipate that our Sony Ericsson joint venture, our industry-leading patent portfolio and our newly-formed multimedia business unit will increasingly contribute favorably to our overall financial performance.
KEY ACHIEVEMENTS 2006
We were awarded contracts to build mobile networks in many areas of Asia, Africa and the Middle East, bringing telecoms to millions of people for the first time.
Fixed-line operators, including T-Com and Telefonica, increasingly selected our broadband access and optical transmission solutions.
We won 23 new IMS (IP Multimedia Subsystem) contracts for fixed and mobile networks and led the industry forward by putting six new IMS networks into commercial operation.
We deployed our one millionth microwave MINI-LINK used to transport traffic in mobile and fixed networks.
3
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
We exceeded our goal to reduce R&D lead times by an additional 20 percent during the year.
Our 3G (WCDMA/HSPA) solution was selected by leading operators around the world including eMobile and Softbank (Japan), AT&T and T-Mobile (US) and Telstra (Australia).
We extended our lead in services, now supporting networks with one billion subscribers.
Vodafone Group named us Supplier of the Year and designated us as a preferred IMS supplier.
Our solution for fixed broadband access (VDSL2) was named Best Access Technology at Broadband World Forum 2006.
Our acquisition and successful integration of Marconi further strengthened our ability to deliver end-to-end solutions.
4
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
TO MY FELLOW SHAREHOLDERS,
2006 was a year of great change, enabling us to capture current opportunities and open the door to new ones. Our 17 percent sales growth outpaced the industry and extended our leading position in systems and services.
Change Creates Opportunities
Our market leadership and scale advantage have stimulated increased merger activity among our main competitors. We believe that this is a positive development, as over the long term this will create fewer but stronger competitors and a healthier market. Our customers needs are also changing as they move toward all-IP networks and high-speed broadband. Our recent reorganization and the acquisitions of Marconi in 2006 and Redback Networks in 2007 have put us in a stronger position than ever to address the evolving needs of the worlds leading operators. Our ability to lead the telecommunications industry through times of change is one of our greatest strengths and has made Ericsson a driving force behind the industrys evolution for the past 130 years.
The world of communications is driven by consumers desire for mobility and broadband. Today, there are more than 2.7 billion mobile subscriptions in the world, and in a few years this figure is expected to pass four billion, fueled by high-growth markets. As most of these markets have limited fixed-line networks, the mobile networks will be the way for many new subscribers to access the Internet for the first time.
We rolled out almost one half, and the vast majority in terms of users, of all HSPA mobile broadband networks that were put into commercial service during 2006, enabling our customers to launch a new generation of mobile data services. The combination of rapid subscriber growth, increased usage, and new applications, such as Internet surfing, music downloads and mobile TV, will require ongoing operator investments to improve network coverage, capacity and functionality.
The Prime Driver in an All-Communicating World
By supporting operators to expand their mobile and fixed networks to reach a broader population, we are helping to improve quality of life, spur socio-economic development, and foster mutual understanding. By evolving and improving the networks, and bringing new multimedia services to market, we are also creating a world in which all people can have access to information, entertainment, social communities and more, whenever and wherever they want. At the same time, our Sony Ericsson joint venture is introducing feature-rich and attractive mobile handsets to facilitate simple use of these services.
Striving for Operational Excellence
These achievements would not have been possible without our focus on operational excellence. By identifying best practices in key dimensions of our operations and striving to work smarter and gain a better understanding of customer needs, we have fostered an environment dedicated to serving our customers better than anybody else. Ericsson is a company of outstanding talent. I take pride in our employees and the work that we do around the world. As we close the book on 2006 and enter 2007, I am excited about the prospects for telecommunications and the significance our industry plays in global development. Supplying the technology and services that enrich the everyday lives of billions of people around the world what a fantastic company to work for!
Carl-Henric Svanberg
President & CEO
5
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
OUR BUSINESS FOCUS 2006
1. REACHING MORE PEOPLE
Ericsson brought telecommunications to more people in more parts of the world than ever before, deploying rural networks and boosting capacity in many high-growth markets. The number of global subscriptions grew by a record 500 million, ending the year at 2.7 billion. Our cost-efficient and scalable solutions require fewer radio sites while maintaining high-quality network performance. In this way, we help our customers to reduce their operating costs, enabling them to expand coverage to reach more users in new geographic areas.
2. INCREASING SPEED AND CAPACITY
Our fixed and mobile broadband solutions dramatically improve network speed and capacity. Network evolutions are enhancing quality of service and enabling operators to launch new data services for their subscribers. On the mobile side of the business, we have supplied 46 of the 96 3G/HSPA (high-speed packet access) networks launched to date. On the fixed side, we delivered IP-DSL networks to more than 100 customers around the world during 2006, putting Ericsson among the global leaders in broadband access.
3. PREPARING FOR THE FUTURE
With the introduction of broadband access, subscribers can enjoy a wide variety of multimedia applications. To accommodate this traffic, however, many operators will have to overhaul their core networks as well. During 2006, Ericsson took the lead in supporting operators to prepare their networks for an all-IP environment by deploying softswitch, IMS, and optical and microwave transport solutions. We also worked with partners via Ericsson Mobility World to bring new multimedia content to the mobile environment.
4. EXPANDING OUR ROLE
By providing operators with innovative offerings and reducing their cost of operations, we support our operators in evolving their businesses. We are taking increased responsibility as a prime integrator and managed services partner for our customers. Our 24,000 service professionals in more than 140 countries provide local competence and global expertise in consulting, network rollout, systems integration, managed services, education and support. In 2006, we provided 24-hour network support for one billion subscribers.
Opportunities in a converging world
Many of the worlds leading operators are beginning to converge their mobile and fixed networks into one. For consumers this means a richer experience with easier access to a wide range of content and applications. For operators it means reduced costs and shorter time to market with new services. This, in turn, creates new opportunities for suppliers, like Ericsson, with both mobile and fixed expertise.
During 2006, we complemented our established leadership in mobility by strengthening our fixed-line portfolio. Our technology leadership, global presence, consumer understanding and extensive experience in integrating and managing networks make Ericsson an attractive partner for operators seeking support to reliably and cost-effectively evolve their networks to accommodate multiple technologies.
Same services on all devices
IP Multimedia Subsystem (IMS) is the key that enables subscribers to access the same content and services from a multitude of devices. We are the worlds leading supplier of IMS with 34 contracts for commercial launch and more than 70 trials.
6
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
An impressive customer base
We serve a broad base of more than 600 customers in over 175 countries, including the largest mobile operators in Europe, North America, Latin America, Asia, Middle East and Africa. The worlds ten largest operators are all our customers and together represent almost 50 percent of all mobile subscriptions worldwide.
Diversity Reduces Risk
The diversity of our customer base and the broad appeal of our offerings are reflected in the fact that, during 2006, no single customer accounted for more than 7 percent of Group sales. Our sales were also evenly divided between emerging and developed markets.
Winning New Business
We continued to expand our addressable market and gain market share, with 48 new and expanded agreements for supply of network equipment and/or services during the year. Recent acquisitions will enable us to expand our offerings even further, enhancing our ability to attract new customers and to deliver increased value to the many we already serve.
7
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
THE ERICSSON ADVANTAGE
1. DEDICATION TO LONG-TERM CUSTOMER RELATIONSHIPS
We have been present in most of our markets for more than 100 years, building strong, long-term relationships with the worlds leading operators. Our significant scale advantage, end-to-end offerings and a local presence in every major market enable us to serve as a true partner for cost-effective delivery of solutions and support to a diverse base of customers. As operators are increasingly reducing the number of different suppliers they rely on, the responsiveness of our employees and the power of our portfolio of products and services that have built a trust over many decades, will be key to our future success.
2. COMMITMENT TO TECHNOLOGY LEADERSHIP
Ericsson has earned a reputation for innovation and technology leadership by developing open standards and bringing reliable, cost-effective network solutions to market. Our early involvement in creating new technologies often enables us to be first to market with new solutionsa distinct competitive advantage for operators that choose us as their primary supplier. Our extensive portfolio of approximately 22,000 patents covers a variety of fixed and mobile technologies, including GSM and WCDMAthe technologies that connect more than 80 percent of the worlds mobile subscribers.
3. PASSION FOR OPERATIONAL EXCELLENCE
Our mission to take our customers forward in the best possible way requires simple, efficient and effective processes that consistently yield high-quality products and services with low cost of ownership. This, combined with our core values of professionalism, respect and perserverance, are key to our ways of working. During the past three years, our emphasis on operational excellence has enabled us to increase sales without increasing operating expenses at the same rate. Furthermore, we reduced R&D lead times in 2006 by more than 20 percent. As a result, we can bring products to market faster than ever at a lower R&D cost.
8
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
OUR PRODUCTS AND SERVICES
SEGMENT SYSTEMS: MOBILE AND FIXED NETWORKS
Mobile access
Ericsson is the global leader in the area of 2G (GSM) and 3G (WCDMA/HSPA) mobile networks. By deploying our scalable Ericsson Expander solutions in new coverage areas, operators can profitably serve low-spending users as the total cost of ownership is at least 30 percent lower. More than 40 percent of the operators who have begun rolling out mobile broadband technology have chosen Ericssons WCDMA/HSPA radio network. This evolution from GSM to HSPA means that tasks which once took minutes to accomplish in the mobile network (e.g. downloading a song) will now take seconds. GSM and WCDMA/HSPA share a common core network, meaning that previous investments are preserved as operators transition from voice-centric to multimedia networks.
We are now actively involved in the development of standards for the Long-Term Evolution (LTE) of 3G which will further enhance the consumer experience.
Fixed broadband access
The acquisition of Marconi strengthened our IP-DSL offering for fiber- and copper-based broadband access networks. The expansion of our fixed broadband offering has been an important step in reinforcing our ability to address network operators as they begin integrating their fixed and mobile networks.
IP core network (switching, routing, control and transport)
The evolution to Internet Protocol (IP) starts in the core. Our core network solutions include industry-leading softswitch, IP infrastructure, IMS, media gateways and microwave and optical transport solutions to provide cost-effective management of voice and data traffic. Our acquisition of Redback Networks will further strengthen our IP product portfolio.
Multimedia services and applications
A broadband network with an IP core provides operators with almost everything they need to begin offering multimedia services. The last pieces of the puzzle are multimedia applications and devices to attract subscribers, increase usage and generate revenues.
While multimedia applications and content have flourished in the world of fixed communications, operators are just now beginning to launch attractive features for the mobile subscriber. Our ability to understand the needs of consumers and enterprises, and our relationships with content and application partners enable us to deliver such solutions and drive the future of mobile multimedia.
Working end-to-end
Sony Ericssons cutting-edge multimedia handsets and our handset technology platforms and global services team complete our end-to-end proposition. By ensuring that all elements of the communication chainthe phone, the access and core networks, the applications and the serviceswork together, we provide a powerful offering for our customers.
9
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
10
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
SERVICES
By outsourcing certain activities to Ericsson, operators can focus on their core business of attracting, serving and retaining customers. We realized the strategic importance of services early on, and by the end of the 1990s we were the first supplier to form a services business unit. Today, our services organization leads the industry with 24,000 professionals in 140 countries. We use our experience, skills and scale to support customers in growing their business.
Professional services
Managed services
We provide high-quality operations of fixed and mobile networks at a predictable cost. In addition, as a leading provider of hosting solutions, we enable operators to launch multimedia services in a simple, fast and cost-effective manner. We are the industry leader in managed services, managing networks with more than 100 million subscribers.
Systems integration
Operators can minimize risk by engaging Ericsson to integrate equipment from multiple suppliers and handle technology change programs, as well as to design and integrate new solutions. More and more operators who face challenging technology transformations or introductions of multimedia services are asking us to serve as a prime integrator.
Consulting and education
As technologies and business models become more complex in the evolution towards broadband and all-IP, our customers rely on our consultants to support them in selecting technologies, identifying multimedia services for growth and developing the competence of their employees.
Customer support
Having experienced professionals available around-the-clock to provide customer support is a crucial part of our service offering. Giving advice on how to maximize efficiency in day-to-day operations ensures network uptime and lowers total cost.
Network rollout
Our ability to effectively roll out networks generates significant revenues. In 2006, we raised the bar on network rollout efficiency, launching the worlds geographically largest national HSPA network for Telstra (Australia) in only ten months.
11
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
12
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
SEGMENT OTHER OPERATIONS
Ericsson provides several other important and complementary technical solutions.
The units included in Other Operations are small but strategically important.
Ericsson Mobile Platforms is a leading supplier of technology platforms (GSM/GPRS, EDGE and WCDMA/HSPA) for mobile handsets and PC cards. During 2006, more than 17 million 3G/WCDMA handsets were based on our technology. We currently license these platforms to 19 handset providers, enabling them to launch new products faster, with lower technology risks.
Ericsson Network Technologies (Cables) is a leading provider of copper and fiber cables for telecommunications and power networks.
Ericsson Enterprise provides communications systems and services that enable businesses, public entities and educational institutions to have seamless access to applications and services across multiple locations.
Ericsson Power Modules is a leading supplier of DC/DC power converters and regulators, mainly to the communications industry.
Ericsson Microwave Systems was sold to Saab AB in September 2006.
13
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
A RECORD YEAR FOR SONY ERICSSON
Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications is a 50/50 joint venture, combining Ericssons technology leadership with Sonys consumer electronics expertise to create a powerful partnership that brings innovative products to market and provides us with a valuable link to the consumer.
A record year
In 2006, Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications celebrated their 5th anniversary by delivering record-breaking results. Sony Ericsson reported 46 percent unit growth, 51 percent sales growth and profits that more than doubled. The joint ventures success is partly attributable to its broadened portfolio, including the introduction of the 3.2 mega pixel Cyber-shotTM imaging phone and a wide range of Walkman® music phones.
A complete product portfolio
While Sony Ericssons multimedia Cyber-shot and Walkman® line-up captured most of the headlines, the joint venture shipped more than 75 different phones in all during the year, including a wide variety of models in the mid- and entry-level segments. Over recent years, Sony Ericsson has developed into a full portfolio player and this is reflected in their market share gain during 2006.
3G phones
Some of Sony Ericssons best selling WCDMA phones during 2006 were the K800, K610 and W850. The success of these feature-rich and attractively designed 3G models has enabled Sony Ericsson to capture a market share in 3G that is almost double its position in the overall market. This is promising for the future as 3G phones are expected to represent a much larger share of the market in the years ahead.
Gaining share in a growing market
Sony Ericssons ability to differentiate itself with attractive, feature-rich phones has enabled the joint venture to enter 2007 with strong momentum. The popularity of Sony Ericssons high-end models has generated brand awareness across the portfolio, encouraging more users in all categories to choose Sony Ericsson as their brand of choice. With more than 980 million handsets sold industry wide in 2006 and the market expected to break the one billion mark in 2007, Sony Ericsson is well positioned to capitalize on continued market growth.
Cyber-shot is a trademark of Sony Corporation
WALKMAN® is a registered trademark of Sony Corporation
14
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
15
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
AN ALL-COMMUNICATING WORLD
MORE PEOPLE COMMUNICATING IN MORE WAYS
Communication for all
Following the record growth in new mobile subscriptions during 2006, we expect that the total number of mobile subscriptions will surpass three billion already in 2007. This rapid growth is possible thanks to the introduction of cost-effective solutions, such as Ericsson Expander. This far-reaching and scalable radio base station enables operators to profitably launch networks in sparsely populated or developing areas that typically generate ARPU (average revenue per user) well below USD 10. We also offer solutions that enable operators to enhance capacity without having to add new radio base stations. Apart from being a case for good business, these solutions enhance quality of life by helping to eliminate the impact of distance and to establish the foundation for more advanced data services.
Taking broadband mobile
During the past ten years, the Internet has revolutionized the world, connecting more than a billion homes and offices into one massive global network. In the early 1990s, analog modems and narrowband dial-up connections made surfing the web and downloading content possible but often frustrating due to slow response times over these connections. Then came digital subscriber lines and broadband!
Fixed broadband is today expanding its reach throughout the world, and as it does, an exciting thing has happened broadband has broken away from the home and office and is going mobile! In 2006, the number of 3G/WCDMA subscriptions nearly doubled to approximately 100 million globally.
We anticipate that this figure will grow significantly over the next five years. The traffic increase in fixed broadband networks will be greater still.
Multimedia
Thanks to HSPA and the transformation to all-IP networks, the mobile broadband genie is out of the bottle and there is no end to what it can do: high-speed downloads of music, photos, streaming television and other multimedia applications. Operators are making great strides in this area as they seek to introduce attractive offerings and generate increased revenues in a very competitive marketplace. In 2006, the multimedia market was estimated to be approximately USD 25 billion and is expected to exceed USD 100 billion by 2011.
Our end-to-end approach includes our Consumer and Enterprise Lab, through which we conduct more than 20,000 face-to-face interviews annually, providing valuable insights for ourselves and our customers. It also includes our access to unique content through the more than 250,000 developers linked to Ericsson Mobility World. These assets combined with our network and handset technology expertise and our charging, messaging and provisioning solutions put us in a very strong position to support operators in launching the new services needed to capture the multimedia opportunity.
16
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
LEADING, CHANGING, GROWING
Ericsson has led the evolution of telecommunications. From the introduction of fixed-line networks in the late 1800s to fixed and mobile broadband today, we have built an unparalleled track record that is a result of our ability to predict, respond to and capitalize on change.
As of January 1, 2007, we have realigned our organization to reflect market trends, strengthen our leadership and expand our market reach. Through efficiently applying our resources into three key business units we are sharpening our focus on the markets that we believe will enable us to capture emerging opportunities and best meet the needs of our global customer base.
Business Unit NetworksWith our robust portfolio of mobile and fixed broadband access technologies, core networks, transport and next-generation IP networks, we will effectively meet the coverage, capacity and network evolution needs of our customers.
Business Unit Global ServicesOur expertise in network roll-out, consulting, education, integration, customer support and managed services enables us to capitalize on the trend among operators to outsource a broader range of activities to network suppliers.
Business Unit MultimediaOur applications and content management solutions help our customers to increase their sales. Ericsson Mobility World brings a broad array of music, images, games and global positioning applications to operators and to their subscribers. Ericsson Consumer and Enterprise Lab and the complementary strengths of Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications further enhance our consumer perspective for superior end-to-end offerings.
NETWORKS
Ericsson has been #1 in mobile networks for many years and has now re-emerged as a leading contender in fixed networks as well. This has enabled us to expand our business with existing customers and to enter into important new relationships with others. In the years ahead, fixed and mobile broadband will be deployed in more and more areas of the world and Ericsson Networks will be a driving force behind this evolution.
Kurt Jofs
Executive Vice President
and head of Business Unit Networks
GLOBAL SERVICES
Whether measured by numbers or by performance, we are the global leader in both professional services and network roll-out. In 2006, operators spent an estimated USD 61-65 billion on services and the market has shown consistent growth over the years. Our ability to support our customers in growing their business and in significantly reducing network operations costs explains why our services are in such high demand. With our services offering, our customers gain significant efficiencies.
Hans Vestberg
Executive Vice President
and head of Business Unit Global Services
17
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
MULTIMEDIA
The future is here and nowits about music on the move, mobile TV, Internet and e-mail access wherever you want it. Ericsson is helping to drive the multimedia experience by enabling our customers to develop successful businesses that energize consumers lives by providing rich, exciting, differentiated content. Our innovative technology, application platforms, cutting-edge Sony Ericsson phones and relationships with leading content developers and application providers make us a valuable partner for operators and other industry players seeking to access more revenue streams.
Jan Wäreby
Senior Vice President
and head of Business Unit Multimedia
18
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
QUESTIONS AND ANSWERS
Why is Ericsson expanding headcount?
As a knowledge company, our employees are our greatest asset. During the year we added a net of 7,726 employees. This increase was primarily a result of the Marconi acquisition and the remaining additions were largely in Services to accommodate the 33 percent growth in that area. Going forward we expect to increase our headcount in line with our business needs. We have already announced plans to hire 500 new research engineers over the next few years to further strengthen Ericssons technology leadership and accelerate research, especially in the area of IP-networks and multimedia technology.
What is Ericssons acquisition strategy?
Over the past three years we have consistently grown our business faster than the market while maintaining best-in-class profitability. This has been achieved primarily through organic growth, complemented by bolt-on acquisitions that have brought us cutting-edge technology or expertise. Going forward our strategy remains the same.
What is Ericssons most significant challenge going forward?
Keeping pace with change, bringing cost-efficient, revenue-generating solutions to market, and meeting the needs of our customers better than our competitors are our primary challenges and key to our future success. Although we have been a telecommunications leader for many decades, this industry is always evolving and we must evolve along with it if we are to stay in the lead. The last 20 years have seen tremendous growth in mobile subscriptions. Looking to the future, the pace of new subscriber additions will eventually slow and growth will need to be driven in new ways. Growing minutes of use and a rapid increase in both mobile and fixed broadband data traffic are changing our business. Our recent acquisitions have expanded our technology portfolio and our growing services business will play an even more important role in meeting the challenges in the future.
What is Ericssons Intellectual Property position?
With around 22,000 patents, we believe that we hold leading patent portfolios in a number of key technology standards including GSM, EDGE, WCDMA, HSPA and MBMS. We also hold strong portfolios of essential patents in a variety of other fixed and mobile technologies including Voice over IP (VoIP), ATM, WAP, WiMAX, WLAN and TD-SCDMA. These patents are very valuable, reducing our cost and creating an additional source of income for our Company.
What does Ericsson mean by Operational Excellence?
At Ericsson we use the term operational excellence to refer to our philosophy of striving to do things smarter today than yesterday and to do it in a smarter way than our competitors. By driving excellence and innovation in everything that we do, we create a competitive advantage. Much was achieved through operational excellence in 2006, including improved R&D lead times and the successful integration of Marconi operations. We also reorganized our operations into three business units, creating a more customer-oriented organization and paving the way for continuous efficiency improvements in the years ahead.
How will Ericsson utilize its net cash of SEK 40.7 billion?
Maintaining a strong cash position is essential to us and we intend to keep it at a robust level for the foreseeable future. Our cash provides us flexibility in this competitive and capital-intensive business. It will be used to fund organic growth, to execute large network projects, to provide selective customer financing, to make bolt-on acquisitions, and to pay the annual dividend to shareholders. The dividend payout has increased from SEK 0.25 for 2004, to SEK 0.45 for 2005 and the Board has proposed a dividend of SEK 0.50 for 2006.
19
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY
OUR CONTRIBUTION TO A BETTER WORLD
Corporate Responsibility is about building enduring valueeconomic, environmental and socialfor our Company and our stakeholders. Our goal is to generate positive business impacts and ensure that controls are in place to minimize risks.
GENERATE POSITIVE BUSINESS IMPACTS
We are committed to solutions that increase our own and our customers positive impact on the planet. During 2006:
| We introduced new green site concepts, promoting the use of a variety of renewable energy sources to power our radio base stations. We announced our pioneering biofuel project with pan African-operator MTN and the GSMA Development Fund in Nigeria. |
| Ericsson Consumer and Enterprise Lab conducted studies in Kenya and Nigeria, deepening the industrys understanding of how mobile communications can serve as a major catalyst of socio-economic development in very low-income villages. |
| We are driving market penetration and subscriber growth in emerging economies by introducing new technologies and business models which lower operators costs of network rollout in rural and low-income areas. In this way, we are narrowing the digital divide by increasing the accessibility and affordability of services. |
| Ericsson Response, our employee volunteer disaster relief program, provided on-the-ground support in Pakistan for nine months following the devastating earthquake. |
| As one of the founding partners of the KTH Center for Sustainable Communications in Sweden, we are exploring the role of advanced communication technologies in a sustainability context. |
MINIMIZE RISKS
Our approach ensures that controls are in place to deepen stakeholder trust and to minimize operational risks.
| Our Code of Business Ethics outlines expectations Ericsson has on its employees. This Code is periodically reviewed, and in 2006 all employees were asked to review and acknowledge understanding of this Code. |
| Ericsson was an early signatory to the UN Global Compact principles which cover human rights, fair labor practices, environment and anti-corruption. These principles are reflected in our Code of Conduct and are valid for all employees and all suppliers. |
| During 2006, we completed a pilot project using a risk-based approach to the Codes implementation to evaluate supplier performance and to reduce operational risks. |
| We joined the Business Leaders Initiative on Human Rights (BLIHR), a business-led initiative designed to help lead and develop the corporate response to human rights. |
| Ericsson is in compliance with the EU Directive on Restriction of the use of certain Hazardous Substances in Electrical and Electronic Equipment (RoHS). |
| We have begun global implementation of our Ecology Management Provision (first introduced in 2002), offering take-back of customers decommissioned equipment for all products, in all markets. |
| Ericssons goal is to exceed the European Unions WEEE (Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment) Directives ambition of recycling or reusing 75 percent of equipment taken back and ensure that less than 25 percent ends up in landfill sites. |
20
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
LETTER FROM THE CHAIRMAN OF THE BOARD
Dear Shareholder,
Five years ago, Ericsson embarked on an important process of change. It started with the formation of the Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications joint venture, followed by an extensive revamping of Ericssons entire operations. Today these actions have resulted in a powerful and unique combination of scale and diversity. In 2006, Ericsson reported record profits and Sony Ericsson marked its fifth anniversary with record shipments, sales and income. This transformation would not have been possible without strong shareholder support, particularly the positive response to Ericssons stock issue in 2002 that provided the financial security to successfully complete the change process.
Our ambition is to return value to shareholders in the most sustainable way. This requires maintaining a strong balance sheet for the financial flexibility to capture opportunities and further strengthen Ericssons market position. Organic growth is the Companys primary intention but acquisitions to speed time to market may be necessary. You can be assured that we will rigorously apply the management oversight needed to ensure acquisitions are in line with Ericssons needs and means.
Todays telecommunications market is both promising and challenging, offering opportunities that are bigger but also more demanding than in the past. The market is more global; with customers as well as competitors becoming more concentrated and stronger. Ericsson must continuously adapt to such market dynamics if it is to continue its leadership and management has done a good job to make sure Ericsson is strategically, operationally and financially prepared for a new stage of development.
The underlying strength of Ericsson is the quality of the work-force. Their commitment to Ericssons core values and willingness to embrace change underpins the outstanding results achieved this year. On behalf of the Board of Directors, I would like to express our appreciation to all employees for their dedicated efforts and special contributions.
The ability to attract and retain the best talent at all levels of the Company, especially in leadership roles, is crucial to Ericssons growth and future performance. Executive compensation is one of the most widely debated issues in business today and suitable remuneration is important to the Company. Ericssons executive compensation must be competitive and reflect the high demands we put on the Companys leadership. We believe the compensation plan that the Remuneration committee oversees with the assistance of external experts is fair, robust and in line with industry norms.
The Board is committed to ensuring that Ericssons governance framework supports the Companys main purpose of shareholder value creation. Enhancements made during the year are described in the Corporate Governance Report which I encourage you to read. Along with the Companys executive management, we continue to foster Ericssons culture of integrity, respect and professionalism; integral parts of effective governance.
Your Board of Directors has been particularly busy during 2006, meeting 10 times on a broad range of issues from acquisitions to strategies to a new organization for the Company. In addition we had a number of training sessions including R&D, Human Resources and Corporate Responsibility. We will continue our work with a commitment to progressively enhance the Companys performance for the benefit of the employees, for society in general and, of course, for all Ericsson shareholders.
21
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
The telecom industry is one with long-term growth prospects and one that has an increasingly positive effect on our daily lives. As the worlds leading supplier of communications networks and services, Ericsson has a vital role in the industry and I am proud to be associated with such an exciting company. I thank you for allowing me this privilege.
Yours sincerely,
Michael Treschow
Chairman of the Board
22
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
SEK million |
2006 | 20051) | 20042) | ||||||
Net sales |
177,783 | 151,821 | 131,972 | ||||||
Operating income |
35,828 | 33,084 | 26,706 | ||||||
operating margin |
20.2 | % | 21.8 | % | 20.2 | % | |||
Financial net |
165 | 251 | 540 | ||||||
Net income |
26,436 | 24,460 | 17,836 | ||||||
Year-end position |
|||||||||
Total assets |
214,940 | 209,336 | 186,186 | ||||||
Working capital |
82,926 | 86,184 | 69,268 | ||||||
Capital employed |
142,447 | 133,332 | 115,144 | ||||||
Property, plant and equipment |
7,881 | 6,966 | 5,845 | ||||||
Stockholders equity |
120,113 | 101,622 | 80,445 | ||||||
Minority interests |
782 | 850 | 1,057 | ||||||
Interest-bearing liabilities and post-employment benefits |
21,552 | 30,860 | 33,643 | ||||||
Other information |
|||||||||
Earnings per share, basic, SEK |
1.65 | 1.53 | 1.11 | ||||||
Earnings per share, diluted, SEK |
1.65 | 1.53 | 1.11 | ||||||
Cash dividends per share, SEK |
0.50 | 0.45 | 0.25 | ||||||
Stockholders equity (SEK per share) |
7.56 | 6.41 | 5.08 | ||||||
Number of shares (in millions) |
|||||||||
outstanding, basic, at end of period |
15,881 | 15,864 | 15,832 | ||||||
average, basic |
15,871 | 15,843 | 15,829 | ||||||
average, diluted |
15,943 | 15,907 | 15,895 | ||||||
Additions to property, plant and equipment |
3,827 | 3,365 | 2,452 | ||||||
Depreciation on property, plant and equipment |
3,007 | 2,804 | 2,434 | ||||||
R&D and other technical expenses |
27,921 | 24,454 | 23,421 | ||||||
as percentage of net sales |
15.7 | % | 16.1 | % | 17.7 | % | |||
Ratios |
|||||||||
Return on equity |
23.7 | % | 26.7 | % | 24.2 | % | |||
Return on capital employed |
27.4 | % | 28.7 | % | 26.4 | % | |||
Equity ratio |
56.2 | % | 49.0 | % | 43.8 | % | |||
Capital turnover |
1.3 | 1.2 | 1.2 | ||||||
Inventory turnover |
5.1 | 5.0 | 5.7 | ||||||
Trade receivables turnover |
3.9 | 4.1 | 4.1 | ||||||
Return on sales |
21.3 | % | 23.5 | % | 22.9 | % | |||
Payment readiness, SEK million |
67,454 | 78,647 | 81,447 | ||||||
as percentage of net sales |
37,9 | % | 51.8 | % | 61.7 | % | |||
Net cash, SEK million |
40,728 | 50,645 | 42,911 | ||||||
Statistical data, year-end |
|||||||||
Number of employees |
63,781 | 56,055 | 50,534 | ||||||
Of which in Sweden |
19,094 | 21,178 | 21,296 | ||||||
Export sales from Sweden |
98,694 | 93,879 | 86,510 | ||||||
1) | Ericsson has adopted the new option in IAS 19 from January 1, 2006. 2005 has been restated accordingly. |
2) | 2004 has been restated in accordance with IFRS, using the optional exemptions in IAS 39. Selected financial data for 2003 and 2002 have been omitted because such information cannot be restated in accordance with IFRS without unreasonable effort and expense. |
23
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Working capital: Current assets less current non-interest-bearing provisions and liabilities.
Capital employed: Capital employed is defined as total assets less non-interest-bearing provisions and liabilities.
Earnings per share: See Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C1, Significant Accounting Policies, for information on principles for calculation of earnings per share.
Cash dividends per share: Defined as dividends paid divided by average number of shares, basic.
Stockholders equity (SEK per share): Defined as Stockholders equity divided by the Number of shares outstanding, basic, at the end of the period.
Return on equity: Defined as Net income as a percentage of average Stockholders equity (based on the amounts at January 1 and December 31).
Return on capital employed: Defined as the total of Operating income plus Financial income as a percentage of average capital employed (based on the amounts at January 1 and December 31).
Equity ratio: Defined as Equity, expressed as a percentage of total assets.
Capital turnover: Net sales divided by average Capital employed.
Inventory turnover: Cost of Sales divided by average Inventory.
Accounts receivable turnover: Net sales divided by average Accounts receivable.
Return on sales: Operating income plus Financial income expressed as a percentage of Net Sales.
Payment readiness: Defined as cash and cash equivalents and short-term investments less short-term borrowings plus long-term unused credit commitments. Payment readiness is also shown as a percentage of Net Sales.
Net cash: Defined as cash and cash equivalents plus short-term cash investments less interest-bearing liabilities and post-employment benefits.
Compound annual growth rate (CAGR): Used to describe the growth rate over a period of time.
24
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
This Board of Directors Report contains a discussion and analysis of Ericssons consolidated financial statements and operational results. This report also includes forward-looking statements regarding a variety of matters including future market conditions, strategies and anticipated results. Such statements are based on assumptions and estimates, which are subject to risks and uncertainties. Actual results could differ materially from those described or implied by such forward-looking statements. For further discussion, please see Forward-looking Statements and Risk Factors.
The terms Ericsson, Group, the Company, and similar all refer to Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson and its subsidiaries. Unless otherwise noted, numbers in parenthesis refer to prior year, i.e. 2005.
SUMMARY
Ericsson performed well in 2006, increasing sales 17 percent and generating operating income of SEK 35.8 (33.1) billion and a cash flow before financial investing activities of SEK2.6 (11.3) billion. Excluding the Marconi and Netwise acquisitions and the divestiture of the defense business, the cash flow was SEK 12.2 billion.
In addition to delivering solid financial results, Ericsson also made good progress in strategically important areas, strengthening the Companys position within the Systems segment business in a number of related areas such as mobile and fixed broadband and professional services. Services sales in particular showed strong growth, and we believe that scale for continued profitable growth has now been established.
The Marconi acquisition was completed with the acquired operations integrated and profitability established before year end. The combined Ericsson and Marconi business has secured several significant new contracts as a result of the expanded product line.
Ericssons leading systems position was further expanded with a number of major contracts for new mobile network deployments in all regions of the world, including in Australia, Brazil, India, Japan and the United States. The development in China was unfavorably affected by the timing and operator investment requirements for 3G licenses.
During the year, 48 new or expanded agreements to supply network equipment and/or related services to operators around the world were publicly announced by the Company. This compares with 78 in 2005, 59 in 2004 and 58 in 2003. Although the number of contract announcements was lower this year than in the previous three years, the aggregate value of orders from these agreements along with existing ones lifted our order backlog for systems to the highest level in four years.
The Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications joint venture showed record performance, profitably gaining market share and ending the year as the fourth largest mobile device supplier with strong momentum toward their ambition of becoming a top three mobile phone supplier.
25
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
The Companys progress during 2006 indicates that the strategy of maintaining a healthy balance between profit and growth has already strengthened Ericssons prospects for a number of opportunities in growth areas such as services and next-generation networks for fixed and mobile operators.
MARKET ENVIRONMENT AND TREND INFORMATION
2006 was a record year in terms of new mobile subscriptions: some 500 (450) million new mobile subscriptions and approximately 980 (800) million mobile phones were sold. The network equipment market also developed positively during 2006, particularly for mobile systems, fixed broadband access and optical transmission.
Price competition was especially intense this year regarding strategic pricing necessary to win certain new contracts. However, with the merger of several of our competitors, we expect pricing going forward to be more in line with historical trends. The historical price/performance trend in both mobile phones and network infrastructure has significantly expanded the addressable market with resulting unit volume increases more than offsetting lower average selling prices.
Although GSM represents the majority of the systems market, growth of GSM is slower than 3G/WCDMA, which is accelerating. The market for new GSM networks is mainly in emerging markets, especially Asia, Africa and Latin America. If the current trend continues, the market for 3G/WCDMA will surpass that of GSM within the next several years.
The ongoing equipment supplier consolidation is a healthy process, driven by the competitive need for critical mass in R&D, production and support. As a market leader, Ericssons expansion strategy is based on organic growth supplemented with complementary acquisitions. With Ericssons scale advantage within mobile systems exposed to potential reduction, the Company will increasingly focus on innovation and operational excellence as well as expansion of fixed networks and professional services sales along with new areas within multimedia.
Operator consolidation continues to be a key trend in a number of regions. In the Americas, significant operator consolidation has occurred with the number of operators reduced by more than half over the last several years. One result of this consolidation is that a number of operators in Latin America have chosen the GSM/WCDMA technology track, where Ericsson is the market leader. In Europe, we see an acceleration of cross-border expansion as operators there seek revenue growth and economies of scale. In other regions, operator consolidation is ongoing with the emergence of a number of rapidly growing pan-regional operators.
Increased usage driven by new mobile subscriptions, mainly in emerging markets, and accelerating deployments of 3G networks around the world generated growth in the mobile systems market. At year-end, the
26
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
2.7 billion mobile subscriptions worldwide represented a global subscription penetration of 41 (34) percent. The Company expects the number of mobile subscriptions to exceed three billion before the end of 2007. This will drive a significant number of initial network build-outs and create opportunities for network deployment and professional services in addition to mobile network systems offerings.
Total voice traffic on mobile networks worldwide grew an estimated 30 (30) percent in 2006, driven by subscriber additions and increased average minutes of use (MOU). Western Europe is among the highest penetrated mobile markets in the world in terms of subscriptions. However, Western European usage is significantly lower than the average for the rest of the world. Increased tariff competition among operators is starting to stimulate Western European usage to a level closer to the global average. This is expected to require expansion of mobile network capacity over the coming years.
At year-end, there were 146 (91) 3G/WCDMA networks in commercial service, of which Ericsson is a supplier to 91 (49). The High Speed Packet Access (HSPA) enhanced version of 3G/ WCDMA is now commercially deployed within 96 networks in 51 countries. Ericsson is a supplier of 46 of these networks, which represent the vast majority of HSPA users. The number of WCD-MA subscriptions almost doubled during 2006 to nearly 100 million and HSPA deployments are rapidly picking up speed. However, the number of 3G/WCDMA networks in commercial service is less than one fourth that of 2G/GSMa significant opportunity for 3G/WCDMA equipment suppliers when 2G networks are upgraded.
Within fixed networks, many operators are converting to an all-IP (Internet Protocol) broadband environment. This will enable more efficient handling of fixed and mobile voice, data and image based communications as well as provide a platform for converged services. While fixed network operators spending for network equipment in total was up slightly in 2006, certain areas essential to next-generation networksoptical transmission, IP broadband access, IP routing and IMS/softswitchshowed stronger growth. The Company believes the demand for IP broadband equipment will increase to meet the higher traffic requirements and user expectations for broadband multimedia services.
In addition to network deployment and systems integration services, the opportunity to supply network operation and hosting services is growing rapidly. The market for such managed services is expected to continue to show good growth prospects going forward, as operators realize the competitive advantages and cost savings made possible when outsourcing certain network operations. With hosting services, smaller operators especially benefit by gaining access to service capabilities and content far beyond what they could normally afford, while at the same time lowering their risks and improving their time to market.
GOALS, STRATEGY AND FINANCIAL RESULTS
Our ultimate goal is for the Company to generate growth and a competitive profit that is sustainable over the longer term. Ericsons ambition is to be the preferred business partner to customers, especially the worlds leading network operators. Ericsson strives to be the market and technology leader for the supply and operation of network infrastructure. Being a market leader allows the Company to leverage economies of scale to develop superior products and services and thereby offer customers competitive advantages. In addition, when our network equipment and associated services within Systems are combined with our mobile platform technology and the Sony Ericsson joint venture for mobile handsets, the scope of Ericssons operations extends to complete end-to-end solutions.
Performance relative to financial objectives
The Company performed in line with the following financial targets:
| Increase sales at a faster rate than the market growth. The GSM/WCDMA mobile systems market grew an estimated 5 percent, while Ericsson increased their mobile systems sales by almost 10 percent; |
27
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
| Deliver best-in-class operating margin, i.e. better than the main competitors. With an operating margin of 16 percent for Ericsson Systems segment and 20 percent for the Group, Ericsson operating margins were the highest among its main competitors; |
| Maintain Investment Grade credit ratings; |
However, the Company did not meet the following target Generate positive cash flow before financial investing activities. However, excluding the major acquisitions/divestitures the cash flow was SEK 12.2 billion.
In addition to these objectives, the shareholder-approved long-term variable pay programs for executives is based on a certain EPS growth over a three-year period for each program. Please see also Notes to the consolidated statementsNote C29, Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management.
Sales
Group sales grew 17 percent mainly driven by higher Systems sales, where services increased by 33 percent and the Marconi acquisition added an estimated 7 percent. Fluctuations in foreign exchange rates had an insignificant effect on reported sales.
Segment Systems
Within Systems, unit volume increases drove mobile network sales growth. Sales of network deployment services related to Systems grew 39 percent during 2006, reflecting increased demand for turn-key projects and our strong market position in mobile systems. Sales of professional services were particularly encouraging, growing at 30 percent, as the Company continued to be awarded contracts for network operation and hosting services. At year end 2006, Ericsson-managed network operations served approximately 100 (53) million users.
Based on Ericssons reported sales combined with the publicly reported and estimated sales for Ericssons main competitors, we believe the mobile systems market grew approximately 5 (11) percent in reported currencies during 2006. During this period, Ericssons mobile systems sales increased by almost 10 percent, measured in SEK, indicating that Ericsson grew faster than the market.
The successful integration of the Marconi operations significantly strengthened Ericssons systems offering, especially to operators of fixed networks, where sales grew by 162 percent. The Company was awarded a number of contracts for broadband access and optical transmission equipment due to the competitiveness of the combined product offering. We are optimistic regarding growth opportunities for IP routing, broadband access, optical transmission and next-generation networks. The Company continues to invest in these areas, with the acquisition of Redback Networks expanding the scope of the product portfolio to also include IP routing.
Segment Other Operations
Sales and operating income developed positively within Mobile Platforms and Cables (Ericsson Network Technologies) and overall sales within Other Operations increased by 6 (4) percent and operating income was SEK 0.9 (0.3) billion. The divested Defense business is reflected in sales and operating income of Other Operations up until the divestiture in early September, 2006. Sales up until date of divestment were approximately SEK 1.4 billion, compared with full year 2005 of approximately SEK 2 billion.
Segment Phones
See Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications on page 33 under Partnerships and Joint Ventures.
28
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
SALES BY SEGMENT AND GEOGRAPHIC REGION 2006
(SEK million) |
Systems | Percent change |
Other Operations |
Percent change |
Total | Percent change |
Percent of total |
|||||||||||
Western Europe |
45,396 | 27 | % | 6,542 | 7 | % | 51,938 | 24 | % | 29 | % | |||||||
Central and Eastern Europe, Middle East and Africa |
48,699 | 23 | % | 1,602 | 36 | % | 50,301 | 23 | % | 28 | % | |||||||
Asia Pacific |
41,991 | 45 | % | 1,211 | -16 | % | 43,202 | 42 | % | 25 | % | |||||||
Latin America |
16,234 | -14 | % | 246 | 2 | % | 16,480 | -14 | % | 9 | % | |||||||
North America |
15,250 | -19 | % | 612 | -7 | % | 15,862 | -18 | % | 9 | % | |||||||
Total |
167,570 | 18 | % | 10,213 | 6 | % | 177,783 | 17 | % | 100 | % | |||||||
Margins and operating expenses
Our ambition is for Ericsson to generate a competitive return on sales. With best-in-class operating margins of 20.2 (21.8) percent, the Company continued to perform at industry-leading levels. Sony Ericsson contributed 3.3 (1.5) percentage points to the operating margin, while Marconi negatively affected Systems margins until profitability was established at the end of the third quarter. The lower gross margin of 41.2 (45.7) percent was mainly a reflection of a business mix within Systems that had a significantly higher proportion of service sales as well as the impact of the businesses acquired from Marconi, as both have a lower than group average gross margin.
Operating margins have remained robust, with Group sales showing a 16.1 percent compound annual growth rate (CAGR) over the last three years while operating expenses have a CAGR of only 12.0 percent. Operating expenses, measured as a percentage of net sales, increased from 27 percent in 2005 to 28 percent in 2006. The acquired Marconi operations had a negative effect on operating expenses during the first nine months, until they were successfully integrated and streamlined.
Cost savings programs have been carried out within a number of areas, such as creating scale advantages through the establishment of several shared service centers in a number of regions which provide financial and human resource services to the sales organization. The number of employees in support functions was reduced through improved utilization of IT applications. By focusing on operational excellence (i.e. process efficiency), we have been able to grow sales without having to increase S&A head-count and costs at a corresponding rate.
29
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Other income statement items
Share in earnings of joint ventures and associated companies before tax increased by SEK 3.5 billion, mainly due to a larger contribution from Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications. Ericssons 50 percent share in earnings of the joint venture before tax increased from SEK 2.3 billion in 2005 to SEK 5.9 billion in 2006.
The financial net decreased slightly from SEK 0.3 billion in 2005 to SEK 0.2 billion in 2006.
Income after financial items was SEK 36.0 (33.3) billion. Net income attributable to the stockholders of the Parent Company increased to SEK 26.3 (24.3) billion, with diluted earnings per share of SEK 1.65 (1.53).
Balance Sheet
Total assets amounted to SEK 214.9 (209.3) billion at year-end. The main item contributing to the 3 percent increase was higher trade receivables reflecting the high business activity in the last quarter of the year in markets with longer payment terms.
Deferred tax assets decreased by SEK 5.0 billion, due to utilization of tax loss carry forwards and timing differences.
SEK 9.3 billion of non-current borrowings were repaid.
Net cash decreased from SEK 50.6 billion to SEK 40.7 billion, mainly as a result of the Marconi acquisition. The major part of the acquired assets were intellectual property rights.
Equity increased to SEK 120.9 (102.5) billion and the equity ratio improved to 56.2 (49.0) percent.
Return on Capital Employed (ROCE ) was 27 percent compared to 29 percent in 2005.
RETURN ON CAPITAL EMPLOYED 2004-2006
Percent | ||
2004 |
26.4 | |
2005 |
28.7 | |
2006 |
27.4 |
Cash flow before financial investing activities
Cash flow before financial investing activities was SEK2.6 (11.3) billion. SEK 17.6 billion was used to acquire certain assets from Marconi. Excluding major acquisitions/divestitures, the underlying cash flow was SEK 12.2 billion. Increases in working capital for work in progress in the field and trade receivables, reflecting the growth in large network roll-out projects, also had negative effects. Cash outlays regarding restructuring amounted to SEK 2.3 (2.0) billion, where SEK 0.8 (1.5) billion relates to restructuring programs initiated during 20012003.
Through the efforts to improve capital efficiency, Inventory Turnover (ITO) improved compared to 2005. Days Sales Outstanding (DSO) increased due to growth in emerging and other markets with longer payment terms. Efforts to further improve capital efficiency will continue.
30
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
WORKING CAPITAL EFFICIENCY MEASURES
Target | 2006 | 2005 | 2004 | |||||
Days Sales Outstanding (DSO) |
<90 | 86 | 81 | 75 | ||||
Inventory Turnover (ITO) |
>5.5 | 5.1 | 5.0 | 5.7 | ||||
Payable Days 1) |
>45 | 54 | 52 | 51 |
1) | Payable days: Accounts payable divided by Cost of sales and multiplied by 365 days. |
Capital expenditures
We continuously monitor the Companys capital expenditures and evaluate whether adjustments are necessary in light of market conditions and other economic factors. Most capital expenditures are normally investments in test equipment used to develop, manufacture and deploy network equipment. However, the increase in capital expenditures from 2005 to 2006 was mainly due to investments for data and network operation centers, needed to support the rapidly growing services business.
The following table summarizes annual capital expenditures during the five years ended December 31, 2006:
CAPITAL EXPENDITURES 2002-2006
SEK billion |
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | 2003 | 2002 | |||||
Capital expenditures |
3.8 | 3.4 | 2.5 | 1.8 | 2.7 | |||||
of which Sweden |
1.0 | 1.0 | 1.1 | 1.1 | 1.2 | |||||
as percent of net sales |
2.2 | 2.2 | 1.9 | 1.5 | 1.9 |
Excluding acquisitions, capital expenditures in relation to sales are not expected to be significantly different in 2007, remaining at roughly two percent of sales. However, in addition to the normal capital expenditures there are commitments to repay SEK 0.1 billion of debt and to purchase Redback Networks for USD 1.9 billion, or SEK 13.4 billion, as well as to acquire Entrisphere. With a net cash position at year-end of SEK 40.7 billion, we expect the Company to be able to cover all capital expenditure plans and customer financing commitments for 2007 by using funds generated from operations with no additional borrowings required.
In 2000 and 2001, we disposed of the majority of the real estate properties that we owned. We believe the properties that we now occupy are suitable for our present needs in most locations. As of December 31, 2006, no material land, buildings, machinery or equipment were pledged as collateral for outstanding indebtedness.
Credit ratings
Moodys credit rating agency raised Ericssons credit rating during 2006, while Standard & Poors (S&P) last upgraded their ratings in 2005. At year-end, their ratings of Ericssons creditworthiness were Baa2 (Baa3) for Moodys and BBB for S&P, both considered to be Investment Grade.
ERICSSON CREDIT RATINGS YEAR END 2004-2006
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
Moodys |
Baa2 | Baa3 | Ba2 | |||
Standard & Poors |
BBB | BBB | BB+ |
31
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT
A robust R&D program is essential to Ericssons competitiveness and future success. With most R&D invested in mobile communications network infrastructure, Ericssons program is one of the largest in the industry. The efficiency of the R&D activities has been improved, enabling a faster time to market for new products and increased investments in new areas such as multimedia solutions, while decreasing R&D as a percentage of sales. The Company reduced R&D lead time by more than 20 percent this year and has an ambition to reduce R&D lead times by an additional 30 percent over the next several years, as well as adding as many as 500 research engineers in the areas of multimedia and IP technology.
R&D PROGRAM
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | |||||||
Expenses (SEK billion) |
27.9 | 24.5 | 23.4 | ||||||
As percent of sales |
15.7 | % | 16.1 | % | 17.7 | % | |||
Employees within R&D at December 31 1) |
17,000 | 16,500 | 16,000 | ||||||
Patents 1) |
22,000 | 20,000 | 16,000 |
1) | The number of employees and patents are approximate. |
R&D expenses during 2007, excluding the effects of the acquisition of Redback Networks, are expected to remain at roughly the same level in absolute terms compared with 2006, including the additional research engineers and the amortization of the intangible assets acquired from Marconi.
PARTNERSHIPS AND JOINT VENTURES
During 2006, Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications AB reported strong unit volume and sales increases, which caused income before tax to improve significantly during the year. The improved performance is mainly a result of focusing on imaging, music and enterprise phones, while increasing the number of more affordable models. Sony Ericssons ambition is to achieve continued profitable growth by leveraging the opportunities created by the combination of technologies and expertise from the parent companies. The joint venture results are accounted for in accordance with the equity method. For more information, see also Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C1, Significant Accounting Policies.
SONY ERICSSON RESULTS 2004-2006
2006 | Percent change |
2005 | 2004 | ||||||
Shipments (unit millions) |
74.8 | 46 | % | 51.2 | 42.3 | ||||
Sales (EUR m.) |
10,959 | 51 | % | 7,268 | 6,525 | ||||
Income before tax (EUR m.) |
1,298 | 154 | % | 512 | 486 | ||||
Net income (EUR m.) |
997 | 185 | % | 350 | 316 | ||||
Ericssons share of earnings (SEK billion) |
5.9 | 157 | % | 2.3 | 2.1 |
For more information on transactions with Sony Ericsson, please see also Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C30, Related Party Transactions.
ACQUISITIONS AND DIVESTITURES
The acquisition of certain assets relating to broadband access, optical and radio transmission systems, data networking and service layer from Marconi was completed on January 23, 2006, with a cash payment equivalent
32
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
to SEK 17.6 billion. With net assets of SEK 4.0 billion, most of the acquisition costs were related to intellectual property rights, e.g. patents, brands, trade marks, etc., which will be amortized over a ten year period. The acquired businesses were consolidated into Ericssons accounts as per January 1, 2006.
During the year, the acquired Marconi businesses were streamlined and fully integrated within Ericssons operations. This resulted in a 24 percent reduction of the former Marconi workforce for an estimated annual cost savings of approximately SEK 2.0 billion, with full effect from the fourth quarter of 2006. Restructuring charges were SEK 2.2 billion, of which about one third was utilized during 2006, with the remainder expected to be utilized during the first half of 2007. Of this charge, SEK 1.4 billion relates to the layoff of 1,600 employees and SEK 0.8 billion relates to the termination of IT agreements and facilities contracts that are no longer needed but were pre-paid as part of the acquisition.
During 2006, there were also several small acquisitions made to increase capacity mainly to support the growing systems integration business. To expand the systems product portfolio, the Company also made several small technology acquisitions with Netwise of Sweden, acquired for SEK 0.3 billion, being the largest.
Ericssons defense business, Ericsson Microwave Systems AB, and its 40 percent holding in Saab Ericsson Space was sold to Saab AB for SEK 3.8 billion in cash with a capital gain of SEK 3.0 billion. The Ericsson defense business that Saab acquired had sales of approximately SEK 2 billion in 2005 and employed 1,250 employees when ownership was transferred.
In December, Ericsson launched a tender offer to acquire Redback Networks of the US for USD 1.9 billion. The tender offer was successfully concluded on January 25, 2007.
During 2004, Ericsson made a public offer to purchase shares of Ericsson S.P.A. in Italy, increasing Ericssons ownership to 93 percent. In the first quarter of 2005, a Residual Public Offer was launched for the remaining shares, and subsequently Ericsson S.P.A. was delisted from the Milan Stock Exchange. In total SEK 2.2 billion was paid out for the shares, of which SEK 0.6 billion in 2005. In 2006, the remaining shares were purchased for SEK 0.1 billion, and the ownership in Ericsson S.P.A. is now 100 percent.
Other than the transactions described above, there were no material acquisitions or divestitures completed during 2004, 2005 or 2006.
MATERIAL CONTRACTS AND CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS
Primary contractual obligations are outlined in the following table. Operating leases are mainly related to offices and production facilities. Purchase obligations are mainly related to outsourced manufacturing, R&D and IT operations and to components for our own manufacturing. Except for those transactions previously described in this report, Ericsson has not been a party to any material contracts over the last three years other than those entered into during the ordinary course of business.
33
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS 2006
Payment due by period | ||||||||||
(SEK million) |
Total | <1 year | 1-3 years | 3-5 years | >5 years | |||||
Long-term debt 1) 2) |
12,020 | 427 | 6,689 | 4,401 | 503 | |||||
Capital lease obligations 3) |
2,207 | 180 | 334 | 253 | 1,440 | |||||
Operating leases 3) |
11,225 | 2,198 | 3,318 | 2,205 | 3,504 | |||||
Other non-current liabilities |
2,868 | 187 | 991 | 15 | 1,676 | |||||
Purchase obligations 4) |
8,238 | 8,238 | | | | |||||
Commitments for customer financing 2) |
6,795 | 6,795 | | | | |||||
Total |
43,353 | 18,025 | 11,332 | 6,874 | 7,122 | |||||
1) | Including interest payments. |
2) | See also Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C20, Financial Risk Management and Financial Instruments. |
3) | See also Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C27, Leasing. |
4) | The amounts of purchase obligations are gross, before deduction of any related provisions. |
CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES
The discussion and analysis of our results of operations and financial condition are based on our consolidated financial statements which have been prepared in accordance with IFRS. The preparation of these financial statements requires management to apply accounting methods and policies that are based on difficult, complex or subjective judgments or on estimates based on past experience and assumptions determined to be reasonable and realistic based on the related circumstances. The application of these estimates and assumptions affects the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and contingent assets and liabilities at the balance sheet date and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions or conditions.
Please see Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C2, Critical Accounting Estimates and Judgments for more information about the accounting policies that we believe have the most significant impact on Ericssons reported results and financial position.
NEW ORGANIZATION
The development of broadband capabilities for both mobile and fixed operators combined with the move toward next-generation networks are expected to create demand for richer multimedia services and accelerate growth opportunities. In this environment, we see the possibility to further strengthen Ericssons market and technology leadership by implementing a more customer-oriented organization with three business units, each optimized for a specific, but related, market segment.
Networks includes access, core and transport, as well as cables and power modules, previously reported within Other Operations.
Global Services, consisting of network rollout and professional services, remains unchanged.
Multimedia includes Multimedia systems, as well as mobile platforms and enterprise solutions, both previously reported within Other Operations.
The new organization is in effect as from January 1, 2007.
34
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
Although internal policies and directives for governance and other important rules for managing the Companys business activities have long been established, we have adapted our work procedures in line with relevant developments in Sweden and the United States regarding reporting, disclosure and other requirements for listed companies as well as changes in legislation, such as the Swedish Companies Act and the US Sarbanes-Oxley Act.
In accordance with the Swedish Code of Corporate Governance, a separate Corporate Governance Report, including an Internal Control section, has been prepared. There have been no amendments or waivers to Ericssons Code of Business Ethics for any Director or member of management.
RISK MANAGEMENT
Risk-taking is an inherent part of doing business. Risks are managed in our operational processes where risks are identified, probability of occurrence assessed and potential consequences estimated. Actions are then taken to reduce or mitigate the risk exposures and limit potential unfavorable consequences.
We broadly categorize risks into operational risks and financial risks. Our approach to risk management leverages the scale and diversity of our business activities and balances central coordination with well-defined risk management responsibilities within each operational unit.
For more information on risk management, see also page 121, Risk Factors.
Operational risk management
Risk management has been integrated within the Ericsson Group Management System and each business process. The operational risk management framework applies universally across all business activities and is based on the following principles:
Each risk is owned and managed by an operational unit that is held accountable, and monitored through unit steering boards and Group Management.
Risks are dealt with on three levels: in the strategy process, in annual target setting and within ongoing operations by transaction (customer bid/contract, acquisition, investment, product development project, etc).
Approval limits are clearly established with escalation according to a well-defined delegation of authority.
Certain risks, such as information security/IT risks and physical security as well as insurable risks are centrally coordinated. A crisis management council deals with ad hoc events of a serious nature, as necessary.
Financial risk management
We have an established policy governing the Groups financial risk management, which is carried out by the Treasury function within the Parent Company and by a Customer finance function. These are both supervised by the Board of Directors Finance Committee.
For further information on objectives, policies and strategies for financial risk management, please see Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C19, Interest-Bearing Liabilities and Note C20, Financial Risk Management and Financial Instruments.
35
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Foreign exchange risks
With significant transaction volumes in currencies other than SEK, the Company has a net exposure to a number of currencies. The duration of this exposure is also considerable, as many contracts have long lead times between order and delivery. A variety of hedging activities, covering on average the forthcoming 69 months, are used to manage foreign exchange risks.
The largest foreign exchange exposure is to the US dollar and related currencies, which represented 49 (46) percent of sales in 2006. Assuming that other foreign exchange exposures remained the same, a 10 percent plus/minus change in the USD/ SEK exchange rate would affect operating income by an estimated plus/minus SEK 3.8 (3.3) billion before any hedging effects. However, these effects may be compensated over time with new contracts with adjusted prices and costs.
Interest rate risks
Ericsson is exposed to interest rate risk through market value fluctuations of certain balance sheet items and through changes in interest expenses and income. Assuming the net cash position remained at SEK 40.7 (50.6) billion, a sustained change in interest rates of plus/minus 0.25 percentage points would have an annual impact on the financial net of approximately plus/minus SEK 72 (135) million.
Credit risk in trade receivables
At year-end 2006, trade receivables amounted to SEK 51.1 (41.2) billion, less allowances of SEK 1.4 (1.4) billion. Extended payment terms for trade credits and overdue amounts are regularly reviewed, and allowances are made to cover any potential losses. Historically, credit losses have been minimal, mainly due to a customer base that largely consists of well established and financially sound network operators.
Customer finance risk
At year-end 2006, gross exposure for customer financing amounted to SEK 4.1 (7.0) billion, of which less than one percent was off-balance sheet. Operators in Central and Eastern Europe, Middle East and Africa represented half of the exposure, with Latin America accounting for most of the rest.
Credit risks are covered by security arrangements in most customer financing agreements, normally in the form of pledges of equipment, pledges of certain of the borrowers assets and/or pledges of shares in the operating company. In addition to these security arrangements provisions are made and reported as part of selling expenses. Risk provisions amounted to 13 (29) percent of the gross exposure.
Unutilized outstanding customer financing commitments amounted to SEK 6.8 (3.6) billion at year-end.
Financial credit risk
Financial instruments carry an element of risk in that counterparties may be unable to fulfill their payment obligations. All derivative transactions are covered by ISDA Master Agreements to reduce the credit risk. During 2006, no credit losses were incurred from such instruments.
Liquidity and refinancing risk
We expect the Companys cash-generating capabilities and strong cash position to satisfy any short-term liquidity requirements. During 2006, there have not been any defaults in the payment of principal or interest, or any other material default relating to the indebtedness of Ericsson or any of its subsidiaries.
36
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY
Effective management of social, environmental and ethical issues can help to assure an enduring capability for value creation and competitive advantage. Ericsson supports the UN Global Compact and its ten guiding principles. We see these principles not only as guiding principles, but also as a prerequisite for sound, long-term business and as such, we are committed to responsible business practices for sustainable economic growth that all our stakeholders benefit from. Our commitment to employees, customers, shareholders and the broader global community is underscored by external recognition of our efforts. During 2006, Ericsson was again included in the FTSE 4Good, the Dow Jones Sustainability Index and the 100 Global Most Sustainable Corporations.
Ericsson publishes a separate Corporate Responsibility Report annually, which provides comprehensive information about our corporate responsibility and related activities.
Human Rights
Ericsson believes that publicly available and affordable telecommunications is a fundamental prerequisite for social and economic development. As one of the worlds largest providers of communications equipment and services, the Company plays a vital role in this process, especially in emerging markets. Ericsson joined The Business Leaders Initiative on Human Rights (BLIHR), which aims to find practical applications of the Universal Declaration of Human Rights within a business context and to inspire other businesses to do likewise. Ericssons participation in BLIHR reinforces a longstanding commitment to human rights and corporate responsibility activities.
Community Involvement
The Company is committed to being a responsible member of the global society and of the local communities in which we operate. Employees are encouraged and empowered to make a positive contribution to the world around them. Their contributions are of many kinds, determined by our employees according to local needs. They may, for example, be in the fields of health care, social and humanitarian aid, scholarships and other educational support, art and culture, the environment, childrens welfare as well as many other charitable activities.
We believe that telecom by its very nature has a constructive role to play in the proactive engagement in local economic, environmental and social challenges. We are encouraging economic growth in emerging markets through our Communications for All program, which we are convinced will contribute substantially to poverty reduction.
Ericsson Response is a global initiative to rapidly provide IT, communication solutions and telecom experts anywhere in the world in response to human suffering caused by disasters. Ericsson Response assists the disaster relief operations of the UN Office for the Coordination of Humanitarian Affairs (OCHA), UN World Food Programme (WFP) and the International Federation of Red Cross and Red Crescent Societies (IFRC). During 2006, Ericsson Response continued its 2005 support for an additional six months to the earthquake-hit Pakistan. During the crisis in Lebanon, Ericsson Response supported the Telecom Sans Frontiers operations in the country through our office in Lebanon.
Environment and Health
Our most significant environmental impact relates to the energy consumed by our products during their use phase, and we have set ambitious targets in this area. By 2008, the Company intends to improve the energy efficiency of the 3G/WCDMA base station portfolio by a total of 50 percent, compared with 2005 levels. During 2006, the annual incremental improvement target of 25 percent was significantly exceeded.
37
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
The Company is also working actively with green site solutions, including solar, wind, fuel cell and biofuel technologies. Ericsson recently teamed up with the GSM Associations Development Fund in Nigeria to show that biofuel is a viable option for powering rural base stations. A second biofuel pilot, on a larger scale, is now starting in India. Biofuel-powered networks have the potential to bring socio-economic and environmental benefits to a society, while lowering operators total cost of ownership.
We believe that the Company is in compliance with all material environmental, health and safety laws and regulations required by its operations and business activities. Ericsson provides public information on radio waves and health and supports independent research to further increase knowledge in this area. Ericsson currently co-sponsors more than 45 different ongoing research projects related to electromagnetic fields (EMF), radio waves and health, and has since 1996 supported more than 80 studies with a total cost of more than EUR 40 million. Public health authorities and independent expert groups have reviewed the total amount of research and they have consistently concluded that the balance of evidence does not demonstrate any health effects associated with radio wave exposure from either mobile phones or radio base stations.
From August 13, 2005, Ericsson has complied with the EU Directive on Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment (WEEE). Our global end-of-life treatment program is called the Ecology Management Provision, and was initiated three years before the WEEE requirements became law in the EU. This proactive approach gives Ericsson an effective tool to meet waste-management challenges in all our markets around the world. From July 1, 2006, Ericsson is in compliance with the EU Directive on Reduction of Hazardous Substances (RoHS).
Employees
Every year, an employee satisfaction survey is conducted with a high level of employee participation. In 2006, over 90 (92) percent of employees participated in this survey. The results show improvements in, among others, the areas of Operational Excellence, Work Empowerment & Company Engagement, Co-operation, Learning and Leadership.
Employee headcount at year-end was 63,781 (56,055). Most of the additions were due to the acquisition of Marconi and to support the growing services business. During the year, 6,432 (2,377) employees departed while 14,158 (7,898) joined the company. Please see also Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C29, Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management.
Executive Compensation
The Remuneration Committee continues to be mindful of the debates around the world on executive salaries and benefits. We remain confident that current policies and practices concerning authorization, compliance and control of senior executive compensation within Ericsson are appropriate and reasonable. Principles for remuneration and other employment terms for top executives were approved by the Annual General Meeting 2006, and are further described in Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C29, Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management.
As of December 31, 2006, there were no loans outstanding from, and no guarantees issued to or assumed by Ericsson for the benefit of any member of the Board of Directors or senior management. Please see also Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C29, Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management.
LEGAL AND TAX PROCEEDINGS
Ericsson and Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications are engaged in multiple patent litigations in the US, UK, Germany and the Netherlands, involving GSM/GPRS/EDGE/WCDMA standards against the Korean
38
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
handset manufacturer Samsung, including proceedings in the US International Trade Commission (ITC) under Section 337 of the Tariff Act of 1930. In ITC, both sides complaints are based on respondents alleged unlawful importation and sales within the United States of products, thataccording to the complainantsinfringe several of their US patents. Ericsson and Sony Ericsson, as well as Samsung, seek exclusion orders to stop respondents importation of such products into the US.
In October 2005, Ericsson filed a complaint to the European Commission requesting that it investigate and stop US-based Qualcomms anti-competitive conduct in the licensing of essential patents for 3G mobile technology. At the same time, Broad-com, NEC, Nokia, Panasonic Mobile Communications and Texas Instruments each filed similar complaints claiming Qualcomm is violating EU competition law and failing to meet the commitments Qualcomm made to international standardization bodies around the world that it would license its technology on fair, reasonable and non-discriminatory terms. In December, 2005, The Commission opened a first-phase investigation. The complainants are still waiting for the Commissions decision to open a second-phase investigation.
Together with most of the mobile communications industry, Ericsson has been named as a defendant in six class action lawsuits in the United States, where plaintiffs alleged that adverse health effects could be associated with the use of mobile phones. In 2006, plaintiffs voluntarily dismissed four of those lawsuits. The two remaining cases are currently pending in the United States District Court for the District of Maryland and the Superior Court of the District of Columbia.
In another suit filed in the US, Freedom Wireless Inc., a technology company, sued Cingular Wireless LLC and Ericsson, claiming the two defendants built their prepaid wireless telephone service on Freedom Wireless patents that allow mobile telephone customers to purchase increments of airtime for any mobile phone.
Ericsson is engaged in litigation with an Australian company, QPSX, in the Federal Court of Australia. QPSXs claim relates to an alleged breach by Ericsson of a patent license agreement. Ericsson has contested the claim.
In December, 2006, the Stockholm City Court acquitted all current or former employees of the Parent Company who had all been indicted by the Swedish National Economics Crimes Bureau for evasion of tax control. The judgment has in part been appealed by the prosecutor.
Swedish fiscal authorities have disallowed, for income tax purposes, the Parent Company and the subsidiary companies Ericsson Telecom AB and Ericsson Radio Systems AB (renamed Ericsson AB) deductions for sales commission payments via external service companies to sales agents in certain countries. Most of these taxes have been paid. The decision covering the fiscal year 1999 was appealed. In December, 2006, the County Administrative Court in Stockholm rendered a judgment in favor of the fiscal authorities.
BOARD OF DIRECTORS
More information regarding the Board of Directors and its members as well as the Board and its committee activities can be found in the Corporate Governance Report.
Changes to the Board membership
The Board of Directors is elected each year at the Annual General Meeting for the period until the next Annual General Meeting. At the Annual General Meeting on April 10, 2006, Michael Treshow was re-elected Chairman of the Board and Marcus Wallenberg Deputy Chairman. Sverker Martin-Löf was also elected Deputy
39
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Chairman. Sir Peter L. Bonfield, Ulf J. Johansson, Nancy McKinstry and Carl-Henric Svanberg were re-elected. Börje Ekholm, Katherine Hudson and Anders Nyrén were elected as new members of the Board of Directors.
Board compensation
Members of the Board, who are not employees of the Company, have not received any compensation other than the fees paid for Board duties as outlined in Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C29, Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management. Members and Deputy Members of the Board, who are employees, i.e. the CEO and the employee representatives, have not received any remuneration or benefits other than their normal employee entitlements, with the exception of a small fee paid to the employee representatives for each Board meeting attended.
PARENT COMPANY
The Parent Company business consists mainly of corporate management, holding company functions and internal banking activities. The Parent Company business also includes customer credit management performed on a commission basis by Ericsson Credit AB.
The Parent Company is the owner of the majority of intellectual property rights and manages the patent portfolio, including patent applications, licensing and cross-licensing of patents and defending of patents in litigations.
The Parent Company has 7 (8) branch offices. In total, the Group has 51 (51) branch and representative offices.
Net sales for the year amounted to SEK 0.6 (1.1) billion and income after financial items was SEK 13.6 (14.0) billion. Exports accounted for 100 percent of net sales in 2006 (96 percent in 2005). No consolidated companies were customers of the Parent Companys sales in 2006 or 2005, while 29 percent (27 percent in 2005) of the Companys total purchases of goods and services were from such companies. Net profits from disposals and write-downs of shares, including Ericsson Microwave Systems AB, contributed SEK 2.9 (6.6) billion to income.
Major changes in the Parent Companys financial position for the year include decreases in current and non-current receivables from subsidiaries of SEK 31.4 billion and decreases in cash and bank and short-term investments of SEK 21.0 billion. Current and non-current liabilities to subsidiaries decreased by SEK 41.9 billion and current maturities of long-term borrowings decreased by SEK 9.7 billion. At year-end, cash and bank and short-term investments amounted to SEK 54.0 (75.0) billion.
In accordance with the conditions of the Stock Purchase Plans and Option Plans for Ericsson employees, 17,051,349 shares from treasury stock were sold or distributed to employees during the year. The quota value of these shares is SEK 17.1 million, representing less than one percent of capital stock, and compensation received amounted to SEK 124.9 million. The holding of treasury stock at December 31, 2006 was 251,013,892 Class B shares. The quota value of these shares is SEK 251.0 million, representing 2 percent of capital stock, and related acquisition cost amounts to SEK 558.6 million.
POST-CLOSING EVENTS
Acquisition of Redback Networks
On December 20, 2006, Ericsson and Redback Networks Inc. (NASDAQ:RBAK) announced the signing of a definitive agreement under which Ericsson would acquire Redback for USD 25.00 per share, or an aggregate price of approximately USD 1.9 billion (SEK 13.4 billion). The acquisition was completed on January 25, 2007.
40
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Redback has over 700 carrier customers in more than 80 countries and employs about 800 people, including 500 R&D engineers. Fifteen of the top 20 network operators worldwide use Redbacks technology, including broadband routers to manage IP-based data, voice and video services. Redback has a strong position in multi-service edge routing technology, which helps carriers deliver broadband, telephony, TV and mobility services over Internet-based infrastructures.
The combination of Redbacks intelligent routing technology and Ericssons leading IMS (IP Multimedia Subsystem), optical transport and broadband access puts Ericsson in a leading position in end-to-end IP solutions for both fixed and mobile operators.
Acquisition of Entrisphere
Ericsson announced on February 12, 2007, the acquisition of Entrisphere, a company providing fiber access technology. Entrisphere was founded in 2000 in Santa Clara, California, and employs about 140 people, including important R&D resources.
The Entrisphere acquisition brings a leading IP-based broadband access platform ready for volume deployment compliant with both North American and international standards.
Since its first deployment of fiber access solution in 2003, Entrisphere has worked with major operators to deliver IP-based services to customers across North America. With its GPON solution (Gigabit Passive Optical Network) already in service in North America and the system being evaluated for deployment by leading network operators around the globe, the acquisition forms an important cornerstone in Ericssons full service broadband offering.
PROPOSED DISPOSITION OF EARNINGS
The Board of Directors proposes that a dividend of SEK 0.50 (0.45) per share be paid to shareholders duly registered on the Record date of April 16, 2007, and that the Company retains the remaining part of non-restricted equity. The Class B treasury shares held by the Parent Company are not entitled to receive a dividend.
Assuming that no treasury shares remain within the Company on the Record date, the Board of Directors proposes that earnings be distributed as follows:
Amount to be paid to the shareholders |
SEK 8,066,129,339 | |
Amount to be retained by the Parent Company |
SEK 24,920,658,097 | |
Total non-restricted equityof the Parent Company |
SEK 32,986,787,436 |
As a basis for its proposal for a dividend, the Board of Directors has made an assessment in accordance with Chapter 18, Section 4 of the Swedish Companies Act of the Parent Companys and the Groups need for financial resources as well as the Parent Companys and the Groups liquidity, financial position in other respects and long-term ability to meet their commitments.
The Group reports an equity ratio of 56.2 (49.0) percent and net cash amounts to SEK 40.7 (50.6) billion.
The Board of Directors has also considered the Parent Companys and the Groups position in general. In this respect, the Board of Directors has taken into account known commitments that may have an impact on the financial positions of the Parent Company and its subsidiaries.
The proposed dividend does not limit the Groups ability to make investments or raise funds and it is our assessment that the proposed dividend is well-balanced considering the nature, scope and risks of the business activities as well as the capital requirements for the Parent Company and the Group.
41
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
To the Shareholders of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (publ),
We have completed an integrated audit of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (publ)s 2006 consolidated financial statements and of its internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2006, and audits of its 2005 and 2004 consolidated financial statements in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Our opinions, based on our audits, are presented below.
Consolidated financial statements
In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheet and the related consolidated income statement, statement of recognized income and expense and cash flow statement present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson and its subsidiaries at December 31, 2006, and December 31, 2005, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2006 in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by EU. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Companys management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our audits of these statements in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit of financial statements includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
As discussed in the accounting policies, note C1, the Group adopted International Accounting Standards (IAS) 32 Financial Instruments: Disclosure and Presentation and IAS 39 Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement in accordance with IFRS as adopted by the EU. The change has been accounted for prospectively from January 1, 2005. Additionally, the Company has adopted the amendment to IAS 19 Employee Benefits as from January 1, 2006, and applied the option for recognition of actuarial gains and losses directly in equity. The option has been applied retrospectively as from January 1, 2004.
International Financial Reporting Standards vary in certain significant respects from accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Information relating to the nature and effect of such differences is presented in C33.
Internal control over financial reporting
Also, in our opinion, managements assessment, included in Managements Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting, appearing under Item 15 (b) of the 2006 Annual Report on Form 20-F, that the Company maintained effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2006, based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO), is fairly stated, in all material respects, based on those criteria. Furthermore, in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December, 31 2006, based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the COSO. The Companys management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting. Our responsibility is to express opinions on managements assessment and on the effectiveness of the
42
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Companys internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We conducted our audit of internal control over financial reporting in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. An audit of internal control over financial reporting includes obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, evaluating managements assessment, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control, and performing such other procedures as we consider necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinions.
A companys internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A companys internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the companys assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
PricewaterhouseCoopers AB
Stockholm, June 7, 2007
43
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Years ended December 31, SEK million |
Notes | 2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
Net sales |
C3, C4 | 177,783 | 151,821 | 131,972 | ||||
Cost of sales |
-104,487 | -82,369 | -70,864 | |||||
Gross margin |
73,296 | 69,452 | 61,108 | |||||
Research and development and other technical expenses |
-27,921 | -24,454 | -23,421 | |||||
Selling and administrative expenses |
-21,422 | -16,800 | -15,921 | |||||
Operating expenses |
-49,343 | -41,254 | -39,342 | |||||
Other operating income |
C6 | 5,941 | 2,491 | 2,617 | ||||
Share in earnings of joint ventures and associated companies |
C12 | 5,934 | 2,395 | 2,323 | ||||
Operating income |
35,828 | 33,084 | 26,706 | |||||
Financial income |
C7 | 1,954 | 2,653 | 3,541 | ||||
Financial expenses |
C7 | -1,789 | -2,402 | -4,081 | ||||
Income after financial items |
35,993 | 33,335 | 26,166 | |||||
Taxes |
C8 | -9,557 | -8,875 | -8,330 | ||||
Net income |
26,436 | 24,460 | 17,836 | |||||
Net income attributable to: |
||||||||
Stockholders of the parent company |
26,251 | 24,315 | 17,539 | |||||
Minority interest |
185 | 145 | 297 | |||||
Other information |
||||||||
Average number of shares, basic (million) |
15,871 | 15,843 | 15,829 | |||||
Earnings per share, basic (SEK) |
C9 | 1.65 | 1.53 | 1.11 | ||||
Earnings per share, diluted (SEK) |
C9 | 1.65 | 1.53 | 1.11 |
44
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
December 31, SEK million |
Notes | 2006 | 2005 1) | |||
ASSETS |
||||||
Non-current assets |
||||||
Intangible assets |
C10 | |||||
Capitalized development expenses |
4,995 | 6,161 | ||||
Goodwill |
6,824 | 7,362 | ||||
Intellectual property rights |
15,649 | 939 | ||||
Property, plant and equipment |
C11, C26, C27 | 7,881 | 6,966 | |||
Financial assets |
C12 | |||||
Equity in joint ventures and associated companies |
9,409 | 6,313 | ||||
Other investments in shares and participations |
721 | 805 | ||||
Customer financing, non-current |
1,921 | 1,322 | ||||
Other financial assets, non-current |
2,409 | 2,796 | ||||
Deferred tax assets |
C8 | 13,564 | 18,519 | |||
63,373 | 51,183 | |||||
Current assets |
||||||
Inventories |
C13 | 21,470 | 19,208 | |||
Trade receivables |
C14 | 51,070 | 41,242 | |||
Customer financing, current |
1,735 | 3,624 | ||||
Other current receivables |
C15 | 15,012 | 12,574 | |||
Short-term investments |
C20 | 32,311 | 39,767 | |||
Cash and cash equivalents |
C20 | 29,969 | 41,738 | |||
151,567 | 158,153 | |||||
Total assets |
214,940 | 209,336 | ||||
EQUITY AND LIABILITIES |
||||||
Equity |
||||||
Stockholders equity |
C16 | 120,113 | 101,622 | |||
Minority interest in equity of subsidiaries |
C16 | 782 | 850 | |||
120,895 | 102,472 | |||||
Non-current liabilities |
||||||
Post-employment benefits |
C17 | 6,968 | 5,891 | |||
Provisions, non-current |
C18 | 602 | 904 | |||
Deferred tax liabilities |
C8 | 382 | 391 | |||
Borrowings, non-current |
C19, C20 | 12,904 | 14,185 | |||
Other non-current liabilities |
2,868 | 2,740 | ||||
23,724 | 24,111 | |||||
Current liabilities |
||||||
Provisions, current |
C18 | 13,280 | 17,764 | |||
Borrowings, current |
C19, C20 | 1,680 | 10,784 | |||
Trade payables |
C22 | 18,183 | 12,584 | |||
Other current liabilities |
C21 | 37,178 | 41,621 | |||
70,321 | 82,753 | |||||
Total equity and liabilities 2) |
214,940 | 209,336 | ||||
1) | Ericsson has adopted the new option in IAS 19 to charge actuarial gains/losses directly to equity, as from January 1, 2006. Earlier periods have been restated accordingly. For further information please see Notes to the consolidated statementsNote C17, Post-employment benefits. |
2) | Of which interest-bearing liabilities and post-employment benefits 21,552 (30,860). |
45
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
Years ended December 31, SEK million |
Notes | 2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
OPERATIONS |
||||||||
Net income attributable to stockholders of the parent company |
26,251 | 24,315 | 17,539 | |||||
Adjustments to reconcile net income to cash |
C25 | 6,245 | 10,845 | 10,490 | ||||
32,496 | 35,160 | 28,029 | ||||||
Operating net assets |
||||||||
Inventories |
-2,553 | -3,668 | -3,432 | |||||
Customer financing, current and non-current |
1,186 | -641 | -65 | |||||
Trade receivables |
-10,563 | -5,874 | -1,403 | |||||
Provisions and post-employment benefits |
-3,729 | -15,574 | -1,990 | |||||
Other operating assets and liabilities, net |
1,652 | 7,266 | 1,340 | |||||
Cash flow from operating activities |
18,489 | 16,669 | 22,479 | |||||
Investing activities |
||||||||
Investments in property, plant and equipment |
C11 | -3,827 | -3,365 | -2,452 | ||||
Sales of property, plant and equipment |
185 | 362 | 358 | |||||
Acquisitions of subsidiaries and other operations |
C26 | -18,078 | -1,210 | -1,648 | ||||
Divestments of subsidiaries and other operations |
C26 | 3,086 | 30 | 14 | ||||
Product development |
C10 | -1,353 | -1,174 | -1,146 | ||||
Other investing activities |
-1,070 | 13 | 86 | |||||
Short-term investments |
6,180 | 6,375 | -26,050 | |||||
Cash flow from investing activities |
-14,877 | 1,031 | -30,838 | |||||
Cash flow before financing activities |
3,612 | 17,700 | -8,359 | |||||
Financing activities |
||||||||
Proceeds from issuance of borrowings |
1,290 | 657 | 1,100 | |||||
Repayment of borrowings |
-9,510 | -2,784 | -15,407 | |||||
Sale of own stock and options exercised |
124 | 174 | 41 | |||||
Dividends paid |
-7,343 | -4,133 | -292 | |||||
Cash flow from financing activities |
-15,439 | -6,086 | -14,558 | |||||
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash |
58 | -288 | 214 | |||||
Net change in cash |
-11,769 | 11,326 | -22,703 | |||||
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period |
41,738 | 30,412 | 53,115 | |||||
Cash and cash equivalents, end of period |
C20 | 29,969 | 41,738 | 30,412 | ||||
46
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF RECOGNIZED INCOME AND EXPENSE
Stock- holders equity |
Minority interest |
2006 | Stock- holders equity |
Minority interest |
2005 1) | Stock- holders equity |
Minority interest |
2004 1) | ||||||||||
Years ended December 31, |
Total equity 2) |
Total equity 2) |
Total equity 2) | |||||||||||||||
Income and expenses recognized directly in equity: |
||||||||||||||||||
Actuarial gains and lossed related to pensions including payroll tax |
440 | | 440 | -3,221 | | -3,221 | -1,059 | | -1,059 | |||||||||
Revaluation of other investments in shares and participations |
||||||||||||||||||
Fair value remeasurement reported in equity |
-2 | 1 | -1 | -3 | | -3 | | | | |||||||||
Transferred to income statement at sale |
| | | -147 | | -147 | | | | |||||||||
Cash Flow hedges: |
||||||||||||||||||
Fair value remeasurement of derivatives reported in equity |
4,100 | | 4,100 | -3,961 | | -3,961 | | | | |||||||||
Transferred to income statement for the period |
-1,990 | | -1,990 | 1,404 | | 1,404 | | | | |||||||||
Transferred to balance sheet for the period |
99 | | 99 | | | | | | | |||||||||
Changes in cumulative translation effects due to changes in foreign currency exchange rates |
-3,028 | -91 | -3,119 | 4,118 | 147 | 4,265 | -1,200 | -65 | -1,265 | |||||||||
Tax on items reported directly in/or transferred from equity |
-769 | | -769 | 1,523 | | 1,523 | 384 | | 384 | |||||||||
Total transactions reported in equity |
-1,150 | -90 | -1,240 | -287 | 147 | -140 | -1,875 | -65 | -1,940 | |||||||||
Net income |
26,251 | 185 | 26,436 | 24,315 | 145 | 24,460 | 17,539 | 297 | 17,836 | |||||||||
Total income and expenses recognized for the period |
25,101 | 95 | 25,196 | 24,028 | 292 | 24,320 | 15,664 | 232 | 15,896 | |||||||||
1) | Ericsson has adopted the new option in IAS 19 to charge actuarial gains/losses to equity, as from January 1, 2006. Earlier periods have been restated accordingly. For further information, please see Notes to the consolidated statementsNote C17, Post-employment benefits. |
2) | For further information, please see Notes to the consolidated statementsNote C16, Equity. |
47
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
C1 SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
The consolidated financial statements comprise Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, the Parent Company, and its subsidiaries (the Company) and the Companys interest in associated companies and joint ventures. The Parent Company is domiciled in Sweden at Torshamnsgatan 23, 164 83 Stockholm.
The consolidated financial statements as at and for the year ended December 31, 2006, have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as endorsed by the EU, RR 30:05 Additional rules for Group Accounting and related interpretations issued by the Swedish Financial Accounting Standards Council (Redovisingsrådet) and the Swedish Annual Accounts Act. For the Company, there is no difference between IFRS and IFRS endorsed by the EU, nor is RR 30:05 or the Swedish Annual Accounts Act in conflict with IFRS.
48
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
The financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors on February 23, 2007. The balance sheets and income statements are subject to approval by the annual general meeting of share-holders.
IFRS differ in certain respects from generally accepted accounting principles in the United States (US GAAP). For a description of major differences with respect to Ericssons financial statements, information will be provided in a separate note Reconciliation to Accounting Principles Generally Accepted in the United States in the annual report on form 20F. The 20F will be filed with SEC in the second quarter of 2007.
Ericsson has applied IFRSs since January 1, 2005. All amounts related to 2004 have been restated in accordance with IFRSs, except for IAS 39, which has been applied as from January 1, 2005, as allowed by IFRS 1.
In 2006, the following amendments to IFRS and new IFRIC:s were adopted:
| IAS 19 Employee Benefits. As from January 1, 2006, the Company has applied the option for recognition of actuarial gains and losses directly in equity. The option has been applied retrospectively as from January 1, 2004. In note C17 Post Employment Benefits, the effect of the application of the option is disclosed. |
| IAS 21 The Effects of Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates. IAS 21 has been amended in relation to the accounting treatment of Net Investments in a Foreign Operation. This amendment has not had a significant impact on the financial position or result. |
| IAS 39 Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement. An amendment to IAS 39 requires a company to include liabilities resulting from financial guarantee contracts in the balance sheet at fair value. This amendment has not had a significant impact on the financial position or result. |
| IFRIC 4 Determining whether an Arrangement contains a Lease. This interpretation has not had a significant impact on the financial position or result. |
| IFRIC 6 Liabilities arising from Participating in a Specific MarketWaste of Electric and Electronical Equipment. This interpretation has not had a significant impact on the financial position or result. |
BASIS OF PRESENTATION
The financial statements are presented in millions of Swedish kronor (SEK). They are prepared on a historical cost basis, except for certain financial assets and liabilities that are stated at fair value; derivative financial instruments, financial instruments held for trading, financial instruments classified as available-for-sale and plan assets related to defined benefit plans. Non-current assets and disposal groups held for sale are stated at the lower of carrying amount and fair value less cost to sell.
PRINCIPLES OF CONSOLIDATION
The consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with the purchase method. Accordingly, consolidated stockholders equity includes equity in subsidiaries, associated companies and joint ventures earned only after their acquisition.
Subsidiaries
The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Parent Company and all subsidiaries and the Companys interest in associated companies and joint ventures. Subsidiaries are all companies in which
49
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Ericsson has an ownership interest and directly or indirectly, including effective potential voting rights, has a voting majority or in which Ericsson by agreement has control of or retains the majority of the residual or ownership risk of the entity. This means that the Company has the power to govern the financial and operating policies generally accompanying a shareholding of more than one half of the voting rights. At acquisitions, consolidation is performed from the date control is transferred. At divestments, deconsolidation is made from the date when control ceases.
Intra-group balances, and any unrealized income and expense arising from intra-group transactions, are fully eliminated in preparing the consolidated financial statements. Unrealized losses are eliminated in the same way as unrealized gains, but only to the extent that there is no evidence of impairment.
Associated companies and joint ventures
Investments in associated companies and joint ventures, where voting stock interest including effective potential voting rights is at least 20 percent but not more than 50 percent, or where a corresponding influence is obtained through agreement, are accounted for according to the equity method. Ericssons share of income before taxes is reported in item Share in earnings of joint ventures and associated companies, included in Operating Income. Taxes are included in item Taxes. Unrealized internal profits in inventory as well as other assets in associated companies and joint ventures purchased from subsidiary companies are eliminated in the consolidated accounts in proportion to ownership. Losses in transactions with associated companies and joint ventures are eliminated in the same way as profit unless there is evidence of impairment.
Also when associated companies and joint ventures sell to the Company, unrealized internal profits and losses occur. Eliminations are made also for these profits and losses.
Undistributed earnings of associated companies and joint ventures included in consolidated equity are reported as Retained earnings, subsequent to acquisition.
BUSINESS COMBINATIONS
At the acquisition of a business, an allocation is made of the cost of the business combination in which fair values are assigned to acquired assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities, for example intangible assets such as customer relations, brands and patents, based upon appraisals made. Goodwill arises when the purchase price exceeds the fair value of recognizable acquired net assets.
As from the acquisition date, goodwill acquired in a business combination is allocated to each of the cash-generating units, or groups of cash-generating units, that are expected to benefit from the synergies of the combination. Corporate assets are allocated to cash-generating units in proportion to each units proportion of net sales. An annual impairment test for the cash-generating units to which goodwill has been allocated is performed in the fourth quarter, or when there is an indication of impairment. An impairment loss is recognized if the carrying amount of the cash-generating unit exceeds its recoverable amount. Impairment losses are recognized in the income statement. Impairment losses recognized in respect of cash-generating units are allocated first to reduce the carrying amount of the goodwill allocated to the units and then to reduce the carrying amounts of the other assets in the unit on a pro rata basis. The recoverable amount of an asset or a cash-generating unit is the greater of its value in use and its fair value less costs to sell. In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows are discount-ed to their present value. An impairment loss in respect of goodwill is not reversed.
50
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
TRANSLATION OF FINANCIAL STATEMENTS IN FOREIGN CURRENCY
For subsidiary companies, joint ventures and associated companies, the functional (business) currency is the currency in which the companies primarily generate and expend cash. Their financial statements plus goodwill related to such companies are translated to SEK by translating assets and liabilities at the closing rate on the balance sheet day and income statement items at average exchange rates, with translation adjustments reported directly in consolidated equity. When a company is disposed of, the corresponding accumulated translation adjustments are recognized in consolidated income.
Effective portions of foreign exchange gains and losses on hedge instruments designated to hedge the net investments in foreign entities are reported directly in consolidated equity, net of tax effects, to offset the translation adjustments above. Ineffective portions of foreign exchange gains and losses are reported in operating income.
REMEASUREMENT OF FOREIGN CURRENCY ITEMS IN INDIVIDUAL COMPANIES
In the financial statements, receivables and liabilities in foreign currencies are measured at year-end exchange rates.
Foreign exchange gains and losses are reported either as operational cost or in financial net. Effects of hedging are reported in the income statement together with the foreign currency exchange gains/losses of the hedged item.
The net difference between foreign exchange gains/losses on operating transactions and gains/losses on hedging through foreign exchange derivatives are reported as adjustments to Cost of sales. Gains and losses on foreign exchange attributable to financial assets are included in financial income and gains and losses related to financial liabilities are included in financial expenses.
IAS 39 was adopted as from January 1, 2005, with early adoption of the amendment related to cash flow hedge accounting of forecast intragroup transactions.
STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
The cash flow statement is prepared according to the indirect method. Cash flows from foreign subsidiaries are translated at the average exchange rate during the period. Subsidiaries purchased and/or sold are reported as cash flow from operating investing activities, net of cash.
Cash and cash equivalents consist of cash, bank and short-term investments and are highly liquid financial instruments that have a remaining maturity of three months or less at the date of acquisition.
REVENUE RECOGNITION
Sales are recorded net of value added taxes, goods returned, trade discounts and rebates. Revenue is recognized with reference to all significant contractual terms when the product or service has been delivered, when the revenue amount is fixed or determinable and when collection is reasonably assured.
We offer a comprehensive portfolio of telecommunication and data communication systems and services covering a range of technologies. The majority of our products and services are sold as parts of contracts including several items. The nature of the products and services being sold, and the contractual terms taken as a whole, determine the appropriate revenue recognition method. The contracts are of four main types:
| delivery-type |
| construction-type |
51
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
| contracts for various types of services, for example multi-year managed services contracts |
| licenses |
Large customer frame agreements may include different types of undertakings and may result in a mix of construction-type contracts, delivery-type contracts and service contracts.
Different revenue recognition methods are applied based on the solutions provided to our customers, the nature and sophistication of the technology involved and the contract conditions in each case. Specific contractual performance and acceptance criteria impact the timing and amounts of revenue recognized.
The profitability of contracts is periodically assessed and provisions for losses are immediately made, with full amounts, when losses are probable.
For delivery-type contracts revenue is recognized when risks and rewards have been transferred to the customer, normally stipulated in contractual terms of trade. For delivery-type contracts that have multiple elements, revenue is allocated to each element based on relative fair values. If there are undelivered elements essential to the functionality of the delivered elements, or, if fair values are not available for all elements, the Company defers the recognition of revenue until all elements essential to the functionality have been delivered or fair values exist for the undelivered elements.
Revenues from construction-type contracts are generally recognized using the percentage-of-completion method. The degree of completion is measured using either the milestone output method or, to a very limited extent, the cost-to-cost method. The terms of construction-type contracts generally define deliverables or milestones for progress billing to the customer, which also well reflect the degree of completion of the contract. In construction-type contracts where the milestone output method is applied, costs incurred pending the completion of milestones are reported as contract work in progress and included in Inventory. Such milestones are in most contracts frequent. The extent to which milestones have been met varies from period to period, and as a consequence the amount of contract work included in inventory may also vary significantly.
Revenue for period service contracts and managed services contracts, covering longer periods is recognized pro rata over the contract period. Revenue for training, consulting, engineering, installation and similar services is generally recognized when the services are provided.
Licenses relate to Mobile platform license revenues which are included in reported Net Sales based on the number of handsets or components produced by the customer. Revenue is recognized when the customer production has been made. License revenues related to third party contracts for utilization of our patents are reported as Other operating revenues.
For sales between consolidated companies, associated companies, joint ventures and segments we apply arms length pricing.
EARNINGS PER SHARE
Basic earnings per share are calculated by dividing net income attributable to shareholders of the parent company by the average number of shares outstanding (total number of shares less treasury stock) during the year.
Diluted earnings per share are calculated by dividing net income attributable to shareholders of the parent company by the sum of the average number of ordinary shares outstanding and dilutive potential ordinary shares. Potential ordinary shares are treated as dilutive when, and only when, this reduces earnings per share.
52
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
CLASSIFICATION AND MEASUREMENT OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
IAS 39 was adopted as from January 1, 2005, with early adoption of the amendment related to cash flow hedge accounting of forecast intragroup transactions.
| Short-term investments are measured at fair value through profit or loss. |
| Investments in equity instruments are recognized at fair value. Subsequent changes in fair value are recognized in equity, adjusted for impairment, which is recognized in the income statement. |
| Loans and borrowings are recognized at fair value, net of transaction costs incurred. Subsequently, loans and borrowings are measured using the amortized cost method less impairment. |
| All derivatives are recognized at fair value. Subsequent changes in fair value of derivatives are recognized in the income statement, unless the derivative is a hedging instrument in |
i) | a cash flow hedge of a highly probable forecasted transaction. The effective portion of fair value changes of the derivative is recognized in equity until the hedged transaction affects the income statement, at which moment the accumulated deferred amount in equity is recycled to the income statement. |
ii) | a cash flow hedge of a highly probable forecasted transaction that result in the recognition of a non-financial asset or liability. The effective portion of fair value changes of the derivative is recognized in equity until the hedged transaction affects the balance sheet, at which moment the accumulated deferred amount in equity is included in the initial measurement of the acquisition cost of the asset or liability |
iii) | a hedge of a net investment in a foreign operation. The effective portion of fair value changes of the derivative is recognized in equity until the hedged investment affects the income statement, at which moment the accumulated deferred amount in equity is recycled to the income statement. |
| For derivatives assigned as fair value hedges, fair value changes of both the derivative and the hedged item, attributable to the hedged risk, are recognized in the income statement and offset each other to the extent the hedge is effective. The Company only applies fair value hedge accounting for hedging fixed interest risk on borrowings. |
| Ericssons listed debt instruments (outstanding notes and bond loans) are measured at amortized cost, unless designated as a hedged item in a fair value hedge, when its hedged risk is measured at fair value. |
A financial instrument is recognized if the Company becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the instrument. Regular purchases and sales of financial assets are recognized on settlement date. Investments are initially recognized at fair value plus transaction costs for all financial assets not carried at fair value through profit or loss. Financial assets carried at fair value through profit or loss are initially recognized at fair value, and transaction costs are expensed in the income statement. Financial assets are derecognized when the rights to receive cash flows from the investments have expired or have been transferred and the Group has transferred substantially all risks and rewards of ownership. Financial liabilities are derecognized when they are extinguished.
Foreign exchange gains and losses on operating assets and liabilities are reported as adjustments to Cost of sales. The corresponding reporting for financial items is credited/charged to financial income and expenses respectively.
Gains and losses on derivatives held to offset balance sheet items are reported together with losses and gains on the underlying position.
53
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Financial assets and liabilities are offset and reported net in the balance sheet when there is a legally enforceable right for offset and there is an intent to settle on a net basis.
Fair values of financial instruments are based on quoted market prices or rates. If official rates or market prices are not available, fair values are calculated by discounting the expected future cash flows at prevailing interest rates.
Each balance sheet date, the Company assesses whether there is objective evidence that a financial asset or a group of financial assets is impaired. In the case of equity securities with changes in fair value recognized in equity, a significant or prolonged decline in the fair value of the security below its cost is considered an indicator that the security is impaired. If any such evidence exists for these financial assets, the cumulative lossmeasured as the difference between the acquisition cost and the current fair value, less any impairment loss on that financial asset previously recognized in profit or lossis removed from equity and recognized in the income statement. Impairment losses recognized in the income statement on equity instruments are not reversed.
RECEIVABLES AND CUSTOMER FINANCING
Receivables are initially recognized at fair value and subsequently measured at amortized cost, less allowances for impairment charges. Impairment of receivables is assessed when there is objective evidence that the Company will not be able to collect all amounts due according to the original contractual terms. Significant financial difficulties of the debtor, probability that the debtor will enter bankruptcy or financial reorganization, and default or delinquency in payments are considered indicators that the trade receivable is impaired. The amount of the allowance is the difference between the assets carrying amount and the present value of estimated future cash flows, discounted at the effective interest rate at inception. The amount of the provision is recognized in the income statement within selling expenses.
When selling receivables, they are derecognized if substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership of the receivable have been transferred. Separate assets or liabilities are recognized if any rights and obligations are created or retained in the transfer.
Collectibility of the receivables are assessed for purposes of initial revenue recognition. In instances where the exposures are related to guarantees to third parties for customer financing, we have reported the extent of our exposure as contingent liabilities. These contingent liabilities are reported net of risk provisions.
FINANCIAL GUARANTEES
Financial guarantee contracts are initially recognized at fair value (i.e usually the fee received). Subsequently, these contracts are measured at the higher of
| the amount determined as the best estimate of the expenditure required to settle the obligation according to the guarantee contract, and |
| the recognized fee less cumulative amortization when amortized over the guaranteed period using the straight line method. |
INVENTORIES
Inventories are measured at the lower of cost or net realizable value on a first-in, first-out (FIFO) basis.
Risks of obsolescence have been measured by estimating market value based on future customer demand and changes in technology and customer acceptance of new products.
54
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
INTANGIBLE ASSETS OTHER THAN GOODWILL
These assets consist of capitalized development expenses and acquired intangible assets, such as patents, customer relations, brands and software, and are stated at cost less accumulated amortization/impairment. Amortization and any impairment losses are included in Research and development and other technical expenses, mainly for capitalized development expenses and patents, Selling and administrative expenses, mainly for customer relations and brands, and Cost of sales.
Costs incurred for development of products to be sold, leased or otherwise marketed or intended for internal use are capitalized as from when technological and economical feasibility has been established until the product is available for sale or use. These capitalized costs are mainly generated internally and include direct labor and related overhead. Amortization of capitalized development costs begins when the product is available for general release. Amortization is made on a product or platform basis according to the straight-line method over periods not exceeding five years. Research and development costs directly related to orders from customers are accounted for as a part of Cost of sales. Other research and development costs are charged to expense as incurred.
Amortization of acquired intangible assets, mainly intellectual property rights, is made according to the straight-line method over the useful life, normally not exceeding ten years.
The Company has not recognized any intangible assets with indefinite lifetime other than goodwill.
Impairment tests are performed on a regular basis whenever there is an indication of possible impairment. However, intangible assets not yet available for use are tested annually. An impairment loss is recognized if the carrying amount of an asset or its cash-generating unit exceeds its recoverable amount. The recoverable amount is the higher of its value in use and its fair value less costs to sell. In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows are discounted to their present value using a pre-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the asset. Corporate assets have been allocated to cash-generating units in relation to each units proportion of total net sales. Impairment losses recognized in prior periods are assessed at each reporting date for any indications that the loss has decreased or no longer exists. An impairment loss is reversed if there has been a change in the estimates used to determine the recoverable amount, An impairment loss is reversed only to the extent that the assets carrying amount does not exceed the carrying amount that would have been determined, net of amortization, if no impairment loss had been recognized.
PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT
Items of property, plant and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and impairment losses.
Depreciation is charged to income, generally on a straight-line basis, over the estimated useful life of each part of an item of property, plant and equipment. Estimated useful lives are, in general, 40 years for buildings, 20 years for land improvements, 3 to 10 years for machinery and equipment, and up to 5 years for rental equipment. Depreciation and any impairment are included in Cost of sales, Research and development and other technical expenses and Selling and administrative expenses.
Impairment testing is performed in the same manner as for Intangible assets other than goodwill as well as recognition or reversal of impairment, see description under Intangible assets other than goodwill above.
55
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
LEASING
Leasing when the Company is the lessee
Leases on terms in which the Company assumes substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership are classified as finance leases. Upon initial recognition, the leased asset is measured at an amount equal to the lower of its fair value and the present value of the minimum lease payments. Subsequent to initial recognition, the asset is accounted for in accordance with the accounting policy applicable to that asset, although the depreciation period would not exceed the lease term. Other leases are operating leases, and the leased assets under such contracts are not recognized on the balance sheet.
Costs under operating leases are recognized in the income statement on a straight-line bases over the term of the lease. Lease incentives received are recognized as an integral part of the total lease expense, over the term of the lease.
Leasing when the Company is the lessor
Leasing contracts with the Company as lessor are classified as finance leases when the majority of risks and rewards are transferred to the lessee, and otherwise as operating leases. Under a finance lease, a receivable is recognized at an amount equal to the net investment in the lease and revenue recognized in accordance with the revenue recognition principles.
Under operating leases, an item of property, plant and equipment is reported and revenue as well as depreciation are recognized on a straight-line basis over the lease term.
INCOME TAXES
Income taxes in the consolidated financial statements include both current and deferred taxes. Income taxes are reported in the income statement unless the underlying item is reported directly in equity. For those items the related income tax is also reported directly in equity. A current tax liability or asset is recognized for the estimated taxes payable or refundable for the current year or prior years.
Deferred tax assets are recognized for (i) deductible temporary differences between the book values of assets and liabilities and their tax values and (ii) unutilized tax loss carryforwards. A deferred tax asset is recognized to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profits will be available against which the temporary differences can be utilized. Temporary differences related to the following are not provided for: goodwill not deductible for tax purposes, the initial recognition of assets or liabilities that affect neither accounting nor taxable profit, and differences related to investments in subsidiaries to the extent that they will probably not reverse in the foreseeable future.
The valuation of deferred tax assets involves assumptions regarding the deductibility of costs not yet subject to taxation and regarding sufficient future taxable income to enable utilization of unused tax losses in different tax jurisdictions. All deferred tax assets are subject to annual review of probable utilization. The largest amounts of tax loss carryforwards are in Sweden, with indefinite period of utilization.
Deferred tax is measured at the tax rate that is expected to be applied to the temporary differences when they reverse, based on the tax laws that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the reporting date. An adjustment of deferred tax asset/liability balances due to a change in the tax rate is recognized in the income statement unless it relates to a temporary difference earlier recognized directly in equity, in which case the adjustment is also recognized in equity.
56
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
PROVISIONS
Provisions are made when there are legal or constructive obligations as a result of past events and when it is probable that an outflow of resources will be required to settle the obligations and the amounts can be reliably estimated. However, the actual outflow as a result of the obligation may differ from such estimate.
The provisions mainly relate to warranty commitments, restructuring, customer financing guarantees and other obligations, such as litigation obligations, contractual discounts, customer contract loss provisions, penalties or claims as well as unresolved income tax and value added tax issues.
In the ordinary course of business, the company is subject to proceedings, lawsuits and other unresolved claims, including proceedings under laws and government regulations and other matters. These matters are often resolved over long periods of time. We regularly assess the likelihood of any adverse judgments in or outcomes of these matters, as well as potential ranges of possible losses. Provisions are recognized when it is probable that a liability has been incurred and the amount of the loss can be reasonably estimated based on a detailed analysis of each individual issue.
For losses on customer contracts we record provisions when a loss from a contract is anticipated and possible to estimate reliably. We provide for the estimated future settlements related to patent infringements based on the probable outcome of each infringement. The ultimate outcome or actual cost of settling an individual infringement may vary from our estimate. We estimate the outcome of any potential patent infringement made known to us through assertion and through our own monitoring of patent-related cases in the relevant legal systems. To the extent that we determine that an identified potential infringement will more probably than not result in an outflow of resources, we record a provision based on our best estimate of the expenditure required to settle infringement proceedings.
At various intervals, we give our suppliers and/or subcontractors forecasts of expected purchases and also sometimes commit to minimum purchase levels during a certain period. The agreements often include compensation clauses for the event that material deviations from original plans regarding production volumes or product mix should occur. As a result of actual deviations from committed purchase levels or of received actual claims from these suppliers and/or subcontractors, we make provisions for estimated compensation to such suppliers and/or subcontractors. Additionally, provisions are estimated and accrued for charges as a result of known changes in design specifications that are provided to production subcontractors. Amounts for provisions and subsequent net amounts at settlements are charged to the corresponding item in the income statement, i.e. costs related to component suppliers, production subcontractors and installation subcontractors are included in Cost of sales. Costs regarding development subcontractors are included in Research & development and other technical expenses, and costs related to IT-providers and other services are included in operating expenses or Cost of sales depending on the nature of the service. Such provisions are monitored closely on a regular basis, with any additions/reversals charged or credited to the same account as the initial provision.
POST-EMPLOYMENT BENEFITS
Pensions and other post-employment benefits are classified as either defined contribution plans or defined benefit plans. Under a defined contribution plan, the Companys only obligation is to pay a fixed amount to a separate entity (a fund), and will have no obligation to pay further contributions if the fund does not hold sufficient assets to pay all employee benefits. The related actuarial and investment risks fall on the employee. The expenditures for defined contribution plans are recognized as costs during the period when the employee provides service. Under a defined benefit plan it is the Companys obligation to provide agreed benefits to current and former employees. The related actuarial and investment risks fall on the Company.
57
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
The present value of the defined benefit obligations for current and former employees is calculated using the Projected Unit Credit Method. The discount rate for each country is determined by reference to market yields on high-quality corporate bonds that have maturity dates approximating the terms of the Companys obligations. In countries where there is no deep market in such bonds, the market yields on government bonds are used. The calculations are based upon actuarial assumptions and are as a minimum prepared annually. Actuarial assumptions are the Companys best estimate of the variables that determine the cost of providing the benefits. When using actuarial assumptions, it is possible that the actual result will differ from the estimated result. These differences are reported as actuarial gains and losses. They are for example caused by unexpectedly high or low rates of employee turnover, changed life expectancy, salary changes, changes in the discount rate and differences between actual and expected return on plan assets. Actuarial gains and losses are recognized in equity in the period in which they occur. The Companys net commitment for each defined benefit plan consists of the present value of pension commitments less the fair value of plan assets and is recognized net on the balance sheet. When the result is a benefit to the Company, the recognized asset is limited to the total of any cumulative past service cost and the present value of any future refunds from the plan or reductions in future contribution to the plan.
The net of return on plan assets and interest on pension liabilities is reported as financial income or expense, while the current service cost and any other items in the annual pension cost are reported as operating income or expense.
Pension cost calculated according to IAS 19 differs from pension cost calculated according to Swedish GAAP. A special payroll tax is calculated on the difference between IAS 19 and local practice. Payroll taxes are recorded as other current liabilities and are recognized as cost in the income statement. Payroll tax related to actuarial gains and losses are reported in equity together with the recognition of actuarial gains and losses.
SHARE-BASED EMPLOYEE COMPENSATION
Share based compensation only relates to remuneration to employees, including key management personnel.
Stock option plans
Ericsson has chosen not to apply IFRS 2 to equity instruments granted before November 7, 2002, in accordance with IFRS 1 and IFRS 2.
IFRS 2 is applied for one employee equity settled option program granted after November 7, 2002. The vesting period for this program ended during 2005, and Ericsson recognized compensation costs representing the fair value at grant date of the outstanding employee options. In the balance sheet the corresponding amounts are accounted for as equity. The fair value of the options was calculated using an option-pricing model. The total costs were recognized during the vesting period (3 years), i.e. the period during which the employees had to fulfill vesting requirements. When the options are exercised, social security charges are to be paid in certain countries on the value of the employee benefit; generally based on the difference between the market price of the share and the strike price. Such social security charges are accrued during the vesting period.
Stock purchase plans
For stock purchase plans, compensation costs are recognized during the vesting period, based on the fair value of the Ericsson share at the employees investment date. The fair value is based upon the share price at investment date adjusted for that no dividends will be received on matching shares prior to matching. The employees pay a price equal to the share price at investment date for the investment shares. The investment date is considered as the grant date. In the balance sheet the corresponding amounts are accounted for as equity. Vesting conditions are
58
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
non-market based and affect the number of shares that Ericsson will match. For shares under performance-based matching programs, the Company assesses the probability of meeting the performance targets when calculating the compensation costs. Compensation expenses are based on estimates of the number of shares that will match at the end of the vesting period. When shares are matched, social security charges are to be paid in certain countries on the value of the employee benefit. The employee benefit is generally based on the market value of the shares at the matching date. During the vesting period, estimated such social security charges are accrued.
SEGMENT REPORTING
Financial information is provided to the Board for both primary and secondary segments. These segments are subject to risks and returns that are different from those of other segments.
Primary segments
Ericsson has the following business segments:
| Systems, addressing operators of mobile and fixed public telephone networks. In this segment is included since January 1, 2006, businesses acquired from Marconi. |
| Phones, addressing distributors of mobile handsets to end users. Financial information for this segment consists of our investment in and share in earnings of Sony Ericsson. |
| Other Operations, which consists of a number of different operations addressing different types of customers. Each included operation represents, however, less than 10 percent of total net sales and is therefore considered too small to be reported separately. Included operations are: Network Technologies, Enterprise Systems, Mobile Platform Technology, Power Modules and other. As per September 1, 2006, the major part of the Defense operations was sold and revenue and costs are included in Other operations until that date. |
When determining our business segments, we have looked at which market and to what type of customers our products are aimed, and through what distribution channels they are sold, as well as to commonality regarding technology, research and development. The Systems segment is regarded as one business segment, where the business units Access, Systems, Global Services and Broadband Networks represent different product lines. This is due to the close technical relation between included productsthey are all integrated components in public telecommunications networks for fixed or mobile communication, subject to common technical systems standards, e.g. GSM, TDMA, CDMA and WCDMAand due to the common supply and sales through our own sales organization to operators of public networks, with contracts that as a rule include a mix of products and services from several product lines as well as installation.
Our second segment, Phones, is carried out through a joint venture with Sony and develops and sells handsets for mobile telecommunications to distributors.
Our segment Other Operations is composed of a number of smaller operating units, each too small to be reported individually as a separate segment, and each with different characteristics in terms of products, customers and distribution channels.
Secondary segments
Ericsson operates in five main geographical areas: (1) Western Europe, (2) Central and Eastern Europe, Middle East and Africa, (3) Asia Pacific, (4) North America and (5) Latin America. These areas represent our geographical segments.
59
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
BORROWING COSTS
The Company does not capitalize any borrowing costs. These costs are expensed as incurred.
NON-CURRENT ASSETS HELD FOR SALE
Non-current assets held for sale are measured at the lower of carrying amount and fair value less cost to sell. At present, the amounts related to assets held for sale are insignificant.
GOVERNMENT GRANTS
Government grants are recognized when there is a reasonable assurance of compliance with conditions attached to the grants and that the grants will be received.
For Ericsson, government grants are linked to performance of research or development work or to subsidized capital expenditures as governmental stimulus to employment or investments in a certain country or region. Government grants linked to research and development are normally deducted in reporting the related expense whereas grants related to assets are accounted for deducting the grant in arriving at the carrying amount of the asset.
NEW OR AMENDED STANDARDS (IAS/IFRS)
The new or amended standards relate to changes in disclosure or presentation and will therefore have no impact on financial result or position.
| IFRS 7, Financial Instruments: Disclosures, and a complementary amendment to IAS 1, Presentation of Financial StatementsCapital Disclosures (effective from January 1, 2007). IFRS 7 introduces new disclosure requirements to improve the information about financial instruments. |
The amendment to IAS 1 introduces disclosures about the level of an entitys capital and how it manages capital. The Company will apply IFRS 7 and the amendment to IAS 1 from annual periods beginning January 1, 2007.
| IFRS 8 Operating Segments. This standard prescribes measurement and presentation of segments and replaces IAS 14 Segment reporting. An entity shall apply this IFRS in its annual financial statements for periods beginning on or after January 1, 2009. The Company plans to apply this new standard as from January 1, 2009. |
NEW INTERPRETATIONS (IFRIC:s)
None of the new IFRIC:s are expected to have a significant impact on financial result or position.
The following IFRIC:s shall be applied as from January 1, 2007:
| IFRIC Interpretation 7 Applying the Restatement Approach under IAS 29 Financial Reporting in Hyperinflationary Economies. This Interpretation provides guidance on how to apply the requirements of IAS 29 in a reporting period in which an entity identifies the existence of hyperinflation in the economy of its functional currency. |
| IFRIC Interpretation 8 Scope of IFRS 2. This interpretation applies to transactions when the identifiable consideration received appears to be less than the fair value of the equity instruments granted. |
60
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
| IFRIC Interpretation 9 Reassessment of Embedded Derivatives. Determines when an entity shall reassess the need for an embedded derivative to be separated. |
| IFRIC Interpretation 10 Interim Financial Reporting and Impairment. An entity shall not reverse an impairment loss recognized in a previous interim period in respect of goodwill or an investment in either an equity instrument or a financial asset carried at cost. |
The following IFRIC:s shall be applied as from January 1, 2008:
| IFRIC Interpretation 11 IFRS 2Group and Treasury Share Transactions. This interpretation addresses issues in relation to such transactions when grants to equity instruments of the entity are made to employees and treatment of these grants in individual companies. |
| IFRIC Interpretation 12 Service Concession Arrangements. This Interpretation gives guidance on the accounting by operators for public-to-private service concession arrangements. |
C2 CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES AND JUDGMENTS
The preparation of financial statements and application of accounting standards often involve managements judgment or the use of estimates and assumptions deemed to be reasonable and prudent at the time they are made. However, other results may be derived using different assumptions or estimates and outcomes may occur within the next financial year that could require a material adjustment to the carrying amount of the asset or liability affected. Following are the accounting policies subject to such estimates or assumptions that we believe could have the most significant impact on our reported results and financial position.
REVENUE RECOGNITION
Parts of our sales is generated from large and complex customer contracts. Managerial judgment is applied regarding, among other aspects, contractual performance, estimated total contract costs, degree of completion and conformance with acceptance criteria to determine the amounts of revenue to be recognized and any loss provisions to be made.
INVENTORY VALUATION
Inventories are valued at the lower of cost or net realizable value. Total inventory reserves as of December 31, 2006 amount to SEK 2.6 (2.5) billion or 12 (13) percent of gross inventory. Of the total inventory of SEK 21.5 (19.2) billion, SEK 10.6 (11.6) billion is contract work in progress and SEK 10.9 (7.6) billion is mainly related to components and finished goods. For the contract work in progress inventory, risks are related to the judgements made in relation to revenue recognition, while for the component and finished goods parts, the inventory risks are more related to technological obsolescence and estimates of net realizable values.
DEFERRED TAXES
Deferred tax assets are recognized for temporary differences between reported and taxable income and for unutilized tax loss carryforwards. The largest amounts of tax loss carry-forwards are in Sweden, with an indefinite period of utilization (i.e. with no expiry date). The valuation of tax loss carryforwards and our ability to utilize tax losses is based upon our estimates of future taxable income in different tax jurisdictions and involves assumptions regarding the deductibility of costs not yet subject to taxation.
At December 31, 2006, the value of unutilized tax loss carryforwards amounted to SEK 23,1 (28,0) billion. The deferred tax amounts related to loss carry-forwards are reported as non-current assets.
61
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
ACCOUNTING FOR INCOME-, VALUE ADDED- AND OTHER TAXES
Accounting for these items is based upon evaluation of income, value added tax rules and other taxes in all jurisdictions where we perform activities. The total complexity of all rules related to taxes and the accounting for these require managements involvement in estimates and judgments of probable outcomes.
CAPITALIZED DEVELOPMENT COSTS
Development costs for products that will be sold, leased or otherwise marketed as well as those intended for internal use are capitalized. The starting point for capitalization is based upon managements judgment that technological and economical feasibility is confirmed, usually when a product development project has reached a defined milestone according to an established project management model. Capitalization ceases and amortization of capitalized development amounts begins when the product is available for general use. Impairment testing is performed thereafter whenever there is an indication of impairment. Intangible assets not yet available for use are tested annually. The definition of amortization period as well as evaluation of future cash flows also requires managements judgment.
At December 31, 2006, the amount of capitalized development costs amounted to SEK 5.0 (6.1) billion.
INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS AND OTHER ACQUIRED INTANGIBLE ASSETS, OTHER THAN GOODWILL
At initial recognition, future cash flows are calculated, ensuring that the initial carrying values do not exceed the discounted cash flows for the items of this type of assets. Impairment tests are made sub-sequent to initial recognition whenever there is an indication of impairment. At initial recognition and subsequent measurement, management judgements are made, both for assumptions and outcomes of calculations.
At December 31, 2006, the amount of intellectual property rights and other acquired intangible assets, other than goodwill amounted to SEK 15.6 (0.9) billion.
PROVISIONS
Valuation of receivables and exposures in customer financing
We monitor the financial stability of our customers and the environment in which they operate to evaluate the likelihood that the individual receivables will be paid. Total allowances for doubtful accounts as of December 31, 2006, were SEK 1.4 (1.4) billion or 2.7 (3.4) percent of our gross trade receivables.
We regularly assess the credit risk, and based on these assessments we record provisions for outstanding customer financing credits and contingent liabilities, i.e. third party credits under our guarantees. These risk provisions are included in Selling and administrative expenses.
Warranty commitments
Provisions for product warranties are based on historic quality rates as well as assumptions on estimated quality rates for new products and costs to remedy the various types of faults predicted. Total provisions for product warranties as of December 31, 2006, amounted to SEK 3.0 (4.8) billion.
62
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Pension and other post-employment benefits
Accounting for the costs of defined benefit pension plans and other applicable post-employment benefits is based on actuarial valuations, relying on key assumptions for discount rates, expected return on plan assets, future salary increases, turnover rates and mortality tables. The discount rate assumptions are based on rates for high-quality fixed-income investments with durations similar to our pension plans. Expected return on plan assets consider long-term historical returns, allocation of assets and estimates of future long-term investment returns. At December 31, 2006, provisions for pensions and other post-employment benefits amounted to net SEK 6.1 (5.4) billion.
Other provisions
Other provisions are mainly comprised of contractual obligations and penalties with most of the rest for risks associated with patent and other litigations, contractual discounts of uncertain timing or amount, supplier or subcontractor claims and/or disputes, as well as provisions for income tax and value added tax unresolved issues and estimated losses on customer contracts. The nature and type of risks for these provisions differ and judgments related to them receive special attention from the management. At December 31, 2006, Other provisions amounted to SEK 8.6 (11.5) billion.
HEDGE ACCOUNTING AND FOREIGN EXCHANGE RISKS
Foreign exchange risk in highly probable sales in future periods are hedged using foreign exchange derivative instruments designated as cash-flow hedges.
Establishing highly probable sales volumes involves gathering and evaluating sales forecasts for future periods as well as analyzing actual outcome on a regular basis in order to fulfill effectiveness testing requirements for hedge accounting. Deviations in outcome of sales might result in that the requirements for hedge accounting are not fulfilled.
63
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
BUSINESS SEGMENTS (PRIMARY)
2006 |
Systems | Phones | Other operations |
Unallocated | Eliminations | Group | ||||||||||
Net sales |
167,570 | | 10,213 | | | 177,783 | ||||||||||
Inter-segment sales |
141 | | 1,376 | | 1,517 | | ||||||||||
Total net sales |
167,711 | | 11,589 | | 1,517 | 177,783 | ||||||||||
Share in earnings of JV and associated companies |
65 | 5,852 | 17 | | | 5,934 | ||||||||||
Operating income |
26,824 | 5,852 | 895 | 2,257 | 5) | | 35,828 | |||||||||
Operating margin (%) |
16 | % | | 8 | % | | | 20 | % | |||||||
Financial income |
1,954 | |||||||||||||||
Financial expenses |
1,789 | |||||||||||||||
Income after financial items |
35,993 | |||||||||||||||
Taxes |
9,557 | |||||||||||||||
Net income |
26,436 | |||||||||||||||
Net income attributable to: |
||||||||||||||||
stockholders of the parent company |
26,251 | |||||||||||||||
minority interest |
185 | |||||||||||||||
Assets 1) 2) |
119,453 | | 8,463 | 77,615 | | 205,531 | ||||||||||
Equity in joint ventures and associated companies |
1,106 | 8,041 | 262 | | | 9,409 | ||||||||||
Total assets |
120,559 | 8,041 | 8,725 | 77,615 | | 214,940 | ||||||||||
Liabilities 3) 4) |
60,003 | | 3,962 | 30,080 | | 94,045 | ||||||||||
1) | Segment assets include property, plant and equipment, intangible assets, current and non-current customer financing, accounts receivable, inventory, prepaid expenses, accrued revenues, derivatives and other current assets. |
2) | Unallocated assets include mainly cash and cash equivalents, short-term investments and deferred tax assets. |
3) | Segment liabilities include accounts payable, provisions, accrued expenses and deferred revenues, advances from customers and other current liabilities. |
4) | Unallocated liabilities include accrued interests, tax liabilities, interest-bearing liabilities and post-employment benefits. |
5) | Unallocated operating income includes the effect of the divesture of the Defense business by SEK 2,963 million. |
64
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Other segment items
2006 |
Systems | Phones | Other operations |
Unallocated | Eliminations | Group | |||||||
Property, plant and equipment and intangible assets |
|||||||||||||
Additions/capitalization |
20,888 | 1) | | 1,207 | | | 22,095 | ||||||
Depreciation |
-2,874 | | -132 | -1 | | -3,007 | |||||||
Amortization |
-3,991 | | -209 | 37 | | -4,237 | |||||||
Impairment, net of reversals |
-225 | | -47 | | | -272 | |||||||
Restructuring expenses |
-2,908 | | | | | -2,908 | |||||||
Gains/losses from divestments |
| | 2,963 | -18 | | 2,945 | |||||||
Number of employees |
59,484 | | 4,297 | | | 63,781 |
1) | Of which related to the Marconi acquisition SEK 15.4 billion. |
GEOGRAPHICAL SEGMENTS (SECONDARY)
2006 |
Net sales | Total assets | Additions/ PP&E and intangible assets |
Number of employees | ||||
Western Europe |
51,938 | 158,773 | 20,653 | 38,432 | ||||
of which Sweden |
6,566 | 125,578 | 17,819 | 19,094 | ||||
Central and Eastern Europe, Middle East and Africa |
50,301 | 8,598 | 151 | 6,325 | ||||
Asia Pacific |
43,202 | 24,394 | 415 | 10,388 | ||||
of which China |
11,766 | 9,088 | 206 | 3,938 | ||||
North America |
15,862 | 10,893 | 798 | 4,138 | ||||
of which United States |
13,873 | 10,231 | 739 | 2,582 | ||||
Latin America |
16,480 | 12,282 | 78 | 4,498 | ||||
Total |
177,783 | 214,940 | 22,095 | 63,781 | ||||
of which EU |
55,888 | 159,310 | 20,709 | 39,818 | ||||
65
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
BUSINESS SEGMENTS (PRIMARY)
2005 |
Systems | Phones | Other operations |
Unallocated5) | Eliminations | Group5) | |||||||||
Net sales |
141,986 | | 9,835 | | | 151,821 | |||||||||
Inter-segment sales |
113 | | 1,061 | | -1,174 | | |||||||||
Total net sales |
142,099 | | 10,896 | | -1,174 | 151,821 | |||||||||
Share in earnings of JV and associated companies |
118 | 2,257 | 20 | | | 2,395 | |||||||||
Operating income |
30,885 | 2,257 | 283 | -341 | | 33,084 | |||||||||
Operating margin (%) |
22 | % | | 3 | % | | | 22 | % | ||||||
Financial income |
2,653 | ||||||||||||||
Financial expenses |
-2,402 | ||||||||||||||
Income after financial items |
33,335 | ||||||||||||||
Taxes |
-8,875 | ||||||||||||||
Net income |
24,460 | ||||||||||||||
Net income attributable to: |
|||||||||||||||
stockholders of the parent company |
24,315 | ||||||||||||||
minority interest |
145 | ||||||||||||||
Assets1) 2) |
85,958 | | 10,541 | 106,524 | | 203,023 | |||||||||
Equity in joint ventures and associated companies |
1,185 | 5,044 | 84 | | | 6,313 | |||||||||
Total assets |
87,143 | 5,044 | 10,625 | 106,524 | | 209,336 | |||||||||
Liabilities3) 4) |
60,670 | | 6,461 | 39,733 | | 106,864 | |||||||||
1) | Segment assets include property, plant and equipment, intangible assets, current and non-current customer financing, accounts receivable, inventory, prepaid expenses, accrued revenues, derivatives and other current assets. |
2) | Unallocated assets include mainly cash and cash equivalents, short-term investments and deferred tax assets. |
3) | Segment liabilities include accounts payable, provisions, accrued expenses and deferred revenues, advances from customers and other current liabilities. |
4) | Unallocated liabilities include accrued interests, tax liabilities, interest-bearing liabilities and post-employment benefits. |
5) | Ericsson has adopted the option in IAS 19 to recognize actuarial gains or losses directly to equity, and year 2005 figures have been restated accordingly. |
66
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Other segment items
2005 |
Systems | Phones | Other operations |
Unallocated5) | Eliminations | Group5) | ||||||
Property, plant and equipment and intangible assets |
||||||||||||
Additions/capitalization |
5,166 | | 438 | | | 5,604 | ||||||
Depreciation |
-2,676 | | -127 | -1 | | -2,804 | ||||||
Amortization |
-2,976 | | -377 | 84 | | -3,269 | ||||||
Impairment, net of reversals |
271 | | | | | 271 | ||||||
Number of employees |
50,107 | | 5,948 | | | 56,055 |
GEOGRAPHICAL SEGMENTS (SECONDARY)
2005 |
Net sales | Total assets2) | Additions/ capitalization of PP&E and intangible assets |
Number of employees | ||||
Western Europe |
41,940 | 154,159 | 4,565 | 35,679 | ||||
of which Sweden |
6,110 | 133,448 | 3,502 | 21,178 | ||||
Central and Eastern Europe, Middle East and Africa1) |
40,911 | 7,891 | 113 | 4,533 | ||||
Asia Pacific1) |
30,463 | 20,290 | 285 | 8,550 | ||||
of which China |
11,544 | 8,964 | 123 | 3,601 | ||||
North America |
19,432 | 13,754 | 552 | 3,911 | ||||
of which United States |
17,904 | 12,988 | 453 | 2,113 | ||||
Latin America |
19,075 | 13,242 | 89 | 3,382 | ||||
Total |
151,821 | 209,336 | 5,604 | 56,055 | ||||
of which EU |
45,288 | 154,075 | 4,628 | 36,482 |
1) | Restated for change of geographical segment for Pakistan. |
2) | Ericsson has adopted the option in IAS 19 to recognize actuarial gains or losses directly to equity, and year 2005 figures have been restated accordingly. |
67
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
BUSINESS SEGMENTS (PRIMARY)
2004 |
Systems | Phones | Other operations |
Unallocated | Eliminations | Group | |||||||||
Net sales |
121,549 | | 10,423 | | | 131,972 | |||||||||
Inter-segment sales |
1,348 | | 966 | | 2,314 | | |||||||||
Total net sales |
122,897 | | 11,389 | | 2,314 | 131,972 | |||||||||
Share in earnings of JV and associated companies |
90 | 2,143 | 68 | 22 | | 2,323 | |||||||||
Operating income |
23,187 | 2,143 | 1,298 | 78 | | 26,706 | |||||||||
Operating margin (%) |
19 | % | | 11 | % | | | 20 | % | ||||||
Financial income |
3,541 | ||||||||||||||
Financial expenses |
-4,081 | ||||||||||||||
Income after financial items |
26,166 | ||||||||||||||
Taxes |
-8,330 | ||||||||||||||
Net income |
17,836 | ||||||||||||||
Net income attributable to: |
|||||||||||||||
stockholders of the parent company |
17,539 | ||||||||||||||
minority interest |
297 | ||||||||||||||
Assets1) 2) |
66,973 | | 9,452 | 105,606 | | 182,031 | |||||||||
Equity in joint ventures and associated companies |
961 | 3,092 | 97 | 5 | | 4,155 | |||||||||
Total assets |
67,934 | 3,092 | 9,549 | 105,611 | | 186,186 | |||||||||
Liabilities3) 4) |
54,728 | | 6,627 | 43,329 | | 104,684 | |||||||||
1) | Segment assets include property, plant and equipment, intangible assets, current and non-current customer financing, accounts receivable, inventory, prepaid expenses, accrued revenues, derivatives and other current assets. |
2) | Unallocated assets include mainly cash and cash equivalents, short-term investments and deferred tax assets. |
3) | Segment liabilities include accounts payable, provisions, accrued expenses and deferred revenues, advances from customers and other current liabilities. |
4) | Unallocated liabilities include accrued interests, tax liabilities, interest-bearing liabilities and post-employment benefits. |
Other segment items
2004 |
Systems | Phones | Other operations |
Unallocated | Eliminations | Group | ||||||
Property, plant and equipment and intangible assets |
||||||||||||
Additions/capitalization |
3,898 | | 399 | | | 4,297 | ||||||
Depreciation |
-2,224 | | -209 | -1 | | -2,434 | ||||||
Amortization |
-4,381 | | -82 | 11 | | -4,452 | ||||||
Impairment, net of reversals |
-22 | | -61 | -35 | | -118 |
68
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
GEOGRAPHICAL SEGMENTS (SECONDARY)
2004 |
Net sales | Additions/ capitalization of PP&E and intangible assets | ||
Western Europe |
40,542 | 3,571 | ||
of which Sweden |
6,180 | 2,868 | ||
Central and Eastern Europe, Middle East and Africa2) |
33,075 | 86 | ||
Asia Pacific2) |
28,406 | 227 | ||
of which China |
12,298 | 130 | ||
North America |
15,471 | 320 | ||
of which United States |
13,984 | 165 | ||
Latin America |
14,478 | 93 | ||
Total |
131,972 | 4,297 | ||
of which EU1) |
42,366 | 3,620 | ||
1) | Restated due to new members in EU as of May, 2004. |
2) | Restated for change of geographical segment for Pakistan. |
The majority of Ericssons products and services are sold as parts of contracts including multiple elements. The nature of the products and services being sold, and the contractual terms taken as a whole, determine the appropriate revenue recognition method. The contracts are of three main types:
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
Sales of equipment and network rollout |
142,191 | 125,856 | 110,985 | |||
Of which: |
||||||
Delivery-type contracts |
127,639 | 107,844 | 87,666 | |||
Construction-type contracts |
14,552 | 18,012 | 23,319 | |||
Service sales |
32,380 | 23,477 | 19,301 | |||
Licenses |
3,212 | 2,488 | 1,686 | |||
Net sales |
177,783 | 151,821 | 131,972 | |||
Other revenues |
||||||
Capital gains and other operating revenues |
6,192 | 2,760 | 3,119 | |||
Interest income |
1,774 | 2,310 | 3,346 | |||
Dividends |
7 | 9 | 8 |
69
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
Goods and services |
108,033 | 86,630 | 71,842 | |||
Amortization and depreciation |
7,244 | 6,073 | 6,886 | |||
Impairments, net of reversals |
876 | 508 | 2,786 | |||
Employee remunerations |
42,821 | 34,458 | 32,356 | |||
Interest expenses |
1,789 | 2,402 | 4,081 | |||
Taxes |
9,557 | 8,875 | 8,330 | |||
Expenses incurred |
170,320 | 138,946 | 126,281 | |||
Less: |
||||||
Inventory changes1) |
3,791 | 2,872 | 2,526 | |||
Additions to Capitalized development |
1,353 | 1,174 | 1,138 | |||
Expenses charged to the Income Statement |
165,176 | 134,900 | 122,617 | |||
1) | The inventory changes are based on changes of inventory values prior to allowances (gross value). |
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
Gains on sales of intangible assets and PP&E |
27 | 29 | 111 | |||
Losses on sales of intangible assets and PP&E |
-158 | -120 | -229 | |||
Gains on sales of investments and operations |
3,038 | 205 | 510 | |||
Losses on sales of investments and operations |
-93 | -149 | -273 | |||
Capital gains/losses, net |
2,814 | -35 | 119 | |||
Other operating revenues |
3,127 | 2,526 | 2,498 | |||
Total other operating income |
5,941 | 2,491 | 2,617 | |||
The gains on sales of investments and operations for 2006 mainly relate to the sale of Ericsson Microwave Systems in the third quarter.
C7 FINANCIAL INCOME AND EXPENSES
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
Financial income |
||||||
Income from securities and receivables accounted for as non-current assets |
369 | 293 | 354 | |||
Other interest income and similar Profit/loss items |
1,585 | 2,360 | 3,187 | |||
Total |
1,954 | 2,653 | 3,541 | |||
Financial expenses |
||||||
Interest expenses and similar profit/loss items |
-1,789 | -2,402 | -4,081 | |||
Financial net |
165 | 251 | -540 | |||
70
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
INCOME STATEMENT
The following items are included in Taxes:
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
Current income taxes for the year |
-4,565 | -3,635 | -2,324 | |||
Current income taxes related to prior years |
-169 | 138 | -637 | |||
Deferred tax income/expense () related to temporary differences |
-3,582 | -4,753 | -4,635 | |||
Share of taxes in joint ventures and associated companies |
-1,241 | -625 | -734 | |||
Taxes |
-9,557 | -8,875 | -8,330 | |||
A reconciliation between actual tax income ( expense) for the year and the theoretical tax income ( expense) that would arise when applying statutory tax rate in Sweden, 28 percent on income before taxes is shown in the table:
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
Income after financial items |
35,993 | 33,335 | 26,166 | |||
Tax rate in Sweden (28%) |
-10,078 | -9,334 | -7,327 | |||
Effect of foreign tax rates |
-156 | -489 | -286 | |||
Current income taxes related to prior years |
-169 | 138 | -637 | |||
Benefits from temporary differences of prior periods used to reduce deferred tax expense |
505 | 380 | | |||
Tax effect of expenses that are non-deductible for tax purpose |
-1,333 | -515 | -910 | |||
Tax effect of income that are non-taxable for tax purpose |
1,608 | 944 | 855 | |||
Tax effect of changes in tax rates |
66 | 1 | -27 | |||
Taxes |
-9,557 | -8,875 | -8,330 | |||
BALANCE SHEET
Deferred tax assets and liabilities
Tax effects of temporary differences, including unutilized tax loss carryforwards, have resulted in deferred tax assets and liabilities as follows:
2006 | 2005 | |||
Deferred tax assets |
13,564 | 18,519 | ||
Deferred tax liabilities |
382 | 391 |
Deferred tax assets relate to tax loss carryforwards of SEK 6,756 million and temporary differences of SEK 6,808 million, which are related to deferred tax on eliminated group adjustments SEK 1,391 million, warranty commitments SEK 787 million, obsolescence allowance SEK 609 million, allowance for receivables SEK 375 million and other provisions and accruals SEK 3,646 million.
Deferred tax asset are amounts recognized in countries where we expect to be able to generate corresponding taxable income in the future to benefit from tax reductions. The significant tax loss carryforwards are related to countries with long or indefinite periods of utilization, mainly Sweden and the US. Of the total deferred tax assets for tax loss carryforwards, SEK 6,756 million, SEK 5,271 million relate to Sweden with indefinite time of utilization.
71
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
With our strong current financial position and profitability during 2006, we have been able to use part of our tax loss carryforwards during the year, and we are convinced that Ericsson will be able to generate sufficient income in the coming years to utilize also remaining parts.
Deductible temporary differences and unused tax losses for which no deferred tax asset is recognized in the balance sheet amounted to approximately SEK 80 million.
Investments in subsidiaries
Due to losses in certain subsidiary companies, the book value of certain investments in those subsidiaries are less than the tax value of these investments. Since deferred tax assets have been reported with respect also to losses in these companies, and due to the uncertainty as to which deductions can be realized in the future, no additional deferred tax assets are reported.
Tax loss carryforwards
Deferred tax assets regarding unutilized tax loss carryforwards are reported to the extent that realization of the related tax benefit through the future taxable profits is probable also when considering the period during which these can be utilized, as described below.
At December 31, 2006, these unutilized tax loss carryforwards amounted to SEK 23,137 (28,034) million. The tax effect of these tax loss carryforwards are reported as an asset.
The final years in which these loss carryforwards can be utilized are shown in the following table:
Year of expiration |
Tax loss carryforwards |
Tax effect | ||
2007 |
33 | 6 | ||
2008 |
100 | 32 | ||
2009 |
128 | 41 | ||
2010 |
388 | 125 | ||
2011 |
350 | 114 | ||
2012 or later |
22,138 | 6,438 | ||
Total |
23,137 | 6,756 | ||
Tax effects reported directly to stockholders equity
Tax effects reported to equity amount to SEK 769 (1,523 )million, of which hedge accounting SEK 676 million and actuarial gains/losses on pensions SEK 93 million.
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
Net income attributable to stockholders of the parent company |
26,251 | 24,315 | 17,539 | |||
Average number of shares outstanding, basic (millions) |
15,871 | 15,843 | 15,829 | |||
Earnings per share, basic (SEK) |
1.65 | 1.53 | 1.11 | |||
Net income attributable to stockholders of the parent company |
26,251 | 24,315 | 17,539 | |||
Average number of shares outstanding, diluted (millions) 1) |
15,943 | 15,907 | 15,895 | |||
Earnings per share, diluted (SEK) |
1.65 | 1.53 | 1.11 | |||
72
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
1) | Includes the sum of the average number of ordinary shares outstanding and dilutive potential ordinary shares for Ericssons stock option and purchase plans. |
The number of dilutive shares for option programs was 17.5 million and for stock purchase programs 54.7 million, as per December 31, 2006.
Capitalized development costs | Goodwill | Intellectual property rights | ||||||||||||||||
2006 |
To be marketed |
Acquired costs for internal use |
Internal costs, for internal use |
Total | Licenses trademarks and similar rights |
Patents and research and development |
Total | |||||||||||
Accumulated acquisition costs |
||||||||||||||||||
Opening balance |
11,983 | 1,638 | 1,094 | 14,715 | 7,362 | 1,065 | 1,373 | 2,438 | ||||||||||
Acquisitions |
1,353 | | | 1,353 | 163 | 792 | 363 | 1,155 | ||||||||||
Balances regarding divested/ acquired businesses |
| | | | | 3,711 | 1) | 11,937 | 1) | 15,648 | ||||||||
Sales/disposals |
-948 | -36 | -24 | -1,008 | | -173 | -188 | -361 | ||||||||||
Translation difference for the year |
| | | | -701 | -78 | -6 | -84 | ||||||||||
Closing balance |
12,388 | 1,602 | 1,070 | 15,060 | 6,824 | 5,317 | 13,479 | 18,796 | ||||||||||
Accumulated amortization |
||||||||||||||||||
Opening balance |
-5,192 | -1,549 | -1,033 | -7,774 | | -882 | -603 | -1,485 | ||||||||||
Amortization for the year2) |
-2,195 | -49 | -33 | -2,277 | | -452 | -1,508 | -1,960 | ||||||||||
Sales/disposals |
948 | 36 | 24 | 1,008 | | 110 | 155 | 265 | ||||||||||
Translation difference for the year |
| | | | | 44 | 3 | 47 | ||||||||||
Closing balance |
-6,439 | -1,562 | -1,042 | -9,043 | | -1,180 | -1,953 | -3,133 | ||||||||||
Accumulated impairment losses |
||||||||||||||||||
Opening balance |
-716 | -38 | -26 | -780 | | | -14 | -14 | ||||||||||
Impairment losses for the year |
-242 | | | -242 | | | | | ||||||||||
Closing balance |
-958 | -38 | -26 | -1,022 | | | -14 | -14 | ||||||||||
Net carrying value |
4,991 | 2 | 2 | 4,995 | 6,824 | 4,137 | 11,512 | 15,649 | ||||||||||
1) | As per January 1, 2006, Ericsson acquired assets of Marconi telecommunications operations. The acquisition consists of IPR, SEK 11.7 billion, and brands and customer relationships, SEK 3.6 billion. The remaining amortization period related to the intellectual property rights acquired from Marconi is nine years. |
2) | No intangible assets other than goodwill have indefinite useful lives. |
Amortization and impairment losses for capitalized development costs is reported as research and development and other technical expenses.
73
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
The goodwill is allocated to the business segment Systems, representing one cash-generating unit due to that the goodwill is related to acquisitions of internet protocol (IP) competence and know-how. IP technology is an integrated part of the products within Systems and separate prices are not defined or invoiced to the customers for this technology. The estimates used for measuring the recoverable amounts for goodwill per cash-generating unit include mainly assumptions for the following key parameters:
| sales growth, |
| development of operating margin, reduced with estimated tax expense, |
| capital expenditure requirements, including working capital |
The assumptions, approved by management, are based on available industry sources that provide estimates of the number of mobile subscribers. The number of global subscriptions is estimated to grow from 2.7 billion to more than 4 billion within five years. The minutes of usage per user will also continue to increase. Impairment testing is based on the premise that changes for the main assumptions are in line with the development for the global subscriber growth, based on detailed assumptions for four years, with a slight decrease thereafter. The impairment test for goodwill has not resulted in any impairment. A number of tests of sensivity have been made, for example the effect of a growth of just one percent per year. None of these tests indicate impairment. The managements view is that it is unlikely that an outcome for the key parameters will occur that would result in impairment. A pre-tax discount rate of 12 percent has been applied for the discounting of projected cash flows.
Capitalized development costs | Goodwill | Intellectual property rights | ||||||||||||||
2005 |
To be marketed |
Acquired for internal use |
Internal costs, for internal use |
Total | Licenses and similar rights |
Patents and research and development |
Total | |||||||||
Accumulated acquisition costs |
||||||||||||||||
Opening balance |
11,876 | 1,638 | 1,094 | 14,608 | 5,766 | 1,022 | 1,118 | 2,140 | ||||||||
Acquisitions |
1,174 | | | 1,174 | 512 | 38 | 515 | 553 | ||||||||
Balances regarding divested/ acquired businesses |
| | | | | 11 | | 11 | ||||||||
Sales/disposals |
-1,067 | | | -1,067 | | -73 | -276 | -349 | ||||||||
Translation difference for the year |
| | | | 1,084 | 67 | 16 | 83 | ||||||||
Closing balance |
11,983 | 1,638 | 1,094 | 14,715 | 7,362 | 1,065 | 1,373 | 2,438 | ||||||||
Accumulated amortization |
||||||||||||||||
Opening balance |
-3,458 | -1,424 | -950 | -5,832 | | -901 | -477 | -1,378 | ||||||||
Amortization for the year |
-2,801 | -125 | -83 | -3,009 | | -8 | -252 | -260 | ||||||||
Balances regarding divested/ acquired businesses |
| | | | | -7 | | -7 | ||||||||
Sales/disposals |
1,067 | | | 1,067 | | 78 | 134 | 212 | ||||||||
Translation difference for the year |
| | | | | -44 | -8 | -52 | ||||||||
Closing balance |
-5,192 | -1,549 | -1,033 | -7,774 | | -882 | -603 | -1,485 | ||||||||
Accumulated impairment losses |
||||||||||||||||
Opening balance |
-621 | -38 | -26 | -685 | | | -14 | -14 | ||||||||
Impairment losses for the year |
-95 | | | -95 | | | | | ||||||||
Closing balance |
-716 | -38 | -26 | -780 | | | -14 | -14 | ||||||||
Net carrying value |
6,075 | 51 | 35 | 6,161 | 7,362 | 183 | 756 | 939 | ||||||||
74
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
C11 PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT
2006 |
Real estate | Machinery and other technical assets |
Other equipment, tools and installations |
Construction in process and advance payments |
Total | |||||
Accumulated acquisition costs |
||||||||||
Opening balance |
3,512 | 5,200 | 17,146 | 287 | 26,145 | |||||
Additions |
772 | 931 | 1,264 | 860 | 3,827 | |||||
Balances regarding divested/acquired businesses |
624 | 8 | -337 | 11 | 306 | |||||
Sales/disposals |
-47 | -1,036 | -2,448 | -45 | -3,576 | |||||
Reclassifications |
21 | 59 | 552 | -632 | | |||||
Translation difference for the year |
-331 | -157 | -1,042 | -24 | -1,554 | |||||
Closing balance |
4,551 | 5,005 | 15,135 | 457 | 25,148 | |||||
Accumulated amortization |
||||||||||
Opening balance |
-1,119 | -4,285 | -13,106 | | -18,510 | |||||
Depreciation for the year |
-206 | -706 | -2,095 | | -3,007 | |||||
Balances regarding divested/acquired businesses |
| 156 | 542 | | 698 | |||||
Sales/disposals |
40 | 1,043 | 2,178 | | 3,261 | |||||
Reclassifications |
28 | 2 | -30 | | | |||||
Translation difference for the year |
45 | 111 | 773 | | 929 | |||||
Closing balance |
-1,212 | -3,679 | -11,738 | | -16,629 | |||||
Accumulated impairment losses, net |
||||||||||
Opening balance |
-359 | -145 | -165 | | -669 | |||||
Impairment losses for the year |
| -11 | -50 | | -61 | |||||
Reversals of impairment losses |
| | 31 | | 31 | |||||
Balances regarding divested/acquired businesses |
| | | | | |||||
Sales/disposals |
| | | | | |||||
Translation difference for the year |
53 | 2 | 6 | | 61 | |||||
Closing balance |
-306 | -154 | -178 | | -638 | |||||
Net carrying value |
3,033 | 1,172 | 3,219 | 457 | 7,881 | |||||
Contractual commitments for the acquisition of property, plant and equipment as per December 31, 2006, amounted to SEK 190 (1,448) million. The reversal of impairment losses have been reported under Cost of sales.
75
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
2005 |
Real estate | Machinery and other technical assets |
Other equipment, tools and installations |
Construction in process and advance payments |
Total | |||||
Accumulated acquisition costs |
||||||||||
Opening balance |
2,657 | 5,306 | 15,350 | 303 | 23,616 | |||||
Additions |
461 | 405 | 1,745 | 754 | 3,365 | |||||
Balances regarding divested/acquired businesses |
14 | -14 | 24 | | 24 | |||||
Sales/disposals |
-196 | -582 | -2,001 | -17 | -2,796 | |||||
Reclassifications |
229 | -121 | 659 | -767 | | |||||
Translation difference for the year |
347 | 206 | 1,369 | 14 | 1,936 | |||||
Closing balance |
3,512 | 5,200 | 17,146 | 287 | 26,145 | |||||
Accumulated amortization |
||||||||||
Opening balance |
-583 | -4,374 | -11,652 | | -16,609 | |||||
Depreciation for the year |
-366 | -489 | -1,949 | | -2,804 | |||||
Balances regarding divested/acquired businesses |
-3 | 13 | -21 | | -11 | |||||
Sales/disposals |
96 | 562 | 1,685 | | 2,343 | |||||
Reclassifications |
-4 | 173 | -169 | | | |||||
Translation difference for the year |
-259 | -170 | -1,000 | | 1,429 | |||||
Closing balance |
-1,119 | -4,285 | -13,106 | | -18,510 | |||||
Accumulated impairment losses, net |
||||||||||
Opening balance |
-482 | -148 | -532 | | -1,162 | |||||
Impairment losses for the year |
| -14 | | | -14 | |||||
Reversals of impairment losses |
43 | | 337 | | 380 | |||||
Balances regarding divested/acquired businesses |
-1 | | | | -1 | |||||
Sales/disposals |
| | | | | |||||
Translation difference for the year |
81 | 17 | 30 | | 128 | |||||
Closing balance |
-359 | -145 | -165 | | -669 | |||||
Net carrying value |
2,034 | 770 | 3,875 | 287 | 6,966 | |||||
EQUITY IN JOINT VENTURES AND ASSOCIATED COMPANIES
Joint ventures | Associated companies | Total | ||||||||||
2006 | 2005 | 2006 | 2005 | 2006 | 2005 | |||||||
Opening balance |
5,038 | 3,092 | 1,275 | 1,063 | 6,313 | 4,155 | ||||||
Share in earnings |
5,852 | 2,257 | 82 | 138 | 5,934 | 2,395 | ||||||
Taxes |
-1,237 | -604 | -4 | -21 | -1,241 | -625 | ||||||
Translation difference for the year |
-422 | 286 | -9 | 92 | -431 | 378 | ||||||
Change in hedge reserve |
-30 | 7 | | | -30 | 7 | ||||||
Dividends |
-1,160 | | -102 | -32 | -1,262 | -32 | ||||||
Capital contributions |
| | 201 | 33 | 201 | 33 | ||||||
Reclassification |
| | -8 | 2 | -8 | 2 | ||||||
Disposals |
| | -67 | | -67 | | ||||||
Closing balance |
8,041 | 5,038 | 1,368 | 1,275 | 9,409 | 6,313 | ||||||
Goodwill, net, amounts to SEK 18 (21) million.
76
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
ERICSSONS SHARE OF ASSETS, LIABILITIES AND INCOME IN JOINT VENTURE SONY ERICSSON MOBILE COMMUNICATIONS
Non-current assets |
1,963 | |
Current assets |
21,268 | |
Non-current liabilities |
87 | |
Current liabilities |
15,103 | |
Net assets |
8,041 | |
Net sales |
50,770 | |
Income after financial items |
6,006 | |
Income taxes for the year |
-1,237 | |
Net income |
4,769 | |
Net income attributable to: |
||
Stockholders of the Parent Company |
4,615 | |
Minority interest |
154 | |
Assets pledged as collateral |
18 | |
Contingent liabilities |
56 |
Both these companies apply IFRS in the reporting to Ericsson.
ERICSSONS SHARE OF ASSETS, LIABILITIES AND INCOME IN ASSOCIATED COMPANY ERICSSON NIKOLA TESLA D.D.1)
Non-current assets |
367 | |
Current assets |
804 | |
Non-current liabilities |
1 | |
Current liabilities |
222 | |
Net assets |
948 | |
Net sales |
1,014 | |
Income after financial items |
164 | |
Income taxes for the year |
-19 | |
Net income |
145 | |
Net income attributable to: |
||
Stockholders of the Parent Company |
145 | |
Minority interest |
| |
Assets pledged as collateral |
4 | |
Contingent liabilities |
39 |
1) | Ericssons share is 49 percent. |
77
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
OTHER FINANCIAL ASSETS
Other investments in shares and participations |
Customer financing, non-current |
Derivatives hedging non-current liabilities with a positive value |
Other financial assets, non-current | ||||||||||||||||
2006 | 2005 | 2006 | 2005 | 2006 | 2005 | 2006 | 2005 | ||||||||||||
Accumulated acquisition costs |
|||||||||||||||||||
Opening balance |
2,336 | 2,318 | 2,372 | 4,330 | 716 | | 3,199 | 2,312 | |||||||||||
Effect of changed accounting principle, IAS 39 |
| 256 | | | | 937 | | | |||||||||||
Additions |
82 | 26 | 1,760 | 689 | | | 617 | 3) | 1,888 | ||||||||||
Balances regarding divested/acquired businesses |
| | | | | | -84 | | |||||||||||
Disposals/repayments/deductions |
-286 | -467 | -1,755 | -2,215 | | | -149 | -1,191 | |||||||||||
Reclassifications |
| -2 | -35 | -697 | | -401 | | | |||||||||||
Revaluation |
| | | | -600 | 180 | | | |||||||||||
Translation difference for the year |
-133 | 205 | -72 | 265 | | | -136 | 190 | |||||||||||
Closing balance |
1,999 | 2,336 | 2,270 | 2,372 | 116 | 716 | 3,447 | 3,199 | |||||||||||
Accumulated impairment losses/allowances |
|||||||||||||||||||
Opening balance |
-1,531 | 1,775 | -1,050 | -2,180 | | | -1,119 | -1,076 | |||||||||||
Effect of changed accounting principle, IAS 39 |
| 155 | | | | | | | |||||||||||
Impairment losses/allowances for the year |
-8 | -1 | -84 | 128 | | | -81 | 12 | |||||||||||
Balances regarding divested businesses |
| | | | | | | | |||||||||||
Disposals/repayments/deductions |
155 | 225 | 727 | 807 | | | | | |||||||||||
Reclassifications |
| | 31 | 559 | | | | | |||||||||||
Translation difference for the year |
106 | -135 | 27 | -108 | | | 46 | -55 | |||||||||||
Closing balance |
-1,278 | -1,531 | -349 | 2) | -1,050 | | | -1,154 | -1,119 | ||||||||||
Net carrying value |
721 | 1) | 805 | 1,921 | 1,322 | 116 | 716 | 2,293 | 2,080 | ||||||||||
1) | Fair value per December 31, 2006, for listed shares was SEK 6 (8) million with a net carrying value of SEK 6 (8) million. |
2) | Impairment losses are included in Selling expenses due to the close relation to operations. |
3) | Additions include funded pension plans with net assets of SEK 381 (453) million. For further information, see Note C17, Post-employment benefits. |
2006 | 2005 | |||
Raw materials, components and consumables |
6,902 | 4,699 | ||
Manufacturing work in progress |
213 | 139 | ||
Finished products and goods for resale |
3,781 | 2,770 | ||
Contract work in progress |
11,171 | 12,753 | ||
Less advances from customers |
-597 | -1,153 | ||
Inventories, net |
21,470 | 19,208 | ||
Reported amounts are net of obsolescence allowances of SEK 2,578 (2,519) million.
78
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2005
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
MOVEMENTS IN OBSOLESCENCE ALLOWANCES
2006 | 2005 | |||
Opening balance |
2,519 | 3,146 | ||
Additions |
857 | 785 | ||
Utilized |
-693 | -1,560 | ||
Translation difference for the year |
-81 | 148 | ||
Balances regarding acquired/divested businesses |
-24 | | ||
Closing balance |
2,578 | 2,519 | ||
Contract work in progress includes amounts related to construction-type contracts as well as other contracts with ongoing work in progress.
The cost of inventories recognized as an expense and included in Cost of sales was SEK 54,479 (44,662) million.
CONSTRUCTION-TYPE CONTRACTS IN PROGRESS
2006 | 2005 | ||||
For construction-type contracts in progress: |
|||||
Aggregate amounts of costs incurred |
12,255 | 23,244 | 1) | ||
Aggregate amount of recognized profits (less recognized losses) |
1,735 | 6,416 | 1) | ||
Gross amount due from customers2) |
1,537 | 537 | |||
Gross amount due to customers3) |
785 | 4,118 | 1) |
1) | A significant part of these amounts relate to contracts in the Defense business sold in September, 2006. |
2) | For all contracts in progress for which costs incurred plus recognized profits (less recognized losses) exceeds progress billings. |
3) | For all contracts in progress for which progress billings exceed costs incurred plus recognized profits (less recognized losses). |
The aggregate amounts of costs incurred relate to all construction-type contracts that where not finalized as per December 31, 2006 and include all costs incurred since the start of these projects, including any costs incurred prior to January 1, 2006. Net sales for construction-type contracts for 2006 amounts to SEK 14,552 million, see note C4, Revenues.
2006 | 2005 | |||
Trade receivables excluding associated companies and joint ventures |
51,846 | 42,198 | ||
Allowances for impairment of receivables |
-1,372 | -1,382 | ||
Trade receivables, net |
50,474 | 40,816 | ||
Trade receivables related to associated companies and joint ventures |
596 | 426 | ||
Total |
51,070 | 41,242 | ||
Days sales outstanding were 86 (81) in December, 2006.
Retention receivables recognized as revenues were SEK 4,680 (3,940) million as of December 31, 2006.
79
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
MOVEMENTS IN ALLOWANCES FOR IMPAIRMENT OF RECEIVABLES
2006 | 2005 | |||
Opening balance |
1,382 | 1,782 | ||
Additions |
686 | 916 | ||
Utilized |
-139 | -1,185 | ||
Reversal of excess amounts |
-527 | -185 | ||
Reclassification |
56 | -60 | ||
Translation difference for the year |
-86 | 114 | ||
Closing balance |
1,372 | 1,382 | ||
2006 | 2005 | |||
Prepaid expenses |
2,212 | 1,997 | ||
Accrued revenues |
1,124 | 1,998 | ||
Advance payments to suppliers |
666 | 517 | ||
Derivatives with a positive value |
3,802 | 1,347 | ||
Other |
7,208 | 6,715 | ||
Total |
15,012 | 12,574 | ||
The major item within other is value added tax.
Capital stock 2006
Capital stock at December 31, 2006, consisted of the following:
Parent company |
Number of shares | Capital stock | ||
Class A shares |
1,308,779,918 | 1,309 | ||
Class B shares |
14,823,478,760 | 14,823 | ||
Total |
16,132,258,678 | 16,132 | ||
The capital stock of the Company is divided into two classes: Class A shares (quota value SEK 1.00) and Class B shares (quota value SEK 1.00). Both classes have the same rights of participation in the net assets and earnings of the Company. Class A shares, however, are entitled to one vote per share while Class B shares are entitled to one tenth of one vote per share. No class C shares, each carrying one-thousandth of one vote, currently exist.
The total number of treasury shares at December 31, 2006, was 251,013,892 (268,065,241 in 2005, 299,715,117 in 2004) Class B shares. The number of treasury shares decreased during 2006 due to delivery and sale of shares in relation to the Stock Purchase Plans and the Stock Option Plans.
RECONCILIATION OF NUMBER OF SHARES
Number of shares | Capital stock | |||
Number of shares, Jan 1, 2006 |
16,132,258,678 | 16,132 | ||
Number of shares, Dec 31, 2006 |
16,132,258,678 | 16,132 |
80
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Dividend proposal
The Board of Directors will propose to the Annual General Meeting a dividend of SEK 0.50 per share.
Capital stock |
Additional paid in capital |
Revaluation of other investments in shares and participations |
Cash Flow hedges |
Cumulative translation adjustments |
Retained earnings |
Stock- holders equity |
Minority interest |
Total Equity | |||||||||||
2006 |
|||||||||||||||||||
January 1, 2006 |
16,132 | 24,731 | 5 | -704 | -2,493 | 63,951 | 101,622 | 850 | 102,472 | ||||||||||
Actuarial gains and losses related to pensions and payroll tax |
| | | | | 440 | 440 | | 440 | ||||||||||
Revaluation of other investments in shares and participations |
|||||||||||||||||||
Fair value measurement reported in equity |
| | -2 | | | | -2 | 1 | -1 | ||||||||||
Cash flow hedges |
|||||||||||||||||||
Fair value remeasurement of derivatives reported in equity |
| | | 4,100 | | | 4,100 | | 4,100 | ||||||||||
Transferred to income statement for the period |
| | | -1,990 | | | -1,990 | | -1,990 | ||||||||||
Transferred to balance sheet for the period |
| | | 99 | | | 99 | | 99 | ||||||||||
Changes in cumulative translation effects due to changes in foreign currency exchange rates |
| | | | -3,028 | 1) | | -3,028 | -91 | -3,119 | |||||||||
Tax on items reported directly in/or transferred from equity |
| | | -628 | -48 | 2) | -93 | -769 | | -769 | |||||||||
Total transactions reported directly in equity |
| | -2 | 1,581 | -3,076 | 347 | -1,150 | -90 | -1,240 | ||||||||||
Net income |
| | | | | 26,251 | 26,251 | 185 | 26,436 | ||||||||||
Total income and expenses recognized for the period |
| | -2 | 1,581 | -3,076 | 26,598 | 25,101 | 95 | 25,196 | ||||||||||
Sale of own shares |
| | | | | 58 | 58 | | 58 | ||||||||||
Stock Purchase and Stock Option Plans |
| | | | | 473 | 473 | | 473 | ||||||||||
Dividends paid |
| | | | | -7,141 | -7,141 | -202 | -7,343 | ||||||||||
Stock issue, net |
| | | | | | | 70 | 70 | ||||||||||
Business combinations |
| | | | | | | -31 | -31 | ||||||||||
December 31, 2006 |
16,132 | 24,731 | 3 | 877 | -5,569 | 83,939 | 120,113 | 782 | 120,895 | ||||||||||
1) | Changes in cumulative translation adjustments include changes regarding revaluation of goodwill in local currency of SEK-701 million (SEK 1,084 million in 2005, SEK -376 million in 2004), net gain/loss from hedging activities of foreign entities, SEK 123 million (SEK-142 million in 2005, SEK-167 million in 2004) and SEK-1 million (SEK 127 million in 2005, SEK 47 million in 2004) of realized gain/losses net from sold/liquidated companies. |
2) | Deferred tax on gains on hedges on net investments in foreign entities, SEK 171 million pre tax. |
81
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Capital stock |
Additional paid in capital |
Revaluation of other investments in shares and participations |
Cash Flow hedges |
Cumulative translation adjustments |
Retained earnings |
Stock- holders equity |
Minority interest |
Total Equity | ||||||||||
2005 |
||||||||||||||||||
January 1, 2005 |
16,132 | 24,731 | | | -6,530 | 45,372 | 79,705 | 1,057 | 80,762 | |||||||||
Changes in accounting policy |
| | 155 | 1,155 | 179 | 1,489 | | 1,489 | ||||||||||
Adjusted opening balance |
16,132 | 24,731 | 155 | 1,155 | -6,530 | 45,551 | 81,194 | 1,057 | 82,251 | |||||||||
Actuarial gains and losses related to pensions and payroll tax |
| | | | | -3,221 | -3,221 | | -3,221 | |||||||||
Revaluation of other investments in shares and participations |
||||||||||||||||||
Fair value measurement reported in equity |
| | -3 | | | | -3 | | -3 | |||||||||
Transferred to income statement at sale |
| | -147 | | | | -147 | | -147 | |||||||||
Cash flow hedges |
||||||||||||||||||
Fair value remeasurement of derivatives reported in equity |
| | | -3,961 | | | -3,961 | | -3,961 | |||||||||
Transferred to income statement for the period |
| | | 1,404 | | | 1,404 | | 1,404 | |||||||||
Changes in cumulative translation effects due to changes in foreign currency exchange rates |
| | | | 4,118 | | 4,118 | 147 | 4,265 | |||||||||
Tax on items reported directly in transferred from equity |
| | | 698 | -81 | 906 | 1,523 | | 1,523 | |||||||||
Total transactions reported directly in equity |
| | -150 | -1,859 | 4,037 | -2,315 | -287 | 147 | -140 | |||||||||
Net income |
| | | | | 24,315 | 24,315 | 145 | 24,460 | |||||||||
Total income and expenses recognized for the period |
| | -150 | -1,859 | 4,037 | 22,000 | 24,028 | 292 | 24,320 | |||||||||
Sale of own shares |
| | | | | 117 | 117 | | 117 | |||||||||
Stock Purchase and Stock Option Plans |
| | | | | 242 | 242 | | 242 | |||||||||
Dividends paid |
| | | | | -3,959 | -3,959 | -174 | -4,133 | |||||||||
Stock issue, net |
| | | | | | | 17 | 17 | |||||||||
Business combinations |
| | | | | | | -342 | -342 | |||||||||
December 31, 2005 |
16,132 | 24,731 | 5 | -704 | -2,493 | 63,951 | 101,622 | 850 | 102,472 | |||||||||
82
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Capital stock |
Additional paid in capital |
Revaluation of other investments in shares and participations |
Cash Flow hedges |
Cumulative translation adjustments |
Retained earnings |
Stock- holders equity |
Minority interest |
Total Equity | ||||||||||
2004 |
||||||||||||||||||
January 1, 2004 |
16,132 | 24,729 | | | -5,395 | 28,354 | 63,820 | 2,299 | 66,119 | |||||||||
Actuarial gains and losses related to pensions and payroll tax |
| | | | | -1,059 | -1,059 | | -1,059 | |||||||||
Changes in cumulative translation effects due to changes in foreign currency exchange rates |
| | | | -1,200 | | -1,200 | -65 | -1,265 | |||||||||
Tax on items reported directly in/or transferred from equity |
| | | | 65 | 319 | 384 | | 384 | |||||||||
Total transactions reported directly in equity |
| | | | -1,135 | -740 | -1,875 | -65 | -1,940 | |||||||||
Net income |
| | | | | 17,539 | 17,539 | 297 | 17,836 | |||||||||
Total income and expenses recognized for the period |
| | | | -1,135 | 16,799 | 15,664 | 232 | 15,896 | |||||||||
Sale of own shares |
| | | | | 15 | 15 | | 15 | |||||||||
Stock Purchase and Stock Option Plans |
| | | | | 204 | 204 | | 204 | |||||||||
Dividends paid |
| | | | | | | -292 | -292 | |||||||||
Business combinations |
| | | | | | | -1,182 | -1,182 | |||||||||
Adjustment of stock issue 2002 |
| 2 | | | | | 2 | | 2 | |||||||||
December 31, 2004 |
16,132 | 24,731 | | | -6,530 | 45,372 | 79,705 | 1,057 | 80,762 | |||||||||
In summary, during 2006 the overall funded ratio in our plans for post-employment benefits was kept on almost the same level as last year, 74.7 percent compared to 75.2 percent. The funded ratio is defined as total plan assets in relation to total defined benefit obligations (DBO). The slight decrease of this ratio is mainly due to the acquisition of Marconi. In the acquisition of Marconi, Ericsson took over the responsibility for pension plans with a total DBO amounting to SEK 1,755 million (of which fully funded plans were SEK 909 million) and plan assets amounting to SEK 939 million.
Ericsson participates in a number of local post-employment benefit plans throughout the world. The plans benefit levels are in line with market practice in each country. There are principally two types of plans:
| Defined contribution plans, i.e. post-employment benefit plans where Ericsson pays fixed contributions into separate entities and will have no legal or constructive obligation to pay further contributions if the fund does not hold sufficient assets to pay all employee benefits relating to employee service in current |
83
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
and prior periods. In consequence, actuarial risks and investment risks fall on the employee. The expenditures for defined contribution plans are recognized as costs during the period when the employee provides service. |
| Defined benefit plans, i.e. post-employment benefit plans where Ericssons undertaking is to provide pre-determined benefits that the employees will receive on or after retirement. Benefit formulas are usually dependent on one or more factors such as age, years of service and salary. Actuarial risks and investment risks fall on the employer. Defined benefit plans may be funded or unfunded. Within Ericsson, almost all plans are fully or partly funded. |
Actuarial gains and losses may arise from either a change in actuarial assumptions or in deviations between estimated outcome and actual outcome. During 2004, IASB amended IAS 19 and introduced a new alternative way in which actuarial gains and losses may be recognized. The amended IAS 19 was endorsed by the EU in 2005. The new alternative permits immediate recognition of actuarial gains and losses directly in equity disclosed in a statement of recognized income and expense (SORIE). Ericsson has adopted the new method as from January 1, 2006. Earlier reporting periods have been restated accordingly. As a one time effect, provisions for post-employment benefits increased by SEK 3.5 billion at January 1, 2006. Costs for post-employment benefits within Ericsson are distributed between defined contribution plans and defined benefit plans, with at trend towards defined contribution plans.
Almost all companies with material defined benefit plans have trust funds which fully or partly secure the obligations for pension. The net of DBO and plan assets is recognized as provisions for post-employment benefits in the balance sheet. Plans with a net surplus, i.e. where plan assets exceed DBO, are reported as financial assets. None of the Companys plans with net surplus are affected by a ceiling rule, which in some cases can limit the amount reported as assets. The net periodic pension cost and the present value of DBO for current and former employees are calculated using the Projected Unit Credit Method (PUC). The calculations are based upon actuarial assumptions and are prepared annually by certified actuaries. Some of our defined benefit plans throughout the world have been closed for new entrance and will gradually be replaced by defined contribution plans.
In Sweden, the total pension schemes are a mixed solution, with some parts being defined contribution plans and others defined benefit plans. All plans for blue-collar workers are defined contribution plans. Plans for salaried employees consists of a defined contribution plan, ITPK (supplementary retirement benefits), and a defined benefit plan, ITP (occupational pension for salaried employees in manufacturing industries and trade). Thereof the retirement pension part of the ITP-plan DBO is partly secured through the Swedish pension trust. The disability- and survivors pension part of the ITP-plan DBO is secured through an insurance solution with the insurance company Alecta. This part of the plan is classified as a multi-employer defined benefit plan. It has not been possible, however, for Ericsson to get sufficient information to account for the plan as a defined benefit plan. The plan has therefore been accounted for as a defined contribution plan. Fees during 2006 for the disability- and survivors pension amount to SEK 389 million (SEK 350 million in 2005). The collective consolidation level at Alecta was 143.1 percent at year-end 2006 (128.5 percent in 2005). The collective consolidation level is calculated as the market value on Alectas asset portfolio in relation to insurance obligations according to actuarial assumptions set by Alecta, which do not comply with IAS 19. Substantially higher or lower surplus may give rise to future premium changes or refunds. The parties on the Swedish labor market have agreed to launch a new ITP-plan during 2007. The new plan is a defined contribution plan and will be open for new participants in the ITP-system, whereas current participants will continue in the old plan.
84
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
A number of Ericsson employees in Sweden took the opportunity to join a voluntary career change program and left the Company during the year. The effects of the program resulted in a curtailment gain amounting to SEK 81 million. In relation to the divestment of the Defense business, a number of pension obligations were settled with Alecta. The settlement cost was offset by a curtailment gain. The net gain amounts to SEK 57 million.
The following tables summarize the total pension cost for the Group:
TOTAL ANNUAL PENSION COST
Sweden | UK | Eurozone | US | Other | Total | |||||||
2006 |
||||||||||||
Pension cost for defined benefit plans |
347 | 249 | 300 | 49 | 44 | 989 | ||||||
Pension cost for defined contributions plans |
1,350 | | 195 | 93 | 82 | 1,720 | ||||||
Total |
1,697 | 249 | 495 | 142 | 126 | 2,709 | ||||||
2005 |
||||||||||||
Pension cost for defined benefit plans |
417 | 71 | 200 | 101 | 107 | 896 | ||||||
Pension cost for defined contribution plans |
929 | | 198 | 83 | 59 | 1,269 | ||||||
Total |
1,346 | 71 | 398 | 184 | 166 | 2,165 | ||||||
ANNUAL PENSION COST FOR DEFINED BENEFIT PLANS
Sweden | UK | Eurozone | US | Other | Total | |||||||
2006 |
||||||||||||
Service cost |
431 | 228 | 279 | 47 | 92 | 1,077 | ||||||
Interest cost |
406 | 177 | 133 | 146 | 104 | 966 | ||||||
Expected return on plan assets |
-352 | -169 | -103 | -140 | -145 | -909 | ||||||
Past service cost |
| 31 | | 5 | 13 | 49 | ||||||
Curtailments and Settlements |
-138 | -18 | -9 | -9 | -20 | -194 | ||||||
Total |
347 | 249 | 300 | 49 | 44 | 989 | ||||||
2005 |
||||||||||||
Service cost |
275 | 62 | 200 | 78 | 81 | 696 | ||||||
Interest cost |
407 | 169 | 93 | 148 | 61 | 878 | ||||||
Expected return on plan assets |
-267 | -160 | -93 | -128 | -63 | -711 | ||||||
Past service cost |
2 | | | 3 | 14 | 19 | ||||||
Curtailments and settlements |
| | | | 14 | 14 | ||||||
Total |
417 | 71 | 200 | 101 | 107 | 896 | ||||||
The tables below and on the following pages present information about defined benefit plans for Ericsson and summarize changes in the benefit obligation, the plan assets and the funded status of defined benefit plans and the amount recognized in the balance sheet as well as key assumptions.
85
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
CHANGE IN DEFINED BENEFIT OBLIGATION, DBO
Sweden | UK | Eurozone | US | Other | Total | ||||||||
2006 |
|||||||||||||
Opening balance |
11,632 | 3,795 | 2,475 | 2,863 | 1,549 | 22,314 | |||||||
Service cost |
431 | 228 | 279 | 47 | 92 | 1,077 | |||||||
Interest cost |
406 | 177 | 133 | 146 | 104 | 966 | |||||||
Employee contributions |
| 54 | 4 | | 13 | 71 | |||||||
Pension payments |
-69 | -150 | -60 | -189 | -69 | -537 | |||||||
Actuarial gain/loss (-/+) |
-208 | 767 | -244 | -159 | -28 | 128 | |||||||
Settlements |
-209 | -18 | | | -48 | -275 | |||||||
Curtailments |
211 | | -9 | -9 | -19 | -248 | |||||||
Business combinations |
| 909 | 781 | 45 | 20 | 1,755 | |||||||
Other |
| 29 | | 37 | 1 | 67 | |||||||
Translation difference for the year |
| -78 | -118 | -382 | -128 | -706 | |||||||
Closing balance |
11,772 | 5,713 | 3,241 | 2,399 | 1,487 | 24,612 | 1)2) | ||||||
2005 |
|||||||||||||
Opening balance |
8,190 | 3,018 | 1,987 | 2,362 | 1,263 | 16,820 | |||||||
Service cost |
275 | 62 | 200 | 78 | 81 | 696 | |||||||
Interest cost |
407 | 169 | 93 | 148 | 61 | 878 | |||||||
Employee contributions |
| 30 | | 22 | 12 | 64 | |||||||
Pension payments |
-71 | -74 | -37 | -161 | -63 | -406 | |||||||
Actuarial gain/loss (-/+) |
2,830 | 346 | 166 | 148 | 106 | 3,300 | |||||||
Settlements |
| | | | -49 | -49 | |||||||
Curtailments |
| | | | | 0 | |||||||
Business combinations |
| | | | 65 | 65 | |||||||
Reclassifications |
| | 33 | | -94 | -127 | |||||||
Other |
1 | | 18 | 91 | -55 | 55 | |||||||
Translation difference for the year |
| 244 | 81 | 471 | 222 | 1,018 | |||||||
Closing balance1)2) |
11,632 | 3,795 | 2,475 | 2,863 | 1,549 | 22,314 | |||||||
1) | Of which wholly and partly funded plans SEK 22,055 (20,488) million and unfunded plans SEK 2,557 (1,826) million. |
2) | Of which post-employment medical benefit schemes SEK 579 (692) million. |
86
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
CHANGE IN PLAN ASSETS
Sweden | UK | Eurozone | US | Other | Total | |||||||
2006 |
||||||||||||
Opening balance |
8,809 | 2,754 | 1,821 | 1,880 | 1,520 | 16,784 | ||||||
Expected return on plan assets |
352 | 169 | 103 | 140 | 145 | 909 | ||||||
Actuarial gain/loss (+/-) |
261 | 26 | 38 | -24 | 56 | 357 | ||||||
Employer contributions |
| 191 | 99 | 211 | 61 | 562 | ||||||
Employee contributions |
| 54 | 4 | | 13 | 71 | ||||||
Pension payments |
| -151 | -17 | -136 | -62 | -366 | ||||||
Settlements |
-281 | | | | -48 | -329 | ||||||
Business combinations |
| 909 | | 17 | 13 | 939 | ||||||
Other |
| | -11 | | -1 | -12 | ||||||
Translation difference for the year |
| -55 | -78 | -270 | -117 | -520 | ||||||
Closing balance |
9,141 | 3,897 | 1,959 | 1,818 | 1,580 | 18,395 | ||||||
2005 |
||||||||||||
Opening balance |
| 2,014 | 1,389 | 1,417 | 944 | 5,764 | ||||||
Expected return on plan assets |
267 | 160 | 93 | 128 | 63 | 711 | ||||||
Actuarial gain/loss (+/-) |
204 | 107 | 182 | -4 | 217 | 706 | ||||||
Employer contributions |
8,338 | 352 | 102 | 43 | 110 | 8,945 | ||||||
Employee contributions |
| 30 | | 22 | 12 | 64 | ||||||
Pension payments |
| -74 | -15 | -126 | -50 | -265 | ||||||
Settlements |
| | | | -63 | -63 | ||||||
Business combinations |
| | | | 38 | 38 | ||||||
Other |
| | | 108 | -5 | 103 | ||||||
Translation difference for the year |
| 165 | 70 | 292 | 254 | 781 | ||||||
Closing balance |
8,809 | 2,754 | 1,821 | 1,880 | 1,520 | 16,784 | ||||||
ACTUAL RETURN ON PLAN ASSETS
Sweden | UK | Eurozone | US | Other | Total | |||||||
2006 |
613 | 195 | 141 | 116 | 201 | 1,266 | ||||||
2005 |
471 | 267 | 275 | 124 | 280 | 1,417 |
ASSET ALLOCATION
Sweden | UK | Eurozone | US | Other | Total | |||||||
2006 |
||||||||||||
Equities |
2,377 | 1,802 | 1,142 | 1,058 | 353 | 6,732 | ||||||
Interest-bearing securities |
6,764 | 1,914 | 714 | 696 | 1,087 | 11,175 | ||||||
Other |
| 181 | 103 | 64 | 140 | 488 | ||||||
Total |
9,141 | 3,897 | 1,959 | 1,818 | 1,580 | 18,395 | ||||||
2005 |
||||||||||||
Equities |
2,357 | 1,433 | 1,323 | 1,528 | 393 | 7,034 | ||||||
Interest-bearing securities |
6,452 | 635 | 398 | 336 | 1,001 | 8,822 | ||||||
Other |
| 686 | 100 | 16 | 126 | 928 | ||||||
Total |
8,809 | 2,754 | 1,821 | 1,880 | 1,520 | 16,784 | ||||||
87
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Only a minor part of plan assets are invested in the Companys equity securities or in interest-bearing securities issued by the Company. Expected contributions to defined benefit plans during 2007 are slightly higher compared to 2006.
ACCRUED/PREPAID PENSION COST
Sweden | UK | Eurozone | US | Other | Total | |||||||
2006 |
||||||||||||
Fair value of plan assets |
9,141 | 3,897 | 1,959 | 1,818 | 1,580 | 18,395 | ||||||
DBO |
11,772 | 5,713 | 3,241 | 2,399 | 1,487 | 24,612 | ||||||
Deficit/Surplus (-/+) |
-2,631 | -1,816 | -1,282 | -581 | 93 | -6,217 | ||||||
Unrecognized past service cost |
| | | 6 | 77 | 83 | ||||||
Accrued/Prepaid pension cost, net (-/+) |
-2,631 | -1,816 | -1,282 | -575 | 170 | -6,134 | ||||||
2005 |
||||||||||||
Fair Value of plan assets |
8,809 | 2,754 | 1,821 | 1,880 | 1,520 | 16,784 | ||||||
DBO |
11,632 | 3,795 | 2,475 | 2,863 | 1,549 | 22,314 | ||||||
Deficit/Surplus (-/+) |
-2,823 | -1,041 | -654 | -983 | -29 | -5,530 | ||||||
Unrecognized past service cost |
| | | | 92 | 92 | ||||||
Accrued/Prepaid pension cost, net (-/+) |
-2,823 | -1,041 | -654 | -983 | 63 | -5,438 | ||||||
AMOUNT RECOGNIZED IN THE CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET, 2006 | ||||||||||||
Sweden | UK | Eurozone | US | Other | Total | |||||||
2006 |
||||||||||||
Opening balance |
2,823 | 1,041 | 654 | 983 | -63 | 5,438 | ||||||
Annual pension cost |
347 | 249 | 300 | 49 | 44 | 989 | ||||||
Recognized actuarial gain/loss (-/+) current period |
-470 | 741 | -282 | -135 | -84 | -230 | ||||||
Benefits paid by the Company |
-69 | | -43 | -28 | -8 | -148 | ||||||
Employer contributions |
| -191 | -99 | -211 | -61 | -562 | ||||||
Business combinations |
| | 781 | 28 | 7 | 816 | ||||||
Other |
| | 11 | | 1 | 12 | ||||||
Translation difference for the year |
| -24 | -40 | -111 | -6 | -181 | ||||||
Closing balance |
2,631 | 1,816 | 1,282 | 575 | -170 | 6,134 | ||||||
Plans with net surplus |
| | 310 | 41 | 483 | 834 | ||||||
Provision for Post-employment benefits |
2,631 | 1,816 | 1,592 | 616 | 313 | 6,968 | ||||||
2005 |
||||||||||||
Opening balance |
8,190 | 1,004 | 598 | 945 | 249 | 10,986 | ||||||
Annual pension cost |
417 | 71 | 200 | 101 | 107 | 896 | ||||||
Recognized actuarial gain/loss (-/+) current period |
2,626 | 239 | -16 | -144 | -111 | 2,594 | ||||||
Benefits paid by the Company |
-71 | | -23 | -35 | -13 | -142 | ||||||
Employer contributions |
-8,338 | -352 | -102 | -43 | -110 | -8,945 | ||||||
Business combinations |
| | | | 27 | 27 | ||||||
Reclassification |
| | -33 | | -94 | -127 | ||||||
Other |
-1 | | | -3 | -19 | -23 | ||||||
Translation difference for the period |
| 79 | 30 | 162 | -99 | 172 | ||||||
Closing balance |
2,823 | 1,041 | 654 | 983 | 63 | 5,438 | ||||||
Plans with net surplus |
| | 86 | | 367 | 453 | ||||||
Provision for Post-employment benefits |
2,823 | 1,041 | 740 | 983 | 304 | 5,891 | ||||||
88
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Total accrued/prepaid pension cost, SEK 6,134 (5,438) million are reported gross by plan in the balance sheet. Plans with net assets are reported as Other financial assets, non-current, amounting to SEK 834 (453) million and plans with net liabilities are reported as Post-employment benefits, total SEK 6,968 (5,891) million.
ACTUARIAL GAINS AND LOSSES REPORTED DIRECTLY IN EQUITY
2006 | 2005 | |||
Cumulative loss at beginning of year |
3,483 | 899 | ||
Recognized gain/loss (-/+) during the year |
-230 | 2,594 | ||
Translation difference for the year |
8 | -10 | ||
Effects related to the divested defense business |
-196 | |||
Cumulative loss at end of year |
3,065 | 3,483 | ||
MULTI-YEAR SUMMARY
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
Plan assets |
18,395 | 16,784 | 5,764 | |||
DBO |
24,612 | 22,314 | 16,820 | |||
Deficit/Surplus (-/+) |
-6,217 | -5,530 | -11,056 | |||
Actuarial gains and losses (-/+) |
||||||
Experience-based adjustments of pension obligations |
232 | -415 | -56 | |||
Experience-based adjustments of plan assets |
-358 | -706 | -146 | |||
THE EFFECT OF A ONE PERCENTAGE POINT CHANGE IN THE ASSUMED TREND RATE OF MEDICAL COSTS
1 percent increase |
1 percent decrease | |||
Net periodic post-employment medical costs |
4 | -3 | ||
Accumulated post-employment benefit obligation for medical costs |
55 | -47 |
Actuarial assumptions
The discount rate for each country is determined by reference to market yields on high-quality corporate bonds. In countries where there is no deep market in such bonds, the market yields on government bonds are used.
The overall expected long-term return on plan assets is a weighted average of each asset-categorys expected rate of return.
The expected return on interest-bearing investments are set in line with each countrys market yield.
Expected return on equities is derived from each countrys risk-free rate with the addition of a risk premium.
89
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
The principal actuarial assumptions used were as follows:
PRINCIPAL ACTUARIAL ASSUMPTIONS
Sweden | UK | Eurozone 1) | US | Other 1) | |||||||||||
2006 |
|||||||||||||||
Discount rate |
3.7 | % | 5.0 | % | 4.5 | % | 6.0 | % | 8.25 | % | |||||
Expected return on plan assets for the year |
4.0 | % | 6.2 | % | 5.75 | % | 8.0 | % | 9.5 | % | |||||
Future salary increases |
3.0 | % | 4.5 | % | 3.0 | % | 4.5 | % | 6.0 | % | |||||
Health care cost inflation, current year |
n/a | n/a | n/a | 10.0 | % | n/a | |||||||||
2005 |
|||||||||||||||
Discount rate |
3.5 | % | 4.7 | % | 4.5 | % | 5.5 | % | 8.0 | % | |||||
Expected return on plan assets for the year |
3.2 | % | 7.0 | % | 6.25 | % | 8.0 | % | 8.0 | % | |||||
Future salary increases |
3.0 | % | 4.0 | % | 3.25 | % | 4.5 | % | 6.0 | % | |||||
Health care cost inflation, current year |
n/a | n/a | n/a | 10 | % | n/a | |||||||||
1) | Weighted average |
LIFE EXPECTANCY AFTER AGE 65
(Years) |
Sweden | UK | Eurozone 1) | US | Other 1) | |||||
Men |
18 | 21 | 20 | 18 | 17 | |||||
Women |
22 | 24 | 24 | 20 | 20 | |||||
1) | Weighted average |
Ericsson has adopted the new option in IAS 19 to charge actuarial gains and losses directly to equity as from January 1, 2006. The change in accounting policy was recognized retrospectively in accordance with the transitional provisions of the amendment, and earlier periods have been restated. The changes in accounting policy had the following impact on the consolidated financial statements:
EFFECTS OF CHANGES IN ACCOUNTING POLICY IAS 19
Dec 31, 2005 with corridor method |
Effects from changes in accounting policy |
Dec 31, 2005 with equity method | |||||
Income statement |
|||||||
No restatement has been made in the income statement due to minor amounts. |
|||||||
Recognized income and expense |
|||||||
Income and expenses recognized directly in equity |
2,470 | -4,280 | 1) | -1,810 | |||
Tax on items reported in/transferred from equity |
298 | 1,225 | 2) | 1,523 | |||
Total recognized income and expense for the period |
2,768 | -3,055 | 287 | ||||
Balance sheet |
|||||||
Other financial assets, non current |
3,514 | -718 | 2,796 | ||||
Deferred tax assets |
17,294 | 1,225 | 18,519 | ||||
Stockholders equity |
104,677 | -3,055 | 101,622 | ||||
Post-employment benefits |
3,125 | 2,766 | 5,891 | ||||
Other current liabilities |
40,825 | 796 | 41,621 | ||||
90
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
1) | Of which SEK -1,059 million relate to 2004. |
2) | Of which SEK 319 million relate to 2004. |
Warranty commitments |
Restructuring | Other1)2) | Total provisions | |||||
2006 |
||||||||
Opening balance |
4,821 | 2,314 | 11,533 | 18,668 | ||||
Additions |
2,561 | 2,765 | 5,420 | 10,746 | ||||
Costs incurred |
-3,471 | -2,308 | -4,561 | -10,340 | ||||
Reversal of excess amounts |
-1,100 | -416 | -3,231 | -4,747 | ||||
Balances regarding divested/acquired businesses |
224 | 20 | -24 | 220 | ||||
Reclassification |
15 | 19 | -121 | -87 | ||||
Translation difference for the year |
-89 | -117 | -372 | -578 | ||||
Closing balance |
2,961 | 2,277 | 8,644 | 13,882 | ||||
2005 |
||||||||
Opening balance |
6,424 | 3,598 | 14,756 | 24,778 | ||||
Additions |
2,858 | 1,323 | 5,564 | 9,745 | ||||
Costs incurred |
-3,181 | -1,983 | -6,894 | -12,058 | ||||
Reversal of excess amounts |
-1,390 | -480 | -2,923 | -4,793 | ||||
Balances regarding divested/acquired businesses |
6 | | | 6 | ||||
Reclassification |
3 | -322 | 224 | -95 | ||||
Translation difference for the year |
101 | 178 | 806 | 1,085 | ||||
Closing balance |
4,821 | 2,314 | 11,533 | 18,668 | ||||
1) | Both current and non-current provisions. |
2) | Off-balance customer financing is included in other provisions. |
WARRANTY COMMITMENTS
Warranty provisions are based on historic quality rates as well as assumptions on estimated quality rates for new products and costs to remedy the various types of faults predicted. The actual utilization for 2006 was SEK 3.5 billion, compared to the expected SEK 2.9 billion. However, due to more favorable outcomes in certain parts, reversals of SEK 1.1 billion were made. The expected utilization of warranty provisions during year 2007 is SEK 2.2 billion.
RESTRUCTURING
In the third quarter 2006, restructuring provisions were made for the Career change offer in Sweden, SEK 0.6 billion , and for the Marconi integration, SEK 1.4 billion. In the fourth quarter, SEK 0.8 billion were paid out of the restructuring provision made during the year.
Restructuring provisions amounting to SEK 2.3 billion were utilized during 2006, compared to the expected SEK 1.5 billion.
The reversal of SEK 0.4 billion mainly relate to real estate provisions which have been reversed due to more favorable outcome of leasing commitments.
91
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Remaining restructuring provisions are mostly related to Marconi restructuring activities and unutilized leased real estate. The majority of these real estate leases will expire in one to five years, and the last one in year 2028. The values of the real estate commitments are calculated based on the net present value of the future lease payments minus the forecasted sublease revenues. The expected utilization of restructuring provisions during 2007 is SEK 1.6 billion and a major part of these relate to Marconi restructuring.
OTHER
Other provisions include estimated obligations related to patent and other litigations, contractual discounts and penalties of uncertain timing or amount, supplier or subcontractor claims and/or disputes, off-balance customer financing, as well as provisions for unresolved income tax and value added tax issues and estimated losses on customer contracts. On a quarterly basis, management performs an analysis of all provisions to identify the need for new additions or reversals. Management uses its best judgement to estimate provisions based on this analysis. The actual utilization for 2006 was SEK 4.6 billion, compared to the estimated SEK 7.0 billion. In certain circumstances provisions are no longer required, due to more favorable outcomes than anticipated, for instance when certain disputes in some cases have been resolved in a positive way. Therefore excess amounts have been reversed with SEK 3.2 billion 2006. The expected utilization in 2007 is SEK 4.5 billion.
C19 INTEREST-BEARING LIABILITIES
Ericssons outstanding interest-bearing liabilities were SEK 14.6 (25.0) billion as of December 31, 2006.
INTEREST-BEARING LIABILITIES
2006 | 2005 | |||
Borrowings, current |
||||
Current part of non-current borrowings1) |
88 | 9,615 | ||
Other current borrowings |
1,592 | 1,169 | ||
Total current borrowings |
1,680 | 10,784 | ||
Borrowings, non-current |
||||
Notes and bond loans |
11,204 | 11,475 | ||
Other borrowings, non-current |
1,700 | 2,710 | ||
Total non-current interest bearing liabilities |
12,904 | 14,185 | ||
Total interest-bearing liabilities |
14,584 | 24,969 | ||
1) | Including notes and bond loans of SEK 0 (9,614) million. |
NOTES AND BOND LOANS
Issued-maturing |
Nominal | Coupon | Currency | Book value (SEK m.) |
Maturity date (yy-mm-dd) |
|||||||||
1999-2009 |
483 | 6.500 | % | USD | 3,311 | 3) | 09-05-20 | |||||||
2001-2008 |
226 | 1) | 7.375 | % | GBP | 3,044 | 3) | 08-06-05 | ||||||
2003-2010 |
471 | 2) | 6.750 | % | EUR | 4,255 | 3) | 10-11-28 | ||||||
2004-2012 |
450 | 3.935 | % | SEK | 594 | 12-12-07 | 4) | |||||||
Total |
11,204 | |||||||||||||
92
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
1) | The GBP 226 million bond has interest rates linked to the Companys credit rating. The interest will increase/decrease 0.25 percent per annum for each rating notch change per rating agency (Moodys and Standard & Poors). The interest rate applicable to this bond cannot be less than the initial interest rates in the loan agreements. |
2) | The EUR 471 million bond is callable after 2007; the fair value of the embedded derivative is included in the book value of the bond. |
3) | Interest rate swaps are designated as fair value hedges. |
4) | Contractual repricing date 2007-06-07. |
All outstanding notes and bond loans are issued by the Parent Company under its Euro Medium Term Note program. Bonds issued at a fixed interest rate are swapped to a floating interest rate using interest rate swaps, resulting in a weighted average interest rate of 4,70 percent at December 31, 2006. These bonds are revalued based on changes in benchmark interest rates according to the Fair Value hedge methodology stipulated in IAS 39. As the notes and bond loans are issued at par the effective interest rate is the same as the coupon rate.
One note and one bond were redeemed during 2006. One USD-FRN with a nominal amount of USD 15 million and a EUR-bond with a nominal amount of EUR 1,000 million.
C20 FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT AND FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT
Ericssons financial risk management is governed by a policy approved by the Board of Directors. The Finance Committee of the Board of Directors is responsible for approving certain matters regarding investments, loans, guarantees and customer financing commitments and is continuously monitoring the exposure to financial risks.
The Board of Directors has established risk limits for defined exposures to foreign exchange and interest rate risks.
Ericsson has a treasury function with the principal role to ensure that appropriate financing is in place through loans and committed credit facilities, to actively manage the Groups liquidity as well as financial assets and liabilities, and to manage and control financial risk exposures in a manner consistent with underlying business risks and financial policies. Hedging activities and cash management are largely centralized to the treasury function in Stockholm.
Ericsson also has a customer finance function with the main objective to find suitable third-party financing solutions for customers and to minimize recourse to Ericsson. To the extent customer loans are not provided directly by banks, the Parent Company provides or guarantees vendor credits. The customer finance function monitors the exposure from outstanding vendor credits and credit commitments.
Ericsson classifies financial risks as:
| foreign exchange risk |
| interest rate risk |
| credit risk |
| liquidity and refinancing risk |
| market price risk in own and other listed equity instruments. |
93
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Foreign exchange risk
Ericsson has significant revenues, costs, assets and liabilities in currencies other than SEK, which results in a substantial foreign exchange rate exposure in the income statement, balance sheet and cash flows. When managing foreign exchange risk, Ericsson distinguishes between two types of exposure: transaction and translation exposure.
Transaction exposure
An analysis of Ericssons annualized transaction exposure shows that the predominant part is related to transactions in USD (revenue) and SEK (cost of sales). A change in the exchange rate of +/ 10 percent between SEK and USD, would have an estimated annualized impact on the operating income by SEK 3.8 (3.3) billion before tax and hedging effects. However, these effects may be compensated over time with new contracts with adjusted prices and costs.
Foreign exchange risk is as far as possible concentrated to Swedish group companies. Sales to foreign subsidiaries are normally invoiced in the functional currency of the receiving entity. In order to limit the exposure toward exchange rate fluctuations on future revenue or expenditure, committed and forecasted net exposure by period of future sales and purchases in major currencies were hedged, on average, for the coming 69 months in 2006. Trade receivables and payables in foreign currencies are generally fully hedged.
Internal currency forward contracts are primarily used for hedging future revenues and expenditures on subsidiary level. External forward contracts are designated as cash flow hedges of the net exposure for the main currencies and companies of the Group.
Other foreign exchange exposures in balance sheet items are hedged through offsetting balances or derivatives.
As of December 31, 2006, outstanding foreign exchange derivatives hedging transaction exposures had a positive net market value of SEK 2.3 (2.6) billion. The market value is partly deferred in the hedge reserve in equity to offset the gains/losses on hedged future sales in foreign currency. The remaining positive balance corresponds to depreciation of trade receivable balances being remeasured at lower rates compared to the exchange rates prevailing when originated.
Translation exposure
Ericsson has many subsidiaries operating outside Sweden. The net results in such companies and the value of such foreign equity investments are exposed to exchange rate fluctuations, which affect the consolidated income statement and balance sheet when translated to SEK.
Translation exposure in foreign subsidiaries is hedged according to the following policy established by the Board of Directors:
Translation risk relating to equity in foreign companies is hedged up to 20 percent in selected companies. The translation differences reported in equity during 2006 were negative, SEK 3.1 billion, including hedging gains of SEK 0.1 billion.
94
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
OUTSTANDING CURRENCY DERIVATIVES
Currency |
2006 | 2005 | ||||||||||||
Nominal currency |
Asset SEK |
Liability SEK1) |
Nominal currency |
Asset SEK1) |
Liability SEK | |||||||||
Maturity up to one year |
EUR | 2,062 | 370 | 70 | 3,381 | 116 | 142 | |||||||
USD | 6,764 | 2,281 | 726 | 5,247 | 607 | 2,665 | ||||||||
Other | 456 | -40 | 46 | 460 | ||||||||||
Total Currency derivatives with maturity up to one year |
3,107 | 756 | 769 | 3,267 | ||||||||||
Maturity one to three years |
EUR | 1,043 | 90 | 0 | 298 | -16 | 0 | |||||||
USD | 109 | 63 | 29 | 290 | 69 | 103 | ||||||||
Other | 58 | -17 | 13 | 17 | ||||||||||
Total Currency derivatives with maturity one to three years |
211 | 12 | 66 | 120 | ||||||||||
Maturity three to five years |
EUR | 471 | 17 | 0 | ||||||||||
Total Currency derivatives with maturity three to five years |
17 | 0 | ||||||||||||
Total currency derivatives |
3,335 | 768 | 835 | 3,387 | ||||||||||
(of which is included in Cash flow hedge relations) |
1,239 | 158 | 113 | 1,172 | ||||||||||
OUTSTANDING INTEREST RATE DERIVATIVES
2006 | 2005 | ||||||||||||||
Currency | Nominal currency |
Asset SEK |
Liability SEK 1) |
Nominal currency |
Asset SEK |
Liability SEK 1) | |||||||||
Maturity up to one year |
EUR | 260 | 0 | 2 | 1,412 | 408 | 0 | ||||||||
NOK | 24,289 | 12 | 23 | 2 | | 2 | |||||||||
SEK | 42,820 | 119 | 63 | 23,186 | 15 | 20 | |||||||||
Other | 0 | 4 | 4 | 4 | |||||||||||
Total maturity up to one year |
131 | 92 | 427 | 26 | |||||||||||
Maturity one to three years |
GBP | 226 | 115 | 0 | 226 | 188 | 0 | ||||||||
NOK | 25,275 | 43 | -2 | | | ||||||||||
USD | 483 | 180 | 8 | 0 | 0 | ||||||||||
Other | 5 | 6 | 40 | 133 | |||||||||||
Total maturity one to three years |
343 | 12 | 228 | 133 | |||||||||||
Maturity three to five years |
EUR | 434 | 94 | 0 | 942 | 249 | | ||||||||
USD | 50 | 6 | 0 | 530 | 279 | 15 | |||||||||
SEK | | | | 360 | 1 | ||||||||||
Total maturity three to five years |
100 | 0 | 528 | 14 | |||||||||||
Maturity more than five years |
SEK | 1,428 | 9 | 11 | 2,105 | 1 | 3 | ||||||||
Total interest rate derivatives |
583 | 2) | 115 | 1,184 | 176 | ||||||||||
(of which is included in Fair value hedge relations) |
385 | 761 | |||||||||||||
95
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
1) | Negative amounts relate to effects from one exposure of a derivative that is positive/negative while the total effect of the derivative is the opposite. |
2) | Of which SEK 116 million is reported as non-current assets. |
Interest Rate Risk
Ericsson is exposed to interest rate risk through market value fluctuations in certain balance sheet items and through changes in interest expenses and revenues. The net cash position was SEK 40.7 (50.6) billion at the end of 2006, consisting of cash and bank, and short-term cash investments of SEK 62.3 (81.5) billion and interest-bearing liabilities and post-employment benefits of SEK 21.6 (30.9) billion. (Please note that Ericsson has adopted the new option in IAS 19 to charge actuarial gains/losses directly to equity, as from January 1, 2006. Earlier periods have been restated accordingly. For further information please see Notes to the consolidated statementsNote C17, Post-employment benefits.)
Outstanding customer financing credits, net of provisions, were SEK 3.7 (4.9) billion.
Ericsson seeks to avoid risk in the form of (i) a mismatch between fixed and floating interest rates in interest-bearing balance sheet items and (ii) significant fixed interest rate exposure in Ericssons net cash position. As of December 31, 2006, 100 (94) percent of Ericssons interest-bearing liabilities and 99 (99) percent of Ericssons interest-bearing assets had floating interest rates, i.e. interest periods of less than 12 months.
When managing the interest rate exposure, Ericsson uses derivative instruments, such as interest rate swaps.
Ericssons interest net and cash flows are exposed to interest rate fluctuations. A sustained change in interest rates of +/ 0.25 percentage points would, with the current net cash position, have an annual impact on the interest net of approximately SEK +/ 72 (+/135) million .
Credit Risk
Credit risk is divided into three categories: credit risk in trade receivables, customer finance risk and financial credit risk.
Credit risk in trade receivables
Trade receivables amounted to SEK 51.1 (41.2) billion as of December 31, 2006. Provisions for expected losses are regularly assessed and amounted to SEK 1.4 (1.4) billion as of December 31, 2006. Ericssons nominal credit losses have, however, historically been low. The amounts of trade receivables follow closely the distribution of Ericssons sales and do not include any major concentrations of credit risk by customer or by geography.
Customer finance risk
All major customer finance commitments are subject to approval by the Finance Committee of the Board of Directors according to the credit approval policy.
As of December 31, 2006, Ericssons total outstanding exposure related to customer finance credits was SEK 4.1 (7.0) billion. As of that date, Ericsson also had unutilized credit commitments of SEK 6.8 (3.6) billion.
96
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
The outstanding customer loans and financial guarantees relate to infrastructure projects in different geographic markets and to a large number of customers. As of December 31, 2006, there were a total of 66 customer loans originated by or guaranteed by Ericsson. The five largest customer finance arrangements represented 60 percent of the total credit exposure. Security arrangements for customer credits normally include pledges of equipment, pledges of certain of the borrowers assets and pledges of shares in the operating company. Restructuring efforts for cases of troubled debt may lead to temporary holdings of equity interests.
The table below summarizes Ericssons outstanding customer finance credits as of December 31, 2005 and 2006.
OUTSTANDING CUSTOMER FINANCE CREDITS
(SEK billion) |
2006 | 2005 | ||
On-balance sheet credits |
4.1 | 7.0 | ||
Off-balance sheet credits |
0.0 | 0.1 | ||
Total credits |
4.1 | 7.1 | ||
Accrued interest |
0.1 | 0.1 | ||
Less third-party risk coverage |
-0.1 | -0.2 | ||
Ericssons risk exposure |
4.1 | 7.0 | ||
On-balance sheet credits, net value |
3.8 | 5.0 | ||
Reclassifications 1) |
-0.1 | -0.1 | ||
On-balance sheet credits, net book value |
3.7 | 4.9 | ||
Credit commitments for customer financing |
6.8 | 3.6 | ||
1) | Reclassification due to consolidation in accordance with SIC 12. |
Of Ericssons total outstanding customer finance credit exposure as of December 31, 2006, 52 percent related to Central and Eastern Europe, Middle East & Africa, 36 percent to Latin America, 7 percent to Western Europe, 4 percent to Asia Pacific and 1 percent to North America.
The net effect of risk provisions and reversals for customer financing affecting operating expenses, amounted to a positive impact of SEK 1.1 billion in 2006, compared to SEK 1.0 billion in 2005. In 2006 and 2005, Ericsson incurred credit losses of SEK 0.3 billion and SEK 0.4 billion respectively.
Financial credit risk
Financial instruments carry an element of risk in that counterparts may be unable to fulfill their payment obligations. This exposure arises in the investments in cash and cash equivalents and from derivative positions with positive unrealized result against banks and other counterparties.
Ericsson mitigates these risks by investing cash primarily in well-rated commercial papers, treasury bills and floating rate notes with short-term ratings of at least A-2/P-2 and long-term ratings of at least A-/A3 and in liquidity funds with a rating of at least A. Separate credit limits are assigned to each counterpart in order to minimize risk concentration. All derivative transactions are covered by ISDA netting agreements to reduce the credit risk. No credit losses were incurred during 2006, neither on external investments nor on derivative positions.
97
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
At December 31, 2006, the credit risk in financial cash instruments was equal to the instruments carrying value. Credit exposure in derivative instruments was SEK 3.9 (2.0) billion.
Liquidity Risk
Liquidity risk is that Ericsson is unable to meet its short-term payment obligations due to insufficient or illiquid cash reserves.
Ericsson maintains sufficient liquidity through centralized cash management, investments in highly liquid interest-bearing securities, and by having sufficient committed credit lines in place to meet potential funding needs. The current cash position is deemed to satisfy all short-term liquidity requirements.
During 2006, cash and bank and short-term cash investments decreased by SEK 19.2 billion to SEK 62.3 billion, mainly due to repayment of non-current debt and investment in new business combinations. The decrease was partly offset by a positive operating cash flow.
CASH AND SHORT-TERM CASH INVESTMENTS
Remaining time to maturity | ||||||||||||
(SEK billion) |
< 3 months |
< 1 year |
15 years |
>5 years |
2006 | 2005 | ||||||
Total Group |
33.0 | 9.0 | 20.3 | | 62.3 | 81.5 |
The instruments are classified as held for trading and therefore short term investments.
Refinancing risk
Refinancing risk is the risk that Ericsson is unable to refinance outstanding debt at reasonable terms and conditions, or at all, at a given point in time.
REPAYMENT SCHEDULE OF LONG-TERM BORROWINGS 1)
Nominal amount (SEK billion) |
Current maturities of long- term debt |
Notes and bonds (non- current) |
Liabilities to financial institutions (non-current) |
Total | ||||
2007 |
0.1 | | | 0.1 | ||||
2008 |
| 3.0 | 0.1 | 3.1 | ||||
2009 |
| 3.3 | 0.1 | 3.4 | ||||
2010 |
| 4.3 | 0.1 | 4.4 | ||||
2011 |
| | | | ||||
2012 |
| 0.5 | | 0.5 | ||||
Total |
0.1 | 11.1 | 0.3 | 11.5 | ||||
1) | Excluding finance leases reported in Note C27, Leasing. |
Debt financing is mainly carried out through borrowing in the Swedish and international debt capital markets.
Bank financing is used for certain subsidiary funding and to obtain committed credit facilities.
98
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
FUNDING PROGRAMS
Amount | Utilized | Unutilized | ||||
Euro Medium Term Note program (USD m.) |
5,000 | 1,585 | 3,415 | |||
Euro Commercial Paper program (USD m.) |
1,500 | | 1,500 | |||
Swedish Commercial Paper program (SEK m.) |
5,000 | | 5,000 | |||
Long-term Committed Credit facility (USD m.) |
1,000 | | 1,000 | |||
Short-term Committed Credit facilities (SEK m.) |
273 | | 273 |
The USD 1 billion committed credit facility has interest rates linked to our credit rating.
Moodys credit rating agency raised Ericssons credit rating during 2006, while Standard & Poors (S&P) last upgraded their ratings in 2005. At year-end, their ratings of Ericssons creditworthiness were Baa2 (Baa3) for Moodys and BBB for S&P, both considered to be Investment Grade.
Financial Instruments Carried at other than Fair Value
In the following tables, carrying amounts and fair values of financial instruments that are carried in the financial statements at other than fair values are presented. Assets valued at fair value through profit or loss have a net gain of SEK 637 million. For further information about valuation principles, please see Note C1, Significant accounting policies.
FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS CARRIED AT OTHER THAN FAIR VALUE
Carrying amount | Fair value | |||||||
(SEK billion) |
2006 | 2005 | 2006 | 2005 | ||||
Current maturities of non-current borrowings |
0.1 | 9.6 | 0.1 | 9.7 | ||||
Notes and bonds |
11.2 | 12.3 | 11.7 | 13.0 | ||||
11.3 | 21.9 | 11.8 | 22.7 | |||||
Financial instruments excluded from the tables, such as trade receivables and payables are carried at amortized cost which is deemed to be equal to fair value. When a market price is not readily available and there is insignificant interest rate exposure affecting the value, the carrying value is considered to represent a reasonable estimate of a fair value.
Market Price Risk in Own Shares and Other Listed Equity Investments
Risk related to our own share price
Ericsson is exposed to the development of its own share price through stock option and stock purchase plans for employees. The obligation to deliver shares under these plans is covered by holding Ericsson Class B shares as treasury stock and warrants for issuance of new Ericsson Class B shares. An increase in the share price will result in social security charges, which represents a risk to both income and cash flow. The cash flow exposure is fully hedged through the holding of Ericsson Class B shares as treasury stock to be sold to generate funds to cover also social security payments, and through the purchase of call options on Ericsson Class B shares.
Risk related to the prices of listed equity investments
Through investments in equity of listed companies Ericsson is exposed to market value fluctuations of such instruments. Such investments, however, constitute a very limited part of Ericssons financial assets.
99
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
2006 | 2005 | |||
Income tax liabilities |
1,969 | 1,260 | ||
Advances from customers |
1,441 | 4,059 | ||
Liabilities to associated companies |
31 | 34 | ||
Accrued interest |
365 | 770 | ||
Accrued expenses, of which |
19,040 | 20,379 | ||
employee related |
8,042 | 7,983 | ||
other |
10,998 | 12,396 | ||
Deferred revenues |
4,583 | 3,558 | ||
Derivatives with a negative value |
883 | 3,607 | ||
Other |
8,866 | 7,954 | ||
Total |
37,178 | 41,621 | ||
The major items within Other are value added tax payables and amounts withheld due to employees.
2006 | 2005 | |||
Payables to associated companies and joint ventures |
730 | 351 | ||
Other |
17,453 | 12,233 | ||
Total |
18,183 | 12,584 | ||
C23 ASSETS PLEDGED AS COLLATERAL
2006 | 2005 | |||
Real estate mortgages |
| 10 | ||
Chattel mortgages |
114 | 166 | ||
Bank deposits |
171 | 373 | ||
Total |
285 | 549 | ||
There were no collaterals for subsidiary financing during 2006 (SEK 151 million 2005). The remaining bank deposits relate to a capital insurance for the employees.
2006 | 2005 | |||
Guarantees for customer financing |
30 | 67 | ||
Other contingent liabilities |
1,362 | 1,641 | ||
Total |
1,392 | 1,708 | ||
Guarantees for customer financing relate to arrangements where Ericsson is the guarantor for customers payment obligations under credit facilities. A lender under these credit facilities is normally a bank, which thus is the beneficiary of the Ericsson guarantee, covering the entire or part of the outstanding principal amount and accrued interest. The guarantees for customer finance are shown above at their net value (i.e. after provisions).
Other contingent liabilities assumed by Ericsson include guarantees of loans to other companies of SEK 95 (186) million. Ericsson has SEK 496 (760) million issued to guarantee the performance of a third party.
100
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Interest paid in 2006 was SEK 1,353 million (SEK 2,577 million in 2005, SEK 3,492 million in 2004) and interest received was SEK 1,539 million (SEK 2,142 million in 2005, SEK 3,662 million in 2004). Taxes paid, including withholding tax, were SEK 3,649 million (SEK 2,010 million in 2005, SEK 2,944 million in 2004).
For more information regarding the disposition of cash and cash equivalents and unutilized credit commitments, see Note C20Financial Risk Management and Financial Instruments.
Cash restricted due to currency restrictions or other legal restrictions in certain countries amounted to SEK 5,794 million (SEK 3,773 million in 2005, SEK 2,156 million in 2004).
ADJUSTMENTS TO RECONCILE NET INCOME TO CASH
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
Property, plant and equipment |
||||||
Depreciation |
3,007 | 2,804 | 2,434 | |||
Impairment losses/reversals of impairments |
30 | -366 | 10 | |||
Total |
3,037 | 2,438 | 2,444 | |||
Intangible assets |
||||||
Amortization |
||||||
Capitalized development costs |
2,277 | 3,009 | 4,139 | |||
Intellectual Property Rights |
1,960 | 260 | 313 | |||
Total amortization |
4,237 | 3,269 | 4,452 | |||
Impairments |
||||||
Capitalized development costs |
242 | 95 | 108 | |||
Intellectual Property Rights |
| | | |||
Total impairment losses |
242 | 95 | 108 | |||
Total |
4,479 | 3,364 | 4,560 | |||
Total depreciation, amortization and impairment losses on property, plant and equipment and intangible assets |
7,516 | 5,802 | 7,004 | |||
Taxes |
4,282 | 5,518 | 4,483 | |||
Dividends from joint ventures/ associated companies |
1,262 | 31 | 97 | |||
Undistributed earnings in joint ventures/associated companies |
-4,233 | -2,154 | -1,511 | |||
Impairment losses on other investments in shares and participations and capital gains ()/losses on sale of fixed assets, excluding customer financing, net |
-2,815 | 35 | -121 | |||
Other non-cash items |
233 | 1,613 | 538 | |||
Total adjustments to reconcile net income to cash |
6,245 | 10,845 | 10,490 | |||
101
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
ACQUISITIONS AND DIVESTMENTS
Acquisitions
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
Intangible assets |
15,648 | 404 | 85 | |||
Property, plant and equipment |
1,257 | 15 | 149 | |||
Goodwill |
163 | 512 | 387 | |||
Other assets |
4,422 | 124 | 651 | |||
Provisions, including post-employment benefits |
-812 | -135 | | |||
Other liabilities |
-2,689 | -55 | -879 | |||
Purchase of minority holdings |
89 | 345 | 1,255 | |||
Cash and cash equivalents |
1,781 | 16 | 33 | |||
Total purchase price |
19,859 | 1,226 | 1,681 | |||
Less: |
||||||
Cash and cash equivalents |
1,781 | 16 | 33 | |||
Cash flow effect |
18,078 | 1,210 | 1,648 | |||
In 2006, Ericsson made acquisitions amounting to 18,078, primarily:
| The acquisition of certain assets relating to broadband access, optical and radio transmission systems, data networking and service layer from Marconi was completed on January 23, 2006, with a cash payment equivalent to SEK 17.6 billion. With net tangible assets of approximately SEK 4.0 billion, most of the acquisition costs were related to intellectual property rights, e.g. patents, brands, trade marks, etc., which will be amortized over a ten year period. The acquired businesses were consolidated into Ericssons accounts as per January 1, 2006. |
During the year, the acquired Marconi businesses were streamlined and fully integrated within Ericssons operations. This resulted in a 24 percent reduction of the former Marconi workforce for an estimated annual cost savings of approximately SEK 2.0 billion, with full effect from the fourth quarter of 2006. Restructuring charges were SEK 2.2 billion, of which about one third was utilized during 2006, with the remainder expected to be utilized during the first half of 2007. Of this charge, SEK 1.4 billion relates to the layoff of 1,600 employees and SEK 0.8 billion relates to the termination of IT agreements and facilities contracts that are no longer needed but were pre-paid as part of the acquisition. |
The countries affected were primarily the UK, Germany, Italy and the US. Revenues and profit related to the Marconi acquisition cannot be recognized separately, since the product portfolios of the Marconi business and Ericsson have been merged. Total transaction cost was SEK 160 million. |
| Netwise AB, acquired on August 11, 2006, develops and markets software within the growing area of Presence Management, team collaboration, integration of mobile phones, IP-telephony and multimedia. Netwise has subsidiaries in Sweden, Norway, Denmark, Finland, Germany and France. |
102
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
MARCONI BUSINESS
Net assets acquired |
Book Value |
Fair value adjustments |
Fair value | |||
Intangible assets |
||||||
Intellectual property rights |
| 11,748 | 11,748 | |||
Brands |
| 2,901 | 2,901 | |||
Customer relationships |
| 718 | 718 | |||
Goodwill |
| | | |||
Other assets and liabilities |
||||||
Inventory |
1,913 | | 1,913 | |||
Property, plant and equipment |
1,252 | | 1,252 | |||
Other assets |
4,197 | | 4,197 | |||
Post-employment benefits |
-812 | | -812 | |||
Other liabilities |
-2,557 | | -2,557 | |||
Total purchase price |
| | 19,360 | |||
Less: |
||||||
Cash and cash equivalents |
| | 1,748 | |||
Cash flow effect |
| | 17,612 | |||
Divestments | ||||||
Net assets disposed of |
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | |||
Property, plant and equipment |
253 | 3 | | |||
Other assets |
2,946 | 76 | 186 | |||
Provisions, including post-employment benefits |
-89 | -8 | | |||
Other liabilities |
-2,079 | -30 | -131 | |||
Gains from divestments |
2,945 | 16 | -31 | |||
Less: |
||||||
Cash and cash equivalents |
890 | 27 | 10 | |||
Cash flow effect |
3,086 | 30 | 14 | |||
In 2006, divestments made by Ericsson amounted to SEK 3,086 million, primarily:
| The Defense business, Ericsson Microwave Systems AB and its 40 procent holding in Saab Ericsson Space, was sold to Saab AB on September 1. Ericsson Microwave Systems is a leading provider of radar, command and control systems for defense applications. |
DEFENSE BUSINESS
Net assets disposed of |
||
Property, plant and equipment |
252 | |
Other assets |
2,744 | |
Provisions, including post- employment benefits |
-88 | |
Other liabilities |
-2,026 | |
Gains from divestments |
2,963 | |
Less: |
||
Cash and cash equivalents |
726 | |
Cash flow effect |
3,119 | |
103
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
LEASING WITH THE COMPANY AS LESSEE
Assets under finance leases, recorded as property, plant and equipment, consist of:
FINANCE LEASES
2006 | 2005 | |||
Acquisition costs |
||||
Real estate |
1,767 | 1,948 | ||
Machinery |
| | ||
Other equipment |
5 | 5 | ||
1,772 | 1,953 | |||
Accumulated depreciation |
||||
Real estate |
-544 | 502 | ||
Machinery |
| | ||
Other equipment |
-1 | -1 | ||
-545 | -503 | |||
Accumulated write-downs |
||||
Real estate |
-349 | -417 | ||
Machinery |
| | ||
Other equipment |
| | ||
-349 | -417 | |||
Net carrying value |
878 | 1,033 | ||
As of December 31, 2006, future minimum lease payment obligations for leases were distributed as follows:
Finance leases |
Operating leases | |||
2007 |
180 | 2,198 | ||
2008 |
182 | 1,830 | ||
2009 |
152 | 1,488 | ||
2010 |
138 | 1,228 | ||
2011 |
115 | 977 | ||
2012 and later |
1,440 | 3,504 | ||
Total |
2,207 | 11,225 | ||
Future finance charges1) |
-879 | n/a | ||
Present value of finance lease liabilities |
1,328 | 11,225 | ||
1) | Average effective interest rate on lease payables is 6.61 percent. |
Expenses in 2006 for leasing of assets were SEK 2,873 (2,686) million, of which variable expenses were SEK 11 (11) million. The leasing contracts vary in length from 1 to 22 years.
Most of the Companys lease agreements contain no contingent rents. In the few cases they occur it relates to charges for heating, linked to the oil price index. Most of the leases of real estate contain terms of renewal giving the right to prolong the agreement in question for a predefined period of time. All of the finance leases of facilities contain purchase options. Only a very limited number of the Companys lease agreements contain restrictions on stockholders equity or other means of finance. The major agreement contains a restriction stating that the Parent Company must maintain a stockholders equity of at least SEK 25 billion.
104
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
LEASES WITH THE COMPANY AS LESSOR
Leasing income mainly relates to income from sublease of real estate. These leasing contracts vary in length from 1 to 13 years.
At December 31, 2006, future minimum payment receivables were distributed as follows:
Finance leases |
Operating leases | |||
2007 |
| 132 | ||
2008 |
| 92 | ||
2009 |
| 72 | ||
2010 |
| 38 | ||
2011 |
| 23 | ||
2012 and later |
| 107 | ||
Total |
| 464 | ||
Unearned financial income |
| n/a | ||
Uncollectible lease payments |
| n/a | ||
Net investments in financial leases |
| n/a | ||
Leasing income in 2006 was SEK 149 (114) million.
C28 TAX ASSESSMENT VALUES IN SWEDEN
2006 | 2005 | |||
Land and land improvements |
60 | 60 | ||
Buildings |
235 | 235 | ||
Total |
295 | 295 | ||
C29 INFORMATION REGARDING EMPLOYEES, MEMBERS OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS AND MANAGEMENT
AVERAGE NUMBER OF EMPLOYEES
Men | Women | 2006 Total |
Men | Women | 2005 Total | |||||||
Western Europe1) |
31,212 | 8,697 | 39,909 | 25,188 | 8,516 | 33,704 | ||||||
Central and Eastern Europe, Middle East and Africa |
4,344 | 1,137 | 5,481 | 3,261 | 1,058 | 4,319 | ||||||
North America |
3,252 | 998 | 4,250 | 3,129 | 992 | 4,121 | ||||||
Latin America |
3,324 | 740 | 4,064 | 2,549 | 568 | 3,117 | ||||||
Asia Pacific |
8,017 | 2,765 | 10,782 | 6,541 | 2,393 | 8,934 | ||||||
Total2) |
50,149 | 14,337 | 64,486 | 40,668 | 13,527 | 54,195 | ||||||
1) Of which Sweden |
14,517 | 4,792 | 19,309 | 15,378 | 5,120 | 20,498 | ||||||
2) Of which EU |
32,007 | 8,925 | 40,932 | 25,713 | 8,688 | 34,401 |
Within the group of the 150 most senior executives, the distribution between females and males is 15.5 percent and 84.5 percent respectively.
105
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
NUMBER OF EMPLOYEES
As per December 31, | ||||
Employees by region |
2006 | 2005 | ||
Western Europe1) |
38,432 | 35,679 | ||
Central and Eastern Europe, Middle East and Africa |
6,325 | 4,533 | ||
North America |
4,138 | 3,911 | ||
Latin America |
4,498 | 3,382 | ||
Asia Pacific |
10,388 | 8,550 | ||
Total2) |
63,781 | 56,055 | ||
1) Of which Sweden |
19,094 | 21,178 | ||
2) Of which EU |
39,818 | 36,482 | ||
As per December 31, | ||||
Employees per segment |
2006 | 2005 | ||
Systems |
59,484 | 50,107 | ||
Other operations |
4,297 | 5,948 | ||
Total |
63,781 | 56,055 | ||
EMPLOYEES BY GENDER AND AGE AT YEAR END 2006
Female | Male | Percent of total |
|||||||
Under 25 years old |
674 | 2,369 | 5 | % | |||||
2635 years old |
5,663 | 18,507 | 38 | % | |||||
3645 years old |
5,276 | 18,755 | 38 | % | |||||
4655 years old |
1,950 | 7,820 | 15 | % | |||||
Over 55 years old |
573 | 2,194 | 4 | % | |||||
Percent of total |
22 | % | 78 | % | 100 | % | |||
NUMBER OF EMPLOYEES RELATED TO COST OF SALES AND OPERATING EXPENSES |
|
||||||||
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | |||||||
Cost of sales |
27,682 | 22,477 | 19,234 | ||||||
Operating expenses |
36,099 | 33,578 | 31,300 | ||||||
Total |
63,781 | 56,055 | 50,534 | ||||||
EMPLOYEE MOVEMENTS 2006 | ||
Head count at year-end |
63,781 | |
Departed employees |
6,432 | |
Employees joining the company |
14,158 | |
Temporary employees |
1,219 |
106
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
REMUNERATION |
||||
WAGES AND SALARIES AND SOCIAL SECURITY EXPENSES |
||||
2006 | 2005 | |||
Wages and salaries |
32,219 | 25,567 | ||
Social security expenses |
10,602 | 8,891 | ||
Of which pension costs |
2,709 | 2,165 | ||
Amounts related to the President and CEO and the group management team are included.
WAGES AND SALARIES PER GEOGRAPHICAL AREA |
||||
2006 | 2005 | |||
Western Europe1) |
22,296 | 17,706 | ||
Central and Eastern Europe, Middle East and Africa |
1,958 | 1,317 | ||
North America3) |
3,503 | 3,184 | ||
Latin America |
1,333 | 1,007 | ||
Asia Pacific |
3,129 | 2,353 | ||
Total 2) |
32,219 | 25,567 | ||
1) Of which Sweden |
11,467 | 10,721 | ||
2) Of which EU |
22,480 | 17,781 | ||
3) Of which United States |
2,244 | 1,823 | ||
Remuneration in foreign currency has been translated to SEK at average exchange rates for the year.
ELEMENTS IN TOTAL REMUNERATION FOR THE PRESIDENT AND CEO AND OTHER TOP EXECUTIVES
Objective |
Performance period |
Conditions | ||||
Fixed salary |
Competitive in the home country while tracking global compensation levels | N/A | Absolute level is determined by the size and complexity of the job and year-to-year performance of the individual jobholder | |||
Short-Term Variable salary |
Performance related |
Annual | Cash program based on achievement of specific business objectives derived from the annual business plan approved by the Board of Directors. The exact nature of the targets will vary depending on the specific job, but may include financial targetsat either corporate level or unit leveloperational targets, employee motivation targets and customer satisfaction targets | |||
Long-Term Variable compensation |
Performance related |
3 years | Payouts are determined by three specific variables; the individuals own investments in shares, a long-term financial target at Group level and the share price development. Share-based long-term variable plans are submitted each year for approval by the shareholders at the Annual General Meeting |
107
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Objective |
Performance period |
Conditions | ||||
Pension |
Competitive in the home country | N/A | Defined contribution plan for old age pension in addition to the basic pension plans in the Swedish labor market (the ITP plan) | |||
Other Benefits |
Competitive in the home country | N/A |
COMPENSATION POLICIES AND REMUNERATION TO THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS, THE PRESIDENT AND CEO AND OTHER TOP EXECUTIVES
The following information covers the remuneration for the Board of Directors, the President and CEO and the other top executives as required by applicable laws, rules and recommendations.
Principles for remuneration and other employment terms for Top Executives
The principles, approved by the Annual General Meeting 2006, cover remuneration and other employment terms for the President and CEO and other top executives.
The Remuneration Committee monitors pay trends within and outside Sweden to find competitive and performance driven remuneration packages for the top executives.
The total remuneration includes fixed salary, variable components in the form of short-term variable salary and long-term variable compensation, pension and other benefits according to the table Elements in total remuneration for the President and CEO and other top executives.
Performance is especially reflected in the variable componentsboth in the annual variable part and in the long-term variable portion. Although this may vary over time to take general trends in compensation into account, the target level of the annual component for Swedish top executives is currently about 20 percent of the total compensation (fixed salary, short-term variable salary and long-term variable compensation). The long-term component is also set to achieve a target of around 20 percent of the total compensation. In both cases the variable pay is measured against the achievement of specific business objectives.
Together, the variable components are set to a target of around 40 percent of the total compensation and the remaining part of around 60 percent for the fixed salary, reflecting the judgment of the Board of Directors as to the right balance between fixed and variable pay and the market practice for compensation of executives.
Pension
The pension age is normally 60 years for the President and CEO and the other top executives.
For the President and CEO and the other top executives a defined contribution plan is applied. They were also entitled to pension in accordance with the occupational pension plan for salaried staff on the Swedish labor market (ITP) from 65 years. From 2007, the pension age in the ITP plan is lowered to 60 years. These pension plans are portable.
108
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
In the defined contribution plan, the Company pays for old age pension a contribution between 10 and 35 percent per year on salary portions in excess of 20 base amounts (one base amount 2006 was SEK 44 500) of the executives pensionable salary. For the President and CEO the annual pension contribution is 35 percent of the pensionable salary above 20 base amounts.
The pensionable salary consists of the annual fixed salary and the target level of the annual variable salary.
Notice and severance pay
For the President and CEO and the other top executives the following applies:
The mutual notice period is 6 months. Upon termination of employment by the Company, severance pay amounting to a maximum of 18 months fixed salary is paid. Notice of termination given by the employee due to significant structural changes or other events occurred that, in a determining manner, affect the content of work or the condition for the position, is equated with notice of termination served by the Company. The severance pay is reduced by 50 percent of the salary or corresponding compensation which the employee would be entitled to from another employer or from own or other business during the period severance is paid from Ericsson.
PROPORTION OF FEMALES/MALES IN THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS AND OTHER TOP EXECUTIVES
Females | Males | |||||||
Board of Directors |
||||||||
2005-12-31 |
3 | 20% | 12 | 80% | ||||
2006-12-31 |
5 | 31% | 11 | 69% | ||||
Other Top Executives |
||||||||
2005-12-31 |
1 | 9% | 10 | 91% | ||||
2006-12-31 |
1 | 8% | 11 | 92% | ||||
109
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
COMPENSATION TO MEMBERS OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS DURING 2006
SEK |
Board member fee |
Committee fee |
Employee representative |
Total | ||||
Board member |
||||||||
Michael Treschow |
3,750,000 | 250,000 | | 4,000,000 | ||||
Sverker Martin-Löf |
750,000 | 350,000 | | 1,100,000 | ||||
Marcus Wallenberg |
750,000 | 125,000 | | 875,000 | ||||
Peter L. Bonfield |
750,000 | 250,000 | | 1,000,000 | ||||
Börje Ekholm |
750,000 | 125,000 | | 875,000 | ||||
Katherine Hudson |
750,000 | | | 750,000 | ||||
Ulf J. Johansson |
750,000 | 250,000 | | 1,000,000 | ||||
Nancy McKinstry |
750,000 | 125,000 | | 875,000 | ||||
Anders Nyrén |
750,000 | 125,000 | | 875,000 | ||||
Carl-Henric Svanberg |
| | | | ||||
Monica Bergström |
| 400 | 10,000 | 10,400 | ||||
Jan Hedlund |
| 900 | 10,000 | 10,900 | ||||
Torbjörn Nyman |
| 1,100 | 10,000 | 11,100 | ||||
Kristina Davidsson |
| | 4,000 | 4,000 | ||||
Anna Guldstrand |
| | 10,000 | 10,000 | ||||
Per Lindh |
| 400 | 9,000 | 9,400 | ||||
Arne Löfving |
| | 6,000 | 6,000 | ||||
Total |
9,750,000 | 1,602,800 | 59,000 | 11,411,800 | ||||
Social security fees |
3,683,729 | |||||||
Total |
15,095,529 | |||||||
Comments to the table
| The Chairman of the Board received a Board fee of SEK 3,750,000. The Chairman also received SEK 125,000 for each Board committee on which he served. |
| The other Directors appointed by the Annual General Meeting received a fee of SEK 750,000 each. In addition, each Director serving on a Board committee has received a fee of SEK 125,000 for each committee. However, the Chairman of the Audit Committee received a fee of SEK 350,000 and the other two members of the Audit Committee received a fee of SEK 250,000 each. |
| Members of the Board, who are not employees of the Company, have not received any compensation other than the fees paid for Board duties. |
| Members and Deputy Members of the Board who are Ericsson employees received no remuneration or benefits other than their entitlements as employees. However, a fee of SEK 1,000 per attended meeting was paid to each employee representative on the Board. Further, employee representatives being also members of a committee of the Board received a fee of SEK 100 for each committee meeting. |
| Arne Löfving resigned from the Board of Directors in August 2006 and was replaced by Kristina Davidsson. |
110
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
COMPENSATION PAID TO THE PRESIDENT AND CEO AND OTHER TOP EXECUTIVES DURING 2006
Salary and benefits, SEK |
The President |
Other Top Executives |
Total | |||
Salary |
15,271,483 | 44,170,661 | 59,442,144 | |||
Variable pay earned 2005 and paid 2006 |
8,700,000 | 23,423,344 | 32,123,344 | |||
Other benefits |
71,127 | 807,850 | 878,977 | |||
Total |
24,042,610 | 68,401,855 | 92,444,465 | |||
Comments to the table
| Other top executives included the following persons: Karl-Henrik Sundström, Sivert Bergman, Carl Olof Blomqvist, Marita Hellberg, Torbjörn Nilsson, Bert Nordberg, Henry Sténson, Joakim Westh, Håkan Eriksson, Kurt Jofs, Björn Olsson and Hans Vestberg. |
| Other benefits include the value of matching shares received during 2006 under the Stock Purchase Plan 2003. The value of matching shares for the President and CEO was SEK 27,429 corresponding to 989 Ericsson B-shares. For the other top executives the value for matched shares was SEK 135,839, corresponding to 4,900 Ericsson B shares. The above values are based on the share price at matching. |
| In addition to the above amounts, the Company has paid fees for an external lawyer and compensated for individual taxes on this benefit, totally SEK 7,458,949, for one person in the top executive group in connection with an alleged evasion of tax control. |
COMPENSATION COSTS INCURRED DURING 2006 FOR THE PRESIDENT AND CEO AND THE GROUP MANAGEMENT TEAM
Total costs, SEK |
The President |
Other Top Executives |
Total | |||
Salary |
15,271,483 | 44,170,661 | 59,442,144 | |||
Provisions for variable pay earned 2006 to be paid 2007 |
8,940,002 | 21,137,377 | 30,077,379 | |||
Other benefits |
4,025,547 | 10,258,162 | 14,283,709 | |||
Pension premiums |
6,493,648 | 20,981,148 | 27,474,796 | |||
Social security fees |
10,966,834 | 30,164,068 | 41,130,902 | |||
Total |
45,697,514 | 126,711,416 | 172,408,930 | |||
Comments to the table
| Other benefits include the compensation cost during 2006 for share based programs. For the President and CEO the cost was SEK 3,981,849 and for the other top executives SEK 9,586,151, which represent their part of total compensation costs as disclosed under Shares for all plans. |
Stock purchase programs are a part of the total remuneration package as a compensation for the services rendered by employees. Ericsson shall recognize the value of services received as compensation cost in the income statement at consumption of the services. |
| For the President and CEO, the above pension premium includes a fee of SEK 6,580,992 corresponding to 35 percent of his pensionable salary above 20 base amounts (one base amount 2006 was SEK 44,500), for a premium-based old age pension and a fee of SEK 373,656 for the ITP plan. Included in |
111
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
the pension premiums are also changes of commitments made to the President and CEO and the other top executives for benefit based temporary disability and survivals pensions until retirement age. For the President and CEO, the change of these commitments wasSEK 464,300, which amount has affected his total premiums for the year. |
| The Companys commitments for benefit-based pensions per December 31, 2006, under IAS 19 amounted to SEK 3,128,700 for the President and CEO, of which SEK 89,200 refers to old age pensions in the ITP plan and the remaining SEK 3,039,500 to temporary disability and survivals pensions until retirement age. For other top executives the Companys commitments amounted to SEK 36,869,094, of which 17,040,094 refers to old age pensions in the ITP plan. |
| Social security fees include payroll tax on pension premiums. |
| For previous Presidents, the Company has made provisions for defined benefit pension plans in connection with their active service periods within the Company. |
| In addition to the above amounts, the Company has incurred costs of SEK 9,866,698 whereof social security fees of SEK 2,407,749 for the above reported benefits for one person in the top executive group in connection with an alleged evasion of tax control. |
OUTSTANDING STOCK OPTIONS AND MATCHING RIGHTS
As per December 31, 2006 | ||||
Number of B shares |
The President |
Other Top Executives | ||
1999 Stock Option Plan |
| 13,816 | ||
Millenium Stock Option Plan |
| 1,238,240 | ||
Stock Option Plan 2001May Grant |
| 625,000 | ||
Stock Option Plan 2002 |
| 690,000 | ||
Stock Purchase Plan 2003 (two-year), 2005 and 2006, and Performance Matching Program 2004, 2005 and 2006 |
705,378 | 1,621,974 | ||
Comments to the tables
| For the definition of matching rights, see description under Long-term variable compensation. |
| The number of options presumes full exercise under applicable plans. The Millenium Stock Option Plan expired on January 17, 2007 and the 1999 Stock Option Plan will expire February 28, 2007. |
| For strike prices for option plans, see Long-term variable compensation. |
| The number of matching rights presumes maximum performance matching under Long-Term Incentive Plans 2004, 2005 and 2006. The matching under the Performance Matching Programs will start in 2007. |
LONG-TERM VARIABLE COMPENSATION
The Stock Purchase Plan
The Stock Purchase plan is designed to offer an incentive for all employees to participate in the Company, which is consistent with our industry and with our ways of working. Under the plans, employees can save up to 7.5 percent of the gross salary, for purchase of class B shares at market price on the Stockholm Stock Exchange or ADRs at NASDAQ (contribution shares). If the contribution shares are retained by the employee for three
112
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
years after the investment and the employment with the Ericsson Group continues during that time, the employees shares will be matched with a corresponding number of class B shares or ADRs free of consideration. Employees in 86 countries participate in the plan.
The below table shows the periods for employees purchase of shares (contribution period) and participation details in ongoing plans.
Plan |
Contribution period |
Number of participants at launch |
Take-up rate % of all employees |
||||
Stock Purchase plan 2003 1st year |
August 2003 July 2004 | 11,000 | 22 | % | |||
Stock Purchase plan 2003 2nd year |
August 2004 July 2005 | 15,000 | 30 | % | |||
Stock Purchase plan 2005 |
August 2005 July 2006 | 16,000 | 29 | % | |||
Stock Purchase plan 2006 |
August 2006 July 2007 | 17,000 | 29 | % |
The Key Contributor Program
The Key Contributor Program is designed to give recognition to key employees as a method of retention. Under the program, about 10 percent of the employees (2004: up to 4,500, 2005: up to 5,000 and 2006: up to 6,040) have been selected to obtain one extra matching share in addition to the ordinary one matching share for each contribution share purchased under the Stock Purchase Plan during a twelve-month program period. The program was introduced in 2004 and has been repeated 2005 and 2006.
The Performance Matching Program for executives
The Performance Matching Program is designed to focus the management on driving earnings and provide competitive compensation based on Swedish practice. Under the program, executives (2004: up to 200 executives, 2005 and 2006: up to 220 executives) have been selected to obtain up to four or six extra shares (performance matching shares) in addition to the ordinary one matching share for each contribution share purchased under the Stock Purchase Plan during a twelve-month program period. The performance matching is subject to the fulfillment of a performance target. Several possible measures have been evaluated, but earnings per share (EPS) growth during a three-year period has been found to best suit the Company. The program was introduced in 2004 and has been repeated 2005 and 2006. In the 2006 program, the CEO is allowed to invest up to 9 percent of the salary in shares and may obtain up to eight performance matching shares in addition to the ordinary one matching share.
The performance target for the 2004 program is annual average EPS growth between five (0 performance matching shares) and 25 percent (maximum performance matching shares). The performance target for the 2005 and 2006 programs is annual average EPS growth between three (0 performance matching shares) and 15 percent (maximum performance matching shares). The Board may reduce the number of performance matching shares, if deemed appropriate, considering the Companys financial results and position, conditions on the stock market and other circumstances at the time of matching.
It is the Board of Directors intention to repeat the Stock Purchase Plan, including the Key Contributor Program and the Performance Matching Program for next year.
Shares for all plans
All plans, except the Millennium Option Plan, are funded with treasury stock. Sale of shares is recognized directly in equity. The Millennium Stock Option Plan is based on warrants, i.e. options entitling the holders to
113
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
subscribe for Class B shares. The warrants are held by subsidiaries to Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericsson, which have granted options to their employees. Treasury stock for the 1999 Option Plan was repurchased in year 2000 on the Stockholm Stock Exchange. Treasury stock for all remaining plans was issued in a directed cash issue of Class C shares at a nominal amount of SEK 1, and purchased under a public offering at SEK 1 per share plus a premium corresponding to the subscribers financing costs, and then converted to Class B shares.
For all plans, additional shares and warrants have been allocated for financing of social security expenses. For the Millennium Stock Option Plan, the warrants designated for social security expenses have been exchanged for a call option issued by a bank in order to hedge also equity against potential social security payments. For all other plans, treasury stock is sold on the Stockholm Stock Exchange to cover the social security payments when arising due to exercise of options or matching of shares. During 2006, 2,075,564 shares were sold at an average price of SEK 27.07.
STOCK OPTION PLANS
Plan |
Grant/Expiry date | Exercise price 1) (SEK) |
Vesting period |
Number of participants at grant |
Number of participants end 2006 | |||||
1999 Stock Option Plan |
1 March 00/28 Feb 07 | 128.00 | 30% after 3 years, | 1,800 | 1,007 | |||||
40% after 4 years, | ||||||||||
30% after 5 years | ||||||||||
Millennium Stock Option Plan |
17 Jan 00/17 Jan 07 | 93.80 | 1/3 after 1 year, | 8,000 | 2,591 | |||||
1/3 after 2 years, | ||||||||||
1/3 after 3 years | ||||||||||
Stock Option Plan 2001 |
1/3 after 1 year, | |||||||||
May Grant |
14 May 01/14 May 08 | 30.50 | 1/3 after 2 years, | 15,000 | 7,698 | |||||
1/3 after 3 years | ||||||||||
Stock Option Plan 2001 |
1/3 after 1 year, | |||||||||
November Grant2) |
19 Nov 01/19 Nov 08 | 25.70 | 1/3 after 2 years, | 900 | 527 | |||||
1/3 after 3 years | ||||||||||
Stock Option Plan 20022) |
11 Nov 02/11 Nov 09 | 7.80 | 1/3 after 1 year, | 12,800 | 6,881 | |||||
1/3 after 2 years, | ||||||||||
1/3 after 3 years |
1) |
Market price at grant datere-pricing is only permitted under limited circumstances principally relating to changes in the capital structure of Ericsson. |
2) | For stock options exercised during 2006, the weighted average share price was SEK 26.49. |
If all options outstanding as of December 31, 2006, were exercised, all shares allocated for future matching under the Stock Purchase Plan were transferred, and shares designated to cover social security payments were disposed of as a result of the exercise and the matching, approximately 34 million Class B shares would be issued and approximately 197 million Class B shares, held as treasury stock, would be transferred. The total, approximately 231 million Class B shares, corresponds to 1.5 percent of the total number of shares outstanding, 15,881 million.
114
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
The below table shows the number of shares (representing options and matching rights but excluding shares for social security costs) allocated for each ongoing plan and changes during 2006. It also shows compensation costs charged for each plan. The total compensation costs charged for the Long Term Variable Compensation plans during 2006 amount to SEK 389 million.
Plan (million shares) |
Originally designated 1) |
Outstanding beginning of 2006 |
Granted during 2006 |
Exercised/ matched during 2006 |
Forfeited during 2006 |
Expired during 2006 |
Outstanding 2006 |
Number of options exercisable |
Compensation charged 2006 |
|||||||||||
1999 Stock Option Plan |
1.4 | 0.8 | | | 0.1 | | 0.7 | 0.7 | | |||||||||||
Millennium Stock Option Plan |
71.6 | 31.2 | | | 2.8 | | 28.4 | 28.4 | | |||||||||||
2001 Stock Option PlanMay Grant |
44.9 | 25.9 | | | 2.3 | | 23.6 | 23.6 | | |||||||||||
2001 Stock Option PlanNov Grant |
2.6 | 1.5 | | 0.1 | 0.1 | | 1.3 | 1.3 | | |||||||||||
2002 Stock Option Plan |
53.9 | 33.3 | | 8.1 | 0.5 | | 24.7 | 24.7 | | |||||||||||
2003 Stock Purchase Plan (2-year plan) and 2004 Key Contributor and Performance Matching programs |
151.7 | 33.3 | 0.1 | 5.4 | 1.0 | | 27 | 2) | | 245 | 3) | |||||||||
2005 Stock Purchase Plan, Key Contributor and Performance Matching programs |
31.5 | 5.9 | 19.4 | 1.3 | 0.4 | | 23.6 | 2) | | 138 | 3) | |||||||||
2006 Stock Purchase Plan, Key Contributor and Performance Matching programs |
31.8 | | 5.8 | | | | 5.8 | 2) | | 6 | 3) |
1) | Adjusted for split, bonus issue and rights offering when applicable. |
2) | Presuming maximum performance matching under the Performance Matching Program. |
3) | Fair value is calculated as the share price on the investment date reduced by the net present value of the dividend expectations during the three year vesting period. Net present value calculations are based on data from external party. For shares under the performance matching programs, the Company assesses the probability of meeting the performance targets when calculating the compensation costs. Fair value of Class B share at each investment date during 2006 was: February 15 SEK 25.67, May 15 SEK 22.49, August 15 SEK 20.32 and November 15 SEK 26.14. |
C30 RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
During 2006, various transactions were executed pursuant to contracts based on terms customary in the industry and negotiated on an arms length basis.
115
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
SONY ERICSSON MOBILE COMMUNICATIONS AB (SEMC)
In October 2001, SEMC was organized as a joint venture between Sony Corporation and Ericsson, and a substantial portion of Ericssons handset operations was sold to SEMC. As part of the formation of the joint venture, contracts were entered into between Ericsson and SEMC.
Major transactions are as follows:
| Sales. Ericsson reports sales regarding mobile phone platform design to SEMC. |
| Royalty. Both owners of SEMC, Sony Corporation and Ericsson, receive royalties for SEMCs usage of trademarks and intellectual property rights. |
| Purchases. Ericsson purchases mobile phones from SEMC to support contracts with a number of customers for mobile systems which also include limited quantities of phones. |
| Dividends. Both owners of SEMC, Sony Corporation and Ericsson, receive dividends. |
2006 | 2005 | |||
Related party transactions |
||||
Sales |
2,486 | 1,742 | ||
Royalty |
1,478 | 654 | ||
Purchases |
173 | 827 | ||
Dividends |
1,160 | | ||
Related party balances |
||||
Receivables |
479 | 197 | ||
Liabilities |
108 | 33 | ||
ERICSSON NIKOLA TESLA D.D.
Ericsson Nikola Tesla d.d. is a joint stock company for manufacturing of telecommunications systems and equipment and an associated member of the Ericsson Group. Ericsson holds 49.07 percent of the shares.
Major transactions are as follows:
| Sales. Ericsson Nikola Tesla d.d. purchases telecommunication equipment from Ericsson. |
| Royalty. Ericsson receives royalties for Ericsson Nikola Tesla d.d.s usage of trademarks and intellectual property rights. |
| Purchases. Ericsson purchases development resources from Ericsson Nikola Tesla d.d. |
| Dividends. Ericsson receives dividends from Ericsson Nikola Tesla d.d. |
2006 | 2005 | |||
Related party transactions |
||||
Sales |
867 | 880 | ||
Royalty |
7 | 9 | ||
Purchases |
465 | 364 | ||
Dividends |
98 | | ||
Related party balances |
||||
Receivables |
86 | 132 | ||
Liabilities |
82 | 50 | ||
116
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
OTHER RELATED PARTIES
Ericsson continued the cooperation with Ericssons owners Investor AB and AB Industrivärden in the venture capital vehicle Ericsson Venture Partners.
For information regarding the management remuneration, see Note C29, Information regarding employees, members of the Board of Directors and management.
Price- waterhouse- Coopers |
KPMG | Others | Total | |||||
2006 |
||||||||
Audit fees |
98 | 8 | 3 | 109 | ||||
Audit related fees |
14 | | | 14 | ||||
Tax services fees |
19 | 2 | 1 | 22 | ||||
Other fees |
1 | 2 | 1 | 4 | ||||
132 | 12 | 5 | 149 | |||||
2005 |
||||||||
Audit fees |
58 | 6 | 3 | 67 | ||||
Audit related fees |
24 | | | 24 | ||||
Tax services fees |
43 | 1 | 1 | 45 | ||||
Other fees |
| 1 | | 1 | ||||
125 | 8 | 4 | 137 | |||||
2004 |
||||||||
Audit fees |
57 | 6 | 1 | 64 | ||||
Audit related fees |
10 | 6 | | 16 | ||||
Tax services fees |
31 | 2 | | 33 | ||||
Other fees |
| | | | ||||
98 | 14 | 1 | 113 | |||||
During the period 20042006 PricewaterhouseCoopers and KPMG provided the Company with certain audit related services and tax services in addition to audit services. The audit related services provided during the period include consultation on financial accounting, consultation in connection with conversion to International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS), services related to acquisitions and assessments of internal control. The tax services include general expatriate services, VAT refund services and Corporate tax compliance work.
Audit fees to other auditors consist of local statutory audits for minor companies.
The increase of audit fees during 2006 is related to SOX 404.
C32 EVENTS AFTER THE BALANCE SHEET DATE
The process of establishing a purchase price allocation (PPA) for the acquisitions below is in progress and Ericsson disclosed a preliminary PPA for Redback in the Q1 2007 Interim report. Funding of the below acquistions will be from net cash.
117
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
ACQUISITION OF REDBACK NETWORKS
On December 20, 2006, Ericsson and Redback Networks Inc. (NASDAQ:RBAK) announced the signing of a definitive agreement under which Ericsson would acquire Redback for USD 25.00 per share, or an aggregate price of approximately USD 1.9 billion. On January 25, 2007, the completion of the acquisition was announced.
Redback has over 700 carrier customers in more than 80 countries and employs about 800 people, including 500 R&D engineers. Fifteen of the top 20 telephone carriers worldwide use Redbacks technology, including broadband routers to manage IP-based data, voice and video services. Redback has a strong position in multi-service edge routing technology, which helps carriers deliver broadband, telephony, TV and mobility services over internet-based infrastructures.
The combination of Redbacks intelligent routing technology and Ericssons leading IMS (IP Multimedia Subsystem), optical transport and broadband access puts Ericsson in a leading position in end-to-end IP solutions for both fixed and mobile operators.
ACQUISITION OF ENTRISPHERE
Ericsson announced on February 12, 2007, the acquisition of Entrisphere, a company providing fiber access technology. Entrisphere was founded in 2000 in Santa Clara, California, and employs about 140 people, including important R&D resources.
The Entrisphere acquisition brings a leading IP based broadband access platform ready for volume deployment and compliant with both North American and international standards.
ACQUISTION OF TANDBERG TELEVISION
On February 26, 2007, Ericsson announced a voluntary public cash offer to acquire Tandberg Television for NOK 106 in cash per share, or an aggregate price of approximately SEK 9.8 billion.
Ericsson and Tandberg Television is a strong combination with a unique ability to offer complete IPTV solutions. IPTV is key in multimedia offerings from telecom operators as well as cable and satellite operators. Tandbergs leading TV technology and customer base and our global presence and strong position in IP networks and IMS, will create a leading player in networked media solutions. With the majority of sales in cable/satellite and the growing telecom business, Tandberg has built a premiere customer base with customers in more than 100 countries. The company has over 200 patents granted. The European and North American operations are headquartered in Southampton, UK and Atlanta, US. Tandberg Television employs 870 people.
On March 23, 2007, Ericsson had received acceptances and purchased shares representing more than 90 percent of Tandberg Television.
On April 23, 2007, Ericsson announced that we have received favorable rulings from the relevant competition authorities to acquire all outstanding shares in Tandberg Television. All conditions in the terms and conditions set out in the offer document, dated February 26, 2007, have been met and Ericsson will complete the offer in accordance with the offer document.
On May 8, 2007, post completion of the voluntary offer for Tandberg Television, Ericsson holds 74,929,553 shares in Tandberg Television, which corresponds to about 93 percent of the outstanding shares. On the basis of Ericsson holding more than 90 percent of the outstanding shares in Tandberg Television, Ericsson will launch a mandatory offer and initiate a compulsory acquisition of the remaining shares.
ACQUISITION OF MOBEON
March 15, 2007, Ericsson announced that it will acquire business and assets of Mobeon AB, the worlds leader in IP-messaging components for mobile and fixed networks. This is another step in our strategy to
118
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
strengthen the multimedia strategy. 21 percent of Mobeon is already owned by Ericsson, which is also the primary partner and original developer of Mobeons CompEdge series of carrier-class messaging.
Headquartered in Stockholm, Sweden, Mobeon is a leading supplier of IP-based voice and video mail, key elements of Ericssons Enriched Messaging solution, which in turn is a cornerstone of the multimedia strategy.
Mobeon has 130 employees in Sweden and the UK which will all be integrated to Ericssons multimedia division.
THE ANNUAL GENERAL MEETING OF SHAREHOLDERS (AGM)
At the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders (AGM), the AGM resolved to approve the proposals by the Nomination Committee and the Board of Directors with the exception for a Long term Variable compensation plan 2007 and transfer of shares in connection therewith.
ERICSSON CHANGES FINANCIAL REPORTING STRUCTURE
Ericsson has from January 1, 2007, reorganized its operating structure. On April 24, we announced that the financial reporting is changed as from the first quarter report 2007, to reflect the new business segment structure. Ericsson reports the following business segments: Networks, Professional Services and Multimedia. Phones, represented by the share in earnings of Sony Ericsson, will be reported as before.
EXTRAORDINARY GENERAL MEETING TO RESOLVE THE REVISED LONG-TERM VARIABLE COMPENSATION PLAN 2007
Ericsson announced on May 24, 2007, that an Extraordinary General Meeting will be held on June 28, 2007, to resolve the revised Long-Term Variable Compensation Program 2007.
C33 RECONCILIATION TO ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES GENERALLY ACCEPTED IN THE UNITED STATES
As a foreign private issuer registered at the US Securities and Exchange Commission, the Company is required to reconcile certain financial information to accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (US GAAP).
The principal differences between IFRSs and US GAAP that affect our net income, as well as our stockholders equity, relate to the treatment of restructuring cost, pensions, sale-lease back, reversals of impairment losses, goodwill and capitalization of development expenses.
NEW US GAAP STANDARDS
The following FASB standards and pronouncements have been adopted in 2006:
| SFAS 123R Share-Based Payments |
| SFAS 151 Inventory Costs |
| SFAS 154 Accounting Changes and Error Corrections |
| SFAS 158 Employers Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans |
| SAB 108 Considering the Effects of Prior Year Misstatements when Quantifying Misstatements in Current Year Financial Statements. |
The new standards adopted in 2006 do not have any impact on the US GAAP figures.
The following FASB interpretation is expected to be adopted in 2007:
| FIN 48: accounting for uncertainty in Income Taxes an interpretation of FASB statement No. 109 |
119
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Restructuring costs
Under IFRSs, a provision for severance pay is recognized in the balance sheet and income statement when a constructive obligation to restructure arises, which requires that a detailed formal plan has been communicated to those affected by it. Its implementation needs to be planned to begin as soon as possible and to be completed in a timeframe that makes significant changes to the plan unlikely. Under US GAAP provisions for severance pay is recognized over the remaining service period when a company has a detailed formal plan which has been communicated to those affected.
If an entity reporting under IFRSs has a contract that is onerous, the present obligation under the contract shall be recognized and measured as a provision. Under US GAAP, costs to terminate a contract before the end of its term should be recognized as a liability and measured at fair value when the entity terminates the contract in accordance with the contract terms. A liability for costs that will continue to be incurred under a contract for its remaining term without economic benefit to the entity should be recognized and measured at its fair value when the entity ceases to use the right conveyed by the contract.
Ericsson has identified a difference between US GAAP and IFRSs of SEK 144 million (112 million in 2005; 88 million in 2004) related to leasehold property that has not yet been vacated and thus not qualified as provisions in accordance with US GAAP, and SEK 60 million (95 million in 2005; 0 million in 2004) related to severance pay not yet recognized per US GAAP.
Pensions
Different transition dates and the treatment of prior service cost and actuarial gains and losses are the main differences for Ericsson between IFRSs and US GAAP for accounting of defined benefit plans.
Under IFRS, Ericsson adopted IAS 19 Employee Benefits on January 1, 2004, and IAS 19 as amended on January 1, 2006. At adoption of IAS 19, actuarial gains and losses were recognized in the opening balance.
For US GAAP, the Company adopted SFAS 87, Employers Accounting for Pensions in 1989 and FAS 158, Employers Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans in 2006.
The different transition dates for accounting of defined benefit plans between US GAAP and IFRSs affect the balances of actuarial gains and losses, which impact reported pension costs. Under IAS 19, all unrecognized actuarial gains and losses are reported directly to retained earnings in equity, i.e. with no impact on the income statement, whereas SFAS 158 under US GAAP requires amortization of actuarial gains and losses outside a corridor value.
Under US GAAP, companies recognize a net liability or asset to report the funded status of their defined benefit plans on their balance sheets, whereas under IFRS companies recognize the net of the funded status and unrecognized prior service cost as a provision or asset in the balance sheet.
Sale-leaseback of real estate
During 2000 and 2001, the Company sold real estate assets, which were then leased back to subsidiary companies and reported as operating leases. Under IFRSs the gain on sale of property is credited to income, if the rent to be paid is in par with market price. In accordance with US GAAP the part of the gain exceeding present value of future lease payments is credited to income when incurred. The remaining part is recognized over the lease period.
120
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Derivatives:
Ericsson adopted IAS 39 Financial Instruments; Recognition and Measurement January 1, 2005. According to IAS 39, all derivatives should be recognized at fair value on the balance sheet.
Under US GAAP, the Company adopted SFAS 133, Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities, as amended, on January 1, 2001, for calculating income and equity. SFAS 133 requires recognition of all derivatives as either assets or liabilities measured at fair value similarly to IAS 39.
As a result of different opening balances in the Hedge Reserve relating to cash flow hedging, the effect in the income statement differs between IFRSs and US GAAAP. The closing balances 2005 of the Hedge Reserve were the same, as cash flow hedge accounting is applied to the same extent under US GAAP and IFRSs.
In the end of 2006 fair value hedge accounting was used to the same extent under both standards.
Unrealized gains and losses on securities available-for-sale
In accordance with IAS 39, available-for-sale investments that can be reliably determinable are measured at fair value. The unrealized movements in fair value are recognized in equity until disposal or sale, at which time, those unrealized movements from prior periods are recognized in profit or loss. Losses other than temporary that reduce the carrying amount below acquisition cost should be recognized in profit or loss. Investments in equity instruments that do not have a quoted market price in an active market and whose fair value cannot be reliably measured may be measured at cost.
Under US GAAP, the Companys listed marketable securities are classified as available-for-sale and measured at fair value in accordance with SFAS 115 Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities. Investments in equity instruments not publicly traded are carried at cost. Unrealized gains and temporary losses are reported as a separate component of stockholders equity included in other comprehensive income. Other than temporary unrealized losses are charged to income.
Prior to 2005, investments in available-for-sale instruments were recorded in accordance with Swedish GAAP at cost less impairment. As IAS 39 was adopted in 2005, there is no reconciling difference for the current investments.
Reversals of impairment losses
IFRSs require reversal of impairment losses when there has been a change in economic conditions or in the expected use of an asset. Under IFRSs Ericsson has reversed impairment losses for test plants. This is prohibited under US GAAP and reduces the US GAAP net income.
Goodwill
Ericsson adopted IFRS 3 Business Combinations on January 1, 2004. Under IFRS 3, goodwill is not subject to amortization, but requires an impairment review at least annually. Under US GAAP, the Company applies SFAS 142. According to SFAS 142, goodwill is not subject to amortization subsequent to the date of adoption, but instead tested for impairment at least annually similarly to IFRS 3. Under IFRS, as disclosed in note C10 Intangible Assets, goodwill in segment Systems is allocated to one cash-generating unit. Under US GAAP, impairment tests have been performed for reporting units. No need for impairment was identified in either of the two standards. The presented difference in closing balances of goodwill pertains to different transition dates for IFRS 3 and SFAS 142.
121
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Capitalization of development costs
According to IFRSs, development costs are capitalized after the products have reached a certain degree of technological feasibility. Capitalization ceases and amortization begins when the product is ready for its intended use. The Company has adopted an amortization period for capitalized development costs of three to five years. Under US GAAP, the Company applies US GAAP SFAS 86 Accounting for the Cost of Computer Software to be Sold, Leased or Otherwise Marketed and SOP 98-1 Accounting for the costs of Computer Software Developed or Obtained for Internal use. According to SFAS 86, software development costs are capitalized after the product involved has reached a certain degree of technological feasibility similarly to IFRSs. However, under US GAAP non-software related development costs may not be capitalized as per IFRSs, and are therefore expensed under US GAAP.
OTHER
Capitalization of interest expenses
Under IFRSs, an entity can choose to capitalize the borrowing costs where they are directly attributable to the acquisition, construction or production of a qualifying asset. The Company has chosen to expense the borrowing costs incurred. Such costs should be capitalized in accordance with US GAAP, and depreciated as the assets concerned are used. As amortization exceeds the capitalization during the year, the net income is reduced by SEK 10 million according to US GAAP (28 million in 2005; 58 million in 2004).
Provision for social security cost on stock-based compensation
Under IFRSs, the Company accrues social security costs on stock-based compensation during the vesting period. Provisions are adjusted for movements in share price. Under US GAAP, no social security costs are recorded until the options are exercised or matching of shares takes place, which increases net income by SEK 27 million under US GAAP (52 million in 2005; 76 million in 2004).
FIN 45
Under US GAAP, FIN 45 requires a liability to be recognized at the time a company issues a guarantee measured at the fair value of the obligations assumed under certain guarantee agreements.
Due to an amendment of IAS 39 in relation to accounting treatment of financial guarantee contracts in 2006 the application of FIN 45 has no material effect on the Companys earnings and financial position under US GAAP from 2006. Prior to 2006, a provision was recognized under IFRS only when there was an estimated outflow as a result of the guarantee.
Deferred tax effect related to intercompany profits in inventory
According to IFRSs, deferred tax effect related to intercompany profits in inventory is recognized at the buyers tax rate, whereas under US GAAP the sellers tax rate is used. The effect of this difference increased net income according to US GAAP in 2006 by SEK 39 million (-35 million in 2005; -45 million in 2004).
Deferred income taxes
Deferred tax is calculated on US GAAP adjustments, and the US GAAP balance sheet reflects the gross recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities.
122
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
Discontinued Operations
SFAS144 Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-lived Assets requires a component of an entity that either has been disposed or is classified as held for sale to be reported as a discontinued operation if (a) the operations and cash flow of the component have been (or will be) eliminated from the ongoing operations of the Group as a result of the disposal transaction; and b) the group will not have any significant continuing involvement in the operations of the component after the disposal. A component of an entity comprises operations and cash flows that can be clearly distinguished, operationally and for financial reporting purposes, from the rest of the entity. A component of an entity may be a reportable segment, a reporting unit, a subsidiary, or an asset group.
In accordance with IFRS, the Group classifies a discontinued operation as a component of an entity, which (a) pursuant to a single plan, the entity is disposing of in its entirety, (b) represents a separate major line of business or geographical activity and (c) can be distinguished operationally and for financial reporting purposes.
The divestment of the Defense operation on September 1, 2006, is classified as a discontinued operation under US GAAP. However, as the transaction does not represent a major line of business, it has not been classified as a discontinued operation under IFRS.
The table below sets forth the amounts reflected as discontinued operations for 2006, 2005 and 2004, and the amounts reclassified from continuing to discontinued operations, under US GAAP. The discontinued operations refer entirely to the divestment of the Defense operations.
(MSEK) |
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | |||
Net sales |
1,436 | 2,070 | 3,071 | |||
Operating income |
2,827 | 101 | 73 | |||
Net income |
2,820 | 183 | 158 |
The 2006 operating income and net income are both affected by the gain on sale of shares in Ericsson Microwave Systems, see note C6.
Adjustment of net income, equity and balance sheet items
Application of US GAAP as described above would have had the following effects on consolidated net income. In arriving at the individual items increasing or decreasing reported net income, consideration has been given to the effect of minority interests.
123
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
ADJUSTMENT OF NET INCOME
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
Net income attributable to stockholders of the parent company per IFRSs |
26,251 | 24,315 | 17,539 | |||
US GAAP adjustments before taxes: |
||||||
Pensions |
-439 | -64 | -245 | |||
Sale-leaseback |
93 | 191 | 352 | |||
Hedging |
0 | 408 | -2,915 | |||
Capitalization of development costs |
-37 | -78 | -76 | |||
Restructuring costs |
-4 | 120 | -1,354 | |||
Unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale securities |
0 | 0 | -82 | |||
Reversals of impairment losses |
-31 | -380 | 0 | |||
Other |
93 | 56 | 82 | |||
Tax effect of US GAAP adjustments |
154 | -73 | 1,085 | |||
Net income in accordance with US GAAP |
26,080 | 24,495 | 14,386 |
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
Earnings per share in accordance with US GAAP |
||||||
Earnings per share per US GAAP, basic |
1.64 | 1.55 | 0.91 | |||
Earnings per share per US GAAP, diluted |
1.64 | 1.54 | 0.91 | |||
Average number of shares, basic per US GAAP (million) |
15,871 | 15,843 | 15,829 | |||
Average number of shares, diluted per US GAAP (million) |
15,943 | 15,907 | 15,855 | |||
Net income for the period from continuing operations according to US GAAP |
23,260 | 24,312 | 14,228 | |||
Net income for the period from discontinued operations according to US GAAP |
2,820 | 183 | 158 | |||
Total income for the period according to US GAAP |
26,080 | 24,495 | 14,386 | |||
Earnings per share from continuing operations basic |
1.47 | 1.53 | 0.90 | |||
Earning per share from discontinued operations basic |
0.17 | 0.02 | 0.01 | |||
Total earnings per share basic |
1.64 | 1.55 | 0.91 | |||
ADJUSTMENT OF STOCKHOLDERS EQUITY
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||
Equity attributable to stockholders of the parent company per IFRSs |
120,113 | 101,622 | 80,445 | |||
US GAAP adjustments before taxes: |
||||||
Pensions |
-83 | 1,822 | 949 | |||
Goodwill |
2,698 | 2,705 | 2,705 | |||
Sale-leaseback |
-744 | 837 | 1,028 | |||
Derivatives |
0 | 0 | 1,604 | |||
Capitalization of development costs |
-191 | 154 | 76 | |||
Restructuring costs |
204 | 208 | 88 | |||
Unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale securities |
0 | 0 | 411 | |||
Reversals of impairment losses |
-411 | 380 | 0 | |||
Other |
348 | 246 | 190 | |||
Deferred tax effect of US GAAP adjustments |
36 | 594 | 919 | |||
Stockholders equity in accordance with US GAAP |
121,898 | 104,638 | 84,369 | |||
124
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS(Continued)
BALANCE SHEET
Balance sheet items according to IFRSs and US GAAP:
IFRSs Dec. 31 2006 |
Dec. 31 2005 |
Dec.31 2004 |
Dec. 31 2006 |
US GAAP Dec. 31 2005 |
Dec.31 2004 | |||||||
Non-current assets |
63,373 | 51,183 | 49,300 | 65,470 | 52,889 | 53,435 | ||||||
Current assets |
151,567 | 158,153 | 136,886 | 151,567 | 158,153 | 139,428 | ||||||
Total assets |
214,940 | 209,336 | 186,186 | 217,037 | 211,042 | 192,863 | ||||||
Stockholders equity attributable to stockholders of the parent company |
120,113 | 101,622 | 80,445 | 121,898 | 104,638 | 84,369 | ||||||
Minority interests |
782 | 850 | 1,057 | 782 | 850 | 1,057 | ||||||
Non-current liabilities |
23,724 | 24,111 | 35,347 | 23,717 | 22,680 | 36,880 | ||||||
Current liabilities |
70,321 | 82,753 | 69,337 | 70,640 | 82,874 | 70,557 | ||||||
Total stockholders equity and liabilities |
214,940 | 209,336 | 186,186 | 217,037 | 211,042 | 192,863 | ||||||
Share-Based Compensation
Stock Option Plan
Ericsson adopted IFRS 2 Share-based Payments on January 1, 2004, with the optional exception to apply IFRS 2 only to equity instruments granted after November 7, 2002. For one employee option program, granted after this date and not yet vested by January 1, 2005, Ericsson recognized a charge to income representing the fair value at grant date of the outstanding employee options. The impact on the operating profit was a charge of SEK 14 million in 2005 and no impact in 2006.
There were no employee option programs with vesting periods during 2006 and consequently no charge was made during 2006.
Up until 2003, the Company, as permitted under SFAS 123 Accounting for Stock Based Compensation, applied Accounting Principles Board Opinion 25 (APB 25) and related interpretations in accounting for its stock option plans under US GAAP. No compensation expense was reflected in the consolidated income statement, as no compensation expense arose when the strike price of the employees stock options equaled the market value of the underlying stock at grant date, as in the case of all options granted to Ericssons employees.
In 2003 Ericsson adopted SFAS 148 Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation-transition and Disclosure, an amendment of FASB Statement No. 123. The adoption method chosen was the Prospective method. This method stated that the recognition provisions should be applied to all employee awards granted, modified, or settled after the beginning of the fiscal year in which the recognition provisions were first applied. As the Company has had no changes to its current stock option plans nor any new stock option plans started after implementing SFAS 148, there has been no effect to the income according to US GAAP.
If the Company had chosen to adopt the optional recognition provisions of SFAS 123 for its stock option plans, net income (loss) and earnings (loss) per share in accordance with US GAAP would not have been materially affected. No option programs were initiated during 2004, 2005 or 2006.
Stock Purchase Plans
For its stock purchase plans, Ericsson has applied SFAS 123R according to US GAAP and IFRS 2 according to IFRSs. The stock purchase plans have been expensed in the income statement according to both IFRSs and US GAAP since 2003, the first year in which stock purchase plans were issued that still had a vesting period in 2006. The costs are based on the fair value at investment date and charged to profit or loss and credited to shareholders equity and accordingly we have not identified any differences between IFRS and US GAAP.
125
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
You should carefully consider all the information in this annual report and in particular the risks and uncertainties outlined below. Any of the factors described below, or any other factors discussed elsewhere in this report, could have a material negative effect on our business, operational results, financial condition, liquidity and/ or our share price. Furthermore, our operational results may have a greater variability than in the past and we may have more difficulty in accurately predicting future developments.
RISK ASSOCIATED WITH THE INDUSTRY AND MARKET CONDITIONS
We conduct business throughout the world and are subject to the effects of general global economic conditions as well as conditions unique to a specific country and region. In particular, we are affected by market conditions within the telecommunications industry.
We are subject to political, economic and regulatory risks in the various countries in which we operate.
We conduct business in more than 140 countries, with a significant proportion of our sales originating from emerging markets in Asia Pacific, Latin America, Eastern Europe, the Middle East and Africa. We expect that sales to such emerging markets will be an increasing portion of total sales as developing nations and regions around the world increase their investments in telecommunications. We already have extensive operations in many of these countries, which involve certain risks, including volatility in gross domestic product, civil disturbances, economic and political instability, nationalization of private assets and the imposition of exchange controls.
Changes in regulatory requirements, tariffs and other trade barriers, price or exchange controls or other governmental policies in the countries in which we conduct business could limit our operations and make the repatriation of profits difficult. In addition, the uncertainty of the legal environment in some regions could limit our ability to enforce our rights. We also must comply with the export control regulations of the countries in which we operate. Although we seek to comply with each of these regulations, even unintentional violations thereof could have material adverse effects on our business, operational results and reputation.
We are subject to the market conditions affecting the capital and operating expenditures of our customers, making demand for our products and services highly unpredictable.
Adverse economic conditions could cause network operators to postpone investments or initiate other cost-cutting initiatives to improve their financial position, which could result in significantly reduced capital expenditures for network infrastructure. If operator spending for network equipment and associated rollout services declines substantially, our business and operating results would suffer. We have established better flexibility to cost effectively accommodate fluctuations in demand. However, if demand were to fall, or were to be significantly weaker than expected, we may experience material adverse effects and may incur operating losses in the future.
Our business essentially depends upon the continued growth of mobile communications.
Most of our business depends on continued growth in mobile communications in terms of both number of subscriptions and usage per subscriber, which in turn requires the continued deployment of our network systems by customers. In particular, we are dependent on operators in highly penetrated markets to successfully introduce services that cause a substantial increase in usage for both voice and data. In emerging markets, we are, to a certain extent, dependent on the availability of lower-cost handsets in addition to affordable tariffs by operators to support a continued increase of mobile subscribers. If operators are not successful in their attempts to increase the number of subscribers and/or stimulate increased usage, our business and operational results could be materially adversely affected.
126
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Changes in the regulatory environment for telecommunications systems and services could negatively impact our business.
Telecommunications is a regulated industry and regulatory changes affect both our customers and us. For example, changes in regulations that impose more stringent, time-consuming or costly planning, zoning requirements or building approvals regarding the construction of base stations and other network infrastructure could adversely affect the timing and costs of new network construction or expansion and the commercial launch and ultimate commercial success of these networks. Similarly, tariff regulations that affect the pricing of new services offered by operators could also affect their ability to invest in network infrastructure, which in turn could affect the sales of our systems and services.
License fees, environmental, health and safety, privacy and other regulation changes may increase costs and restrict operations of network operators and service providers. The indirect impact of such changes could affect our business adversely even though the specific regulations may not directly apply to our products or us.
Consolidation among network operators may increase our dependence on a limited number of key customers.
The market for mobile network equipment is highly concentrated, with the 10 largest operators representing more than 40 percent of the total market. Network operators have undergone significant consolidation, especially among companies operating in different countries. This trend is expected to continue, while also intra-country consolidation is likely to accelerate as a result of competitive pressure.
A market with fewer and larger operators will increase our reliance on key customers and, due to the increased size of these companies, may negatively impact our bargaining position and profit margins. Moreover, if the combined companies operate in the same geographic market, less network equipment and associated services may be required. Another possible consequence of customer consolidation is that it could cause a delay in their network investments while they negotiate merger/acquisition agreements, secure necessary approvals, or are constrained by efforts to integrate the businesses.
Consolidation among equipment and services suppliers may lead to increased competition and a different competitive landscape.
Industry consolidation among equipment suppliers could potentially result in stronger competitors that are competing as end-to-end suppliers as well as competitors more specialized in particular areas. Consolidation may also result in competitors with greater resources, including technical and engineering resources, than we have. This could have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results, and financial condition.
We operate in a highly competitive industry, which is subject to competitive pricing and rapid technological change.
The markets for our products are highly competitive in terms of pricing, functionality and service quality, the timing of development and introduction of new products and services and terms of financing. We face intense competition from significant competitors. Our competitors may implement new technologies before we do, allowing them to offer more attractively priced or enhanced products, services or solutions than we provide. Some of our competitors may have greater resources in certain business segments or geographic markets than we do. We may also encounter increased competition from new market entrants, alternative technologies or alternative telecommunications platforms. Our operating results significantly depend on our ability to compete in this market environment, in particular on our ability to introduce new products to the market and to continuously enhance the functionality while reducing the cost of new and existing products.
127
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Liability claims related to and public perception of the potential health risks associated with electromagnetic fields could negatively affect our business.
We are subject to claims that mobile handsets and other telecommunications devices that generate electromagnetic fields expose users to health risks. At present, a substantial number of scientific studies conducted by various independent research bodies have indicated that electromagnetic fields, at levels within the limits prescribed by public health authority safety standards and recommendations, cause no adverse effect to human health. However, any perceived risk or new scientific findings of adverse health effects of mobile communication devices and equipment could adversely affect us through a reduction in sales. Although Ericssons products are designed to comply with all current safety standards and recommendations regarding electromagnetic fields, we cannot assure you that we or the jointly owned Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications will not become the subject of product liability claims or be held liable for such claims or be required to comply with future regulatory changes that may have an adverse effect on our business. See also Legal and Tax proceedings in the Board of Directors Report .
Our current and historical operations are subject to a wide range of environmental, health and safety regulations.
We are subject to certain environmental, health and safety laws and regulations that affect our operations, facilities and products in each of the jurisdictions in which we operate. We believe that we are in compliance with all material environmental, health and safety laws and regulations related to our products, operations and business activities. However, there is a risk that we may have to incur expenditures to cover environmental and health liabilities to maintain compliance with current or future environmental, health and safety laws and regulations or to undertake any necessary remediation. It is difficult to reasonably estimate the future impact of environmental matters, including potential liabilities due to a number of factors especially the lengthy time intervals often involved in resolving them.
Strategic and operational risks
Our business is subject to a wide variety of factors that impact our strategies and operating results. Any of these factors could have a material adverse impact on our operating results. Furthermore, results of operations for any period may not necessarily be indicative of results to be expected in future periods. Consequently, our operating results may fluctuate significantly from period to period which may lead us to revise our estimates and/ or strategies.
Most of our business is derived from a limited number of customers.
We derive most of our business from large, multi-year network build-out agreements with a limited number of significant customers. Although no single customer currently represents more than 10 percent of sales, the loss of, or a reduced role with, a key customer for any reason could have a significant adverse impact on sales, profit and market share for an extended period.
Some long-term frame agreements expose us to risks related to agreed future price reductions or penalties.
Long-term agreements are typically awarded on a competitive bidding basis. In some cases such agreements also include commitments to future price reductions. In order to maintain gross margin even with lower prices, we continuously strive to reduce the costs of our products through design improvements and other changes in costs related to e.g. component prices, productivity in production, etc. We can not assure you that our cost reduction actions will be sufficient to maintain our gross margin.
128
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Frame agreements often also provide for penalties and termination rights in the event of our failure to deliver ordered products on time or if our products do not perform as promised, which may affect our results negatively.
We expend significant resources on product and technology R&D which may not be successful in the market.
Developing new products or updating existing products and solutions requires significant levels of financial and other commitments to research and development, which may not always result in success. We are also actively engaged in the development of technology standards that we are incorporating into our products and solutions. In order to be successful, those standards must be accepted by relevant standardization bodies and by the industry as a whole. Our sales and earnings may suffer if we invest in development of technologies and technology standards that do not function as expected, are not adopted in the industry or are not accepted in the marketplace within the time-frame we expect, or at all.
Please also see section Research and Development in the Board of Directors Report and in Information on the Company.
We enter into joint ventures, strategic alliances and third party agreements to offer complementary products and services.
If our partnering arrangements fail to perform as expected, whether as a result of having incorrectly assessed our needs or the capabilities of our strategic partners, our ability to work with these partners or otherwise, our ability to develop new products and solutions may be constrained and this may harm our competitive position in the market. Additionally, our share of any losses from, or commitments to contribute additional capital to, joint ventures may adversely affect our financial position or results of operations.
In the case of our joint venture with Sony Corporation, if the joint venture is unsuccessful for any reason, we may not be able to compete as successfully in the mobile systems market or at all in the mobile handset market.
Our solutions may also require us to license technologies from other companies and successfully integrate such technologies with our products. It may be necessary in the future to seek or renew licenses relating to various aspects of these products. There can be no assurance that the necessary licenses would be available on acceptable terms, or at all. Moreover, the inclusion in our products of software or other intellectual property licensed from third parties on a non-exclusive basis could limit our ability to protect our proprietary rights in our products.
We cannot be certain that we will be successful in integrating acquired operations with our existing operations.
Our success depends in part upon the successful integration of the operations that we acquire. Although we believe that the consummation of acquired businesses will result in significant benefits and synergies, the integration of these operations will also present significant challenges, including:
| realizing economies of scale and eliminating duplicative overheads; and |
| integrating internal communications networks, financial and operational systems and processes. |
We cannot assure you, with respect to our recent acquisitions, that we will realize any anticipated benefits or will successfully integrate any of the acquired operations with our existing operations. The acquired companies may not have disclosure controls and procedures or internal controls over financial reporting that are as thorough
129
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
or effective as those required by U.S. security laws for public companies. While we intend to implement appropriate controls and procedures as we integrate the operations, we cannot provide assurance as to the effectiveness of their disclosure controls and procedures or internal controls over financial reporting until we have fully integrated them.
Our products incorporate intellectual property rights (IPR) developed by us that may be difficult to protect or may be found to infringe on the rights of others.
While we have been issued a large number of patents and other patent applications are currently pending, there can be no assurance that any of these patents will not be challenged, invalidated, or circumvented, or that any rights granted under these patents will in fact provide competitive advantages to us.
The European Union recently considered placing restrictions on the patentability of software. Although the European Union ultimately rejected this proposal, we cannot guarantee that they will not revisit this issue in the future. We rely on many software patents, and any limitations on the patentability of software may materially affect our business.
We utilize a combination of trade secrets, confidentiality policies, non-disclosure and other contractual arrangements in addition to relying on patent, copyright and trademark laws to protect our intellectual property rights. However, these measures may not be adequate to prevent or deter infringement or other misappropriation. Moreover, we may not be able to detect unauthorized use or take appropriate and timely steps to establish and enforce our proprietary rights. In fact, existing laws of some countries in which we conduct business offer only limited protection of our intellectual property rights, if at all.
Many key aspects of telecommunications and data network technology are governed by industry-wide standards, which are usable by all market participants. As the number of market entrants as well as the complexity of the technology increases, the possibility of functional overlap and inadvertent infringement of intellectual property rights also increases. Third parties have asserted, and may assert in the future, claims against us alleging that we infringe their intellectual property rights. Defending such claims may be expensive, time consuming and divert the efforts of our management and/or technical personnel. As a result of litigation, we could be required to pay damages and other compensation, develop non-infringing products/technology or enter into royalty or licensing agreements. However, we cannot be certain that any such licenses, if available at all, will be available to us on commercially reasonable terms.
Adverse resolution of litigation may harm our operating results or financial condition.
We are a party to lawsuits in the normal course of our business. Litigation can be expensive, lengthy and disruptive to normal business operations. Moreover, the results of complex legal proceedings are difficult to predict. An unfavorable resolution of a particular lawsuit could have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results, or financial condition.
For additional information regarding certain of the lawsuits in which we are involved, see Legal and Tax Proceedings in the Board of Directors Report.
We rely on a limited number of suppliers for the majority of our components and electronic manufacturing services.
Our ability to deliver according to market demands depends in large part on obtaining timely and adequate supply of materials, components and production capacity on competitive terms. Failure by any of our suppliers could interrupt our product supply and could significantly limit our sales or increase our costs. If we fail to
130
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
anticipate customer demand properly, an over/undersupply of components and production capacity could occur. In many cases, some of our competitors also utilize the same contract manufacturers, and we could be blocked from acquiring the needed components or increasing capacity if they have purchased capacity ahead of us. This factor could limit our ability to supply our customers or could increase our costs. At the same time we commit to certain capacity levels or component quantities, which, if unused, will result in charges for unused capacity or scrapping costs.
We are dependent upon hiring and retaining highly qualified employees.
We believe that our future success depends in large part on our continued ability to hire, develop, motivate and retain engineers and other qualified personnel needed to develop successful new products, support our existing product range and provide services to our customers. Competition for skilled personnel and highly qualified managers in the telecommunications industry remains intense. We are continuously developing our compensation and benefit policies as well as other measures. However, we may not be as successful at attracting and retaining such highly skilled personnel in the future.
As a Swedish company operating globally, we have substantial foreign exchange exposures.
With the majority of our cost base being Swedish krona (SEK) denominated and a very large share of sales in currencies other than SEK, and many subsidiaries outside Sweden, our foreign exchange exposure is significant. Currency exchange rate fluctuations affect our consolidated balance sheet, cash flows and income statement when foreign currencies are exchanged or translated to SEK. Our attempts to reduce the effect of exchange rate fluctuations through a variety of hedging activities may not be sufficient or successful, resulting in an adverse impact on our results.
A stronger SEK exchange rate would generally have a negative effect on our competitiveness compared to competitors with costs denominated in other currencies.
A significant interruption or other failure of our information technology (IT) operations or communications networks could have a material adverse affect on our operations and results.
Our business operations rely on complex IT operations and communications networks which are vulnerable to damage or disturbance from a variety of sources. Having outsourced a significant portion of our IT operations, we depend partly on security and reliability measures of external companies. Regardless of protection measures, essentially all IT systems and communications networks are susceptible to disruption from equipment failure, vandalism, computer viruses, security breaches, natural disasters, power outages and other events. Although we have experienced disruptions from computer viruses, security breaches, power outages and equipment failures in the past, our operations or results have not been materially affected to date. We will continue to expend significant resources to manage and try to mitigate these risks and we may incur additional costs to remedy damage caused by such disruptions, especially for computer viruses and security breaches.
RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH OWNING ERICSSON SHARES
Our share price has been and may continue to be volatile.
Our share price has been volatile due in part to the high volatility in the securities markets generally, and for telecommunications and technology companies in particular, as well as developments from quarter to quarter which impact our financial results. Factors other than our financial results that may affect our share price include but are not limited to variations between our actual financial results and expectations of financial analysts and investors as well as a result of announcements by our customers, competitors or ourselves regarding capital
131
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
spending plans of network operators, financial difficulties for network operators for whom we have provided financing or with whom we have entered into material contracts, awards of large supply agreements or contracts for network roll-out. Additional factors include but are not limited to: speculation in the press or investment community about the level of business activity or perceived growth in the market for mobile communications services and equipment; technical problems, in particular those relating to the introduction and viability of new network systems like 3G; potential litigation involving ourselves or the markets in which we operate. Even though we may not be directly involved, announcements concerning bankruptcy or other similar reorganization proceedings involving, or any investigations into the accounting practices of, other telecommunications companies may materially adversely affect our share price.
Currency fluctuations may adversely affect the trading prices of our Class B shares and ADSs and the value of any distributions we make thereon.
Because our shares are quoted in Swedish kronor (SEK) on the Stockholm Stock Exchange (our primary stock exchange) but on NASDAQ and the London Stock Exchange in local currencies, i.e. USD and GBP, fluctuations in exchange rates between SEK and these currencies in which our Class B shares or ADSs are quoted may affect the value of your investment. In addition, because we pay cash dividends in SEK, fluctuations in exchange rates may affect the value of distributions if arrangements with your bank, broker or depositary, in the case of ADSs, call for distributions to you in currencies other than SEK.
132
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
GENERAL FACTS ON THE COMPANY
Legal name:
Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (publ)
Organization number:
556016-0680
Legal form of the Company:
A Swedish limited liability company organized under the Swedish Companies Act. The terms Ericsson, the Company, the Group, us, we, our all refer to Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson and its subsidiaries.
Country of incorporation:
Sweden. The Company was incorporated on August 18, 1918, as a result of a merger between AB LM Ericsson & Co. and Stockholms Allmänna Telefon AB.
Domicile:
Our registered address is Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, SE-164 83 Stockholm, Sweden. Our headquarter is located at Torshamnsgatan 23, Kista, Sweden.
Our telephone number is +46 8 719 0000.
Our web site is www.ericsson.com. Please note that information on our web site does not form part of this document.
Agent in the US:
Ericsson Inc., Vice President Legal Affairs, 6300 Legacy Drive, Plano, Texas 75024. Telephone number +1 972 583 0000.
Shares:
Our Class A and B shares are traded on Stockholmsbörs-en (the Stockholm Stock Exchange). Our Class B shares are also traded on the London Stock Exchange (LSE). In the United States, our American depository shares (ADS), each representing 10 underlying Class B shares, are traded on NASDAQ.
Parent Company operations:
The business of the Parent Company, Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, consists mainly of corporate management, holding company functions and internal banking activities. Parent Company operations also include customer credit management activities performed by Ericsson Credit AB.
Subsidiaries and associated companies:
For a listing of our significant subsidiaries, please see Notes to the Parent Company Financial StatementsNote P9 Investments. In addition to our joint venture with SONY Corporation, we are engaged in a number of
133
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
other minor joint ventures, cooperative arrangements and venture capital initiatives. For more information regarding risks associated with joint ventures, strategic alliances and third party agreements, please see Risk FactorsStrategic and Operational Risks.
DOCUMENTS ON DISPLAY:
We file annual reports and other information (normally in Swedish only) for certain domestic legal entities with Bolagsverket (Swedish Companies Registration Office) pursuant to Swedish rules and regulations.
You may order any of these reports from their web site www.bolagsverket.se. If you access these reports, please be aware that the information included may not be indicative of our published consolidated results in all aspects. Other than information related to the Parent Company, only consolidated numbers for the Group totals are included in our reports.
We also file annual reports and other information with the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) in the United States pursuant to the rules and regulations that apply to foreign private issuers. Electronic access to these documents may be obtained from the SECs website www.sec.gov/edgar/searchedgar/webusers.htm where they are stored in the EDGAR database. You may read and copy any of these reports at the SECs Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549, or obtain them by mail upon payment of SECs prescribed rates. For further information, you can call the SEC at +1 800 732 0330.
HISTORY AND DEVELOPMENT
Our origins date back to 1876 when Lars Magnus Ericsson opened a small workshop in Stockholm to repair telegraph instruments. That same year in the United States, Alexander Graham Bell filed a patent application for the telephone. Lars Magnus Ericsson soon recognized the great potential of voice-based telecommunications and realized that the technology could be improved. He started to develop and sell his own telephone equipment and within a few years reached an agreement to supply telephones and switchboards to Swedens first telecom operator. Stockholm soon had the highest telephone density in the world.
Today, Ericsson is a leading provider of telecommunications equipment and related services to operators of mobile and fixed networks worldwide. Over 1,000 networks in more than 175 countries utilize our network equipment and we are one of the few companies worldwide that can offer end-to-end solutions for all major mobile communication standards.
We invest heavily in R&D and actively promote standardization and open systems. As a result, we have a long history of innovation and pioneering of future technologies for more efficient and higher quality telecommunications.
Also reflecting our ongoing commitment to technology leadership, we have one of the industrys most comprehensive intellectual property portfolios containing approximately 22,000 patents.
134
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Technical milestones
1878 |
Telegraph to telephone | |
1923 |
Manual switching to automatic switching | |
1956 |
First mobile phone system | |
1968 |
Electro-mechanical to computer control | |
1978 |
Analog switching to digital switching | |
1981 |
Fixed communications to mobile communications | |
1991 |
1G analog to 2G digital mobile technology | |
1998 |
Integration of voice and data in mobile networks | |
1999 |
Narrowband circuit to broadband packet switching | |
1999 |
Introduction of fixed telephony softswitch | |
2001 |
2G narrowband to 3G wideband mobile technology | |
2003 |
Introduction of mobile softswitch | |
2004 |
Mass commercial launch of WCDMA (3G) networks in Western Europe | |
2005 |
Commercial launch of HSDPA mobile broadband networks in North America | |
2006 |
Global commercial launches of HSPA mobile broadband networks |
Our visionhow we see the world
Our vision is to be the Prime Driver in an all-communicating world
Core valueshow we act
Professionalism, Respect and Perseverance are the cornerstones of the Ericsson culture, guiding us in our daily work, both in how we relate to people and how we conduct our business.
Resultshow we measure our performance
We measure three fundamental metrics: customer satisfaction, employee satisfaction and financial returns for our owners. We believe that highly satisfied customers, empowered employees and best-in-class operating margins help to assure a competitive advantage and an enduring capability for value creation.
BUSINESS STRATEGY AND LONG-TERM GOALS
Our ultimate goal is for the Company to generate growth and a competitive profit that is sustainable over the longer term. Ericssons strategy is to be the preferred business partner to our customers, especially to the worlds leading network operators. In doing so, we strive to be the market and technology leader by offering superior end-to-end solutions mainly related to network infrastructure, network management and other service offerings.
We are a major supplier to most of the worlds leading mobile network operators and many of the worlds leading fixed-line operators. We believe that our ability to offer end-to-end solutions systems, applications, services and core handset technology-together with our in-depth knowledge of consumer requirements, make us well positioned to assist network operators with their network development and operations. We are already a market leader in network systems integration and managed services. Through increased activities in professional services, service layer products and multimedia, we aim for increased sales in these growing segments.
Our strategy is to:
| excel in network infrastructure; |
| expand in service; |
| establish a position in multimedia solutions |
in order to make peoples lives easier and richer, provide affordable communication for all and enable new ways for companies to do business. This is performed with operational excellence in everything we do as a base.
135
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Innovation is an important element of our corporate culture and is key to our competitiveness and future success. We have a long tradition of developing innovative communication technologies, including technologies that form the base for industry standards. For example, we helped pioneer the development of industry-wide mobile technologies such as GSM, GPRS, EDGE, CDMA, WCDMA, HSPA, and Bluetooth.
We work closely with our customers to understand their businesses and technology needs and provide tailored solutions to help them fulfill their business objectives.
We will continue to devote significant resources to develop end-to-end communications solutions that will stimulate network deployments for geographic coverage as well as traffic capacity and thereby drive demand for our products and services.
Our expertise and experience in all major telecommunication standards along with our proven track record for quality and innovation have allowed us to develop our business on a worldwide basis.
We believe that our widespread geographical presence and the economies of scale associated with market share leadership give us competitive advantages. Global presence is an important factor, particularly when working as a business partner to operators working in multiple markets or globally. We are utilizing our strong international reach and core competence in mobile and fixed communications to expand into growth areas such as systems integration, service applications and managed services, as well as to develop alliances with suppliers and manufacturers in many countries in order to increase our combined effectiveness.
We will continue to improve our internal processes and support systems to drive operational excellence as a competitive advantage. In addition, we will continue to develop and maintain high levels of competence in our employees to secure our leading market position and to stay at the forefront of technological development.
136
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
ORGANIZATION
Governance
A significant amount of authority and responsibility is assigned to the management of our various operating units for tasks pertaining to daily operations. Governance of our operating units is carried out through steering boards whose members are representatives of the Group Management Team, the Extended Management Team and the management of the particular operating unit.
For more information regarding our corporate governance, please see the Corporate Governance Report or visit our web site www.ericsson.com/ericsson/corpinfo/corp_governance/ index.shtml.
Information on our web site does not form part of this document.
Group Functions
A number of Group Functions perform tasks pertaining to certain group-wide matters that are not naturally referable to a specific operational unit: Communications, Finance, Human Resources and Organization, Legal Affairs, Operational Excellence, Research & Development, Sales & Marketing and Strategy & Product Management.
Their responsibilities include the formulation of the Groups strategy, issuing of policies and directives, business control and resource allocation. In addition, Group Functions are responsible for the consolidation and reporting of financial performance, financing and cash management, legal issues, communication with various stakeholders including employees, investors, press and media as well as coordination and administration of a number of group-wide issues. Other important group-wide matters, such as Corporate Responsibility, are managed by Group Functions in conjunction with a network of experts from various parts of the Company.
BUSINESS SEGMENTS
We supply the network equipment and services that enable telecommunications. We offer end-to-end solutions for all major mobile communication standards. We also provide our customers with services for network system integration, managed services and other professional services. Through our Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications joint venture we offer a range of mobile handsets and other mobile devices, including those supporting multimedia applications and other personal communication services. In addition, the Company has products for special applications within mobile platforms, enterprise systems, cables and power modules.
Primary Segments
Ericsson is a telecommunications company developing and selling a variety of products aimed largely at customers in the telecommunications industry. When determining our operating segments, we have looked at which market and to what type of customers our products and services are aimed, and through what distribution channels they are sold as well as to commonality regarding technology, research and development. To best reflect our business focus and to facilitate comparability with our peers, we consolidate the results of our operations into three business segments:
| Systems, consisting of a three-pronged business approach: Mobile Networks, Fixed Networks and Professional Services; |
| Phones, carried out through the 50/50 joint venture with SONY Corporation; |
| Other Operations, which comprise a number of smaller businesses, including Mobile Platforms, Enterprise Systems, Cables, Power Modules and the Defense business (Divested to Saab AB September 1, 2006). |
137
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Secondary segments
We group sales into five geographical segments as shown below:
2006 SALES BY REGION AND SEGMENT
Sek billion |
Systems | Other Operations |
Total | ||||||
Western Europe |
45.4 | 6.5 | 51.9 | ||||||
CEMA 1) |
48.7 | 1.6 | 50.3 | ||||||
Asia Pacific |
42.0 | 1.2 | 43.2 | ||||||
North America |
15.3 | 0.6 | 15.9 | ||||||
Latin America |
16.2 | 0.2 | 16.5 | ||||||
Total |
167.6 | 10.2 | 177.8 | ||||||
percent share |
94 | % | 6 | % | 100 | % | |||
1) | Central and Eastern Europe, Middle East and Africa. |
Note: due to rounding, all rows and columns may not add up exactly to the totals.
Please also see Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C3, Segment Information.
Seasonality
Our quarterly sales, income and cash flows from operations are seasonal in nature and generally lower in the first and third quarters of the year and highest in the fourth quarter. This is mainly a result of the seasonal purchase patterns of network operators. Although demonstrating a strong seasonal pattern historically, our seasonal sales variances have not conformed to the longer-term pattern during the market downturn starting in 2001 and subsequent recovery during 2004. The table below illustrates the long-term average seasonal effect on sales for the period 1992 through 2006.
15-YEAR AVERAGE SEASONALITY
First quarter |
Second quarter |
Third quarter |
Fourth quarter |
|||||||||
Sequential Change |
-27 | % | 17 | % | -4 | % | 36 | % | ||||
Share of annual sales |
21 | % | 24 | % | 24 | % | 31 | % |
Compared to the 15-year historical pattern, the seasonality over the last three years has generally been less pronounced with a more equal distribution of sales between quarters. The table below illustrates the average seasonal effect on sales for the years 2004, 2005 and 2006.
MOST RECENT 3-YEAR AVERAGE SEASONALITY
First quarter |
Second quarter |
Third quarter |
Fourth quarter |
|||||||||
Sequential Change |
-19 | % | 17 | % | -5 | % | 27 | % | ||||
Share of annual sales |
21 | % | 25 | % | 24 | % | 30 | % |
138
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Segment Systems
Mobile Networks
We provide mobile systems solutions to network operators that enable reliable, efficient and cost effective mobile networks. Our systems offerings include radio base stations, base station and radio network controllers, mobile switching centers and application nodes. We are the market leader with approximately 35 percent global share of the addressable GSM/WCDMA track within the global mobile systems market, i.e. open non-proprietary standards. Our claim of market leadership in mobile systems is based on our reported sales and how they relate to the publicly reported and estimated mobile system sales of our main competitors. Statements from industry and financial analysts also support our estimates.
Each generation of mobile technology is associated with a group of international standards for mobile communications networks. Transitioning from one technology generation to the next, such as from 2G to 3G, requires network operators, equipment suppliers and mobile handset manufacturers to adopt new and emerging technology standards. We believe that the migration from voice services and basic mobile multimedia services to mobile broadband is the primary technological shift facing mobile network operators today. Our end-to-end solutions offer operators a smooth network migration to 3G.
Our expertise in all 2G standards and our role in developing 3G standards allow us to offer mobile telecommunications systems that incorporate any of the major 2G (GSM, TDMA, CDMA), 2.5G (GPRS) and 3G (EDGE, WCDMA, HSPA, CDMA2000, TD-SCDMA) mobile technology standards. As a result, we are able to offer tailored solutions to a network operator, regardless of the existing network standard used.
We offer a complete portfolio of radio base stations ranging from small pico cells (i.e. small cells in a mobile network that boost capacity and coverage within buildings) to high-capacity macro cell applications. Radio base stations provide access and interconnection between mobile handsets and the mobile network. A central feature of our 2G GSM radio base stations and base station controllers is their ability to be upgraded on a cost-effective basis to enable 2.5G/GPRS and 3G/EDGE transmissions. Similarly, our WCDMA base stations can be upgraded to HSPA.
Other important elements of radio access networks are the controllers for radio base stations and radio access network, which manage the traffic between the radio base stations and core network. In 2G, base station controllers in conjunction with mobile switching centers, effect call handovers between radio base stations as subscribers move between cell sites while engaged in a voice call or data transmission. Similarly, in 3G networks, a radio network controller effects call handover in conjunction with mobility server nodes within the service layer.
The core network nodes interconnect radio access networks with other parts of the network. Many of our core network switching systems, controllers for base stations and radio networks are built upon common platforms. Like our radio base station products, our mobile switching products have industry-leading scalability and capacity.
Mobile network equipment and associated network rollout services account for 74 percent of our Systems sales.
Fixed Networks
We are a supplier of broadband communications equipment and services mainly to fixed network operators in Latin America and Europe. We have a long history in fixed-line networking with an installed base of access and transit lines equivalent to 180 million lines or approximately 10 percent global market share of the installed
139
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
base. By successfully addressing three key operator needs: modernization and expansion of the fixed telephony networks; introduction of IP-based revenue generating services; and cost-efficient rollout of high capacity broadband networks with service differentiation, we have been able to secure strong market positions in voice over packet, soft switching and public Ethernet access.
Fixed network operators are moving from single-service networks toward broadband packet-switched multi-service networks that have the ability to simultaneously handle multiple services, such as voice, data and images. Migration to an all-IP-based packet-switched network is a necessary step in order to combine broadband Internet, voice and image traffic into one broadband network.
Our solution for such multi-service networks utilizes a layered softswitch service and control architecture, combined with broadband access and core network routing and transmission elements. Organizing a network into layers isolates the different functions, i.e., access, core network and services, and facilitates easier migration to an all-IP environment. Due to our leadership in next-generation mobile networks, we are able to leverage our IP-based multimedia subsystem (IMS) developed for 3G mobile networks also for next-generation fixed network applications. IMS is an open service layer platform that hosts IP based services such as Voice over IP (VoIP), push-to-talk etc. Since our IMS solution is common for both fixed and mobile networks, converged services can be transparently provided independent of the type of access.
Fixed network equipment and associated network rollout services account for 7 percent of our Systems sales.
Professional Services
Our professional services portfolio includes expertise in consulting, education, systems integration, managed services and customer support services.
Network operators are reducing operating expenses by optimizing the operation and maintenance of their networks. As a result, many network operators are increasingly outsourcing for example network design, operations and maintenance activities. When outsourcing, operators gain flexibility in capital employed, resources and time to market-all with an assured quality of service.
We offer some of the most comprehensive managed services capabilities within the telecom industry. Our offerings cover management of all aspects of day-to-day operations of a customers network as well as hosting of applications and content management. Ericssons Internet Payment eXchange (IPX) service, which is the global payment and messaging delivery solution for SMS, MMS, Web and WAP that facilitates payment and distribution of content by interconnecting content providers, media companies, governments and consumer brands with operators.
The combination of our local expertise, global technology leadership, business understanding, strong delivery capabilities and extensive experience in managing multi-vendor networks makes Ericsson a leading provider of services to network operators.
Professional services account for 19 percent of our Systems sales.
Customers
We are supplying equipment, integrated solutions and services to almost all major network operators globally. We derive most of our sales from large, multi-year network build-out agreements with a limited number of significant customers. Out of a customer base of more than 425 network operators, the ten largest customers account for 44 percent of our net sales, while the 20 largest customers account for 63 percent of our net sales. Our largest customer accounted for less than 7 percent of sales during 2006.
For more information, see Risk FactorsRisks Associated with the Industry and Market Conditions.
140
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Competitors
In Systems, we compete mainly with large and well-established communication equipment suppliers. Although competition varies depending on the products, services and geographical regions, our most significant competitors in mobile communication include Alcatel/Lucent, Nortel, Huawei, and Nokia/Siemens. With respect to fixed communications equipment, the competition is also highly concentrated and includes, among others, Alcatel/Lucent, Cisco, Huawei, Nokia/Siemens and Nortel. We also compete with numerous local and regional manufacturers and providers of communication equipment and services. We believe the most important competitive factors in this industry include existing customer relationships, the ability to cost-effectively upgrade or migrate an installed base, technological innovation, product design, compatibility of products with industry standards, and the capability for end-to-end systems integration.
Competition in professional services not only includes many of our traditional systems competitors but also a number of large companies from other industry sectors, such as IS/IT, for example IBM, EDS, Accenture and electronics manufacturing services companies as well as a large number of smaller but specialized companies operating on a local or regional basis. As this segment grows, we expect to see additional competitors emerge, possibly including some network operators attempting to expand into new segments.
For more information, see Risk FactorsRisks Associated with the Industry and Market Conditions.
Organization within Systems
Our organization in Systems is built around a structure of business units responsible for the development and delivery of products and services to market units that are responsible for local sales and customer support.
Business units
Access
Our Access business units main role is to continuously strengthen our world leadership in 2G & 3G radio access networks by offering innovative and cost-effective products and solutions that provide best-in-class performance. Business unit Access responsibility covers a wide spectrum of activities, from product development to production and supply. Business unit Access has manufacturing in Brazil, China, India and Sweden.
Systems
Business unit Systems is a leading supplier of end-to-end telecom grade network systems and multimedia services. The system offerings include tailored mobile core and fixed network solutions and service layer products. As a key player in the evolution to all-IP networks, we are a leader in the convergence of fixed and mobile networks and services. Business unit Systems has manufacturing in Brazil, China, India and Sweden.
Broadband Networks
The Broadband Networks business unit offers one of the worlds most widely deployed microwave radio systems (MINI-LINK) together with metro optical networks in customized and managed transport solutions. The products are essential elements of Ericssons end-to-end solutions but are also often chosen by operators utilizing other vendors network equipment. The broadband networks business unit has one of the largest microwave production plants in the world in Sweden, as well as manufacturing in Italy and Norway.
141
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Global Services
We enable operators to strengthen their competitiveness by offering a complete range of consulting, education, systems integration, managed services and customer support services as well as network rollout services that address a major part of their network operations. The business unit is represented in 140 countries with 24,000 employees mainly based within the local market units.
Market units
We use our own sales organization to market and sell our systems and services to customers in over 175 countries via a worldwide sales and support network consisting of 24 market units. Each market unit represents either a single country or a group of countries, depending on the extent of our business activities in that region. We have significant sales in all of the largest geographic markets for telecommunications, with no individual country accounting for more than 8 percent of sales.
We strongly believe that affordable and generally available telecommunication services are a prerequisite for social and economic development which improves the welfare of all people in any given country. As one of the worlds largest providers of communications equipment and services, Ericsson has implemented a strict trade compliance program throughout the group in order to comply with foreign and domestic laws and regulations, trade embargos and sanctions in force. In no way should our business activities be construed as supporting a particular political agenda or regime.
The majority of our market units operate through local subsidiaries that are present in each country. We use our local presence to help our customers achieve greater efficiencies and gain access to recognized world-class support resources wherever they operate. The market units utilize the product expertise of the central business units within the Systems segment in tailoring and integrating our products for delivery to customers. The market units are also responsible for after-sales support and rely in particular on the Global Services business unit in fulfilling this function.
Our customers have different needs in interacting with Ericsson as a supplier, ranging from support in identifying and capturing business opportunities to do-it-yourself fulfillment. We use three different sales approaches that acknowledge these different needs; Project Sales (interactive relationship selling with high involvement of the customer to identify and capture business opportunities, where the solution is not known at the point of sales), System Sales (interactive relationship selling of solutions configured for specific customer needs) and Product Sales (the outcome of relationship sales and frame agreements where customers may call-off well-defined products and services electronically). System Sales has historically been our most common sales approach to best meet our customers needs, however, as their needs evolve, the two other sales approaches will grow in importance.
Research & development
A robust R&D program is key to our competitiveness and future success. We spent over 15 percent of sales on R&D and other technical expenses during 2006. The vast majority of our R&D is invested in product development of which the majority in mobile communications network infrastructure. We have continued to invest in strategically important areas of broadband access, converged networks, service layer and multimedia.
Our R&D organization develops world-class products and performs world-leading research. About 17,100 (16,500) employees in 17 (17) countries worldwide are working in R&D in an organization consisting of development units, Ericsson research, standardization and IPR & licensing. The development units drive R&D operational excellence to increase efficiency and decrease leadtime.
142
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Ericsson Research conducts applied research in various strategic areas to provide Ericsson with system concepts, technology, and methodology to help secure our long-term, strategic position. World-class innovations are achieved through cooperation within Ericsson and with a variety of partners including customers, universities and research institutes. Standardization bodies establish the standards that lead the industry, and Ericsson is a leading player in all major standardization organizations.
For more information regarding product and technology development, please see Risk FactorsStrategic and Operational Risks and Board of Directors ReportResearch and Development.
Intellectual property rights and licensing
Through many years of involvement in the development of new technologies, we have built up a considerable portfolio of intellectual property rights (IPR) relating to telecommunications technologies. As of December 31, 2006, we held approximately 22,000 (20,000) patents worldwide, including a substantial number of patents essential to the 2G/2.5G standards of GSM, GPRS and CDMA, as well as numerous patents essential to 3G standards, such as EDGE, WCDMA, HSPA, MBMS, TD-SCDMA, CDMA2000 and Next Generation OFDM/LTE. We also hold important patents for many other areas, e.g. WiMAX, Voice over IP (VoIP), ATM, WAP, WLAN, mobile platforms and Bluetooth. With the acquisition of Marconi, our optical backbone network and transport technology portfolios were strengthened.
Our intellectual property rights are valuable business assets. We license these rights to many other companies including equipment suppliers, handset manufacturers and mobile applications developers, in return for royalty payments and/or access to additional intellectual property rights. In addition, we acquire rights via licenses to utilize intellectual property rights of third parties. We believe that we have access to all related patents that are material to our business in part or in whole.
For more information, see Risk FactorsStrategic and Operational Risks.
Segment Phones
Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications AB (Sony Ericsson) delivers innovative and feature-rich mobile phones, accessories and PC-cards, which allow us to provide end-to-end solutions to our customers. The 50/50 joint venture, formed in October 2001, combines the mobile communications expertise of Ericsson with the consumer electronic devices and content expertise of SONY Corporation and forms an essential part of our end-to-end capability for mobile multimedia services.
Sony Ericsson is responsible for product design and development, as well as marketing, sales, distribution and customer services. About one-third of Sony Ericssons handsets are produced in their factory in China. The remaining two-thirds of production is more or less equally split between contract manufacturers (EMS) and other device manufacturers (ODM) at locations in several countries in Asia, Latin America and Europe. Sony Ericssons global management is based in London and R&D centers are located in China, Japan, Sweden, the UK and the US.
Within the segment Phones, the primary competitors include Nokia, Motorola, Samsung and a number of other companies such as LG Electronics, NEC and Sharp. We believe that our mobile phone joint venture with Japans SONY Corporation creates a distinctive competitive advantage.
Sales for Sony Ericsson are not included in our reported sales, as their operating results are reported according to the equity method under Share in earnings of joint ventures and associated companies in the income statement.
143
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Segment Other Operations
Units within the segment Other Operations
This segment principally consists of a number of operations deemed too small to be reported as separate segments. Other Operations include Mobile Platforms, Enterprise, Network Technologies (cables), Power Modules and Microwave Systems (Defense) (divested to Saab AB as per September 1, 2006).
Businesses in our Other Operations segment market their products and services through their own specialized direct and indirect sales channels. On occasion, these specialized sales and marketing teams work with our market units in Systems in certain markets or when dealing with large customers with whom we have a relationship.
In our Other Operations segment, our competitors vary widely depending on the product or service being offered. We face significant competition with regard to substantially all of these products and services.
Sales of these units are consolidated within Other Operations and in total amount to 6 percent of total net sales, with no single unit representing more than 2 percent.
Ericsson Microwave Systems
The defense business of Microwave Systems was divested to Saab AB on September 1, 2006. The remaining activities, National security and Public safety solutions, were transferred to segment Systems. Up until September 1, 2006, Microwave Systems provided national security and public safety solutions to defense, government and security agencies in Sweden and to more than 20 countries around the world. The unit supplied advanced airborne, terrestrial and marine radar systems, which were integrated into command, control and communication functionality.
Ericsson Enterprise
Enterprise provides communications systems and services that enable businesses, public entities and educational institutions to have seamless access to applications and services across multiple locations. We address a wide variety of enterprise needs through segmented offerings for both small and large enterprises. We focus on providing solutions for Voice over IP (VoIP)-based private branch exchanges (PBX), Wireless Local Area Networks (WLAN), and Mobile Intranet solutions. With Mobile Enterprise, users on the move are able to access a range of business-critical communications and information applications from a variety of devices over private or public, fixed or mobile networks. Ericsson Enterprise operates mainly from Sweden, but has a global presence through the market units and other partners/distributors. Manufacturing is outsourced.
Ericsson Cables
Our cables unit provides a full range of cable related solutions for telecom and power networks. Ericsson is a leading player in the passive fiber access network field and our expertise includes integration of copper, fiber optic and mobile technologies. About a third of the sales from our Cables group is attributable to inter-segment sales. Manufacturing is carried out in China, India, Malaysia and Sweden.
Ericsson Mobile Platforms
Ericsson Mobile Platforms is a leading platform technology supplier for GSM/EDGE and WCDMA/HSPA platforms used in devices such as mobile handsets and PC cards. Through Ericsson Mobile Platforms, Ericsson
144
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
was one of the first companies in the world to license open-standard end-to-end interoperability tested GSM/EDGE and WCDMA technology platforms. The product offerings are based on our comprehensive intellectual property portfolio and include: reference designs, platform software, ASIC (application specific integrated circuit) designs and development boards, development and test tools, training, support and documentation. By licensing our technology and platforms, mobile phone manufacturers can launch new products faster, with limited R&D investments and lower technology risks, allowing them to focus on product differentiation in areas such as applications, industrial design, manufacturing, distribution and branding getting advanced and attractive products with short time to market. Ericsson Mobile Platforms has operations at nine global locations with main operations in Sweden.
Ericsson Power Modules
Ericsson Power Modules is a leading supplier of miniaturized and high density direct current DC/DC converters and DC/DC regulators, mainly to the communications industry, for advanced applications such as multiplexors, switches, routers and radio base stations. In addition, the levels of technology, ruggedness and reliability of these products mean that they often provide excellent solutions for other demanding applications in medical, avionics, computing, military, space, and industrial market sectors. Manufacturing is centralized to China.
Changes in organization and management
Organizational changes made during 2006:
| As per January 2006, Pakistan was moved from the Market Area Asia Pacific to the Market Area Central & Eastern Europe, Middle East and Africa (CEMA). |
| As per January 2006, three development units, IP Networks, Core Network Evolution and Service Layer Development, were transferred to business unit Systems and business unit Access to bring development closer to the business, improving time to market and ensuring that Ericssons products and solutions meet user needs. |
| As per January 2006, certain assets and staff of Marconi were acquired and integrated within business unit Transmission and Transport Networks, business unit Global Services and business unit Systems. |
| As per January 2006, business unit Transmission and Transport Networks was renamed to business unit Broadband Networks. |
Organizational changes made during 2006 with effect 2007:
| A new organization is effective as from January 1, 2007 consisting of Networks, Global Services and Multimedia. |
| Business unit Networks includes mobile and fixed access, core and transmission networks, as well as next-generation IP-networks. The former business units Systems, Access and Broadband Networks are integrated into the new unit, as well as Ericsson Power Modules and Ericsson Cables. The unit is headed by Kurt Jofs, Executive Vice President and previously head of business unit Access. The new unit has approximately 21,500 employees. |
| Business unit Global Services is intact with approximately 24,000 employees. |
| Business unit Multimedia provides solutions for charging solutions, mobile TV, radio, video, music, gaming, and print over fixed and mobile networks and other new multimedia applications. The business unit includes Multimedia systems, previously reported under segment Systems and business units Ericsson Mobile Platforms and Enterprise, previously reported under segment Other |
145
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Operations as well as Ericsson Consumer and Enterprise Lab. The unit is headed by Jan Wäreby, Senior Vice President and head of business unit Multimedia. The new unit has approximately 4,000 employees. |
| As from January 1, 2007 Group function Strategy and Product Management is split and moved to Group Function Operational Excellence and business unit Networks. Strategy is moved to Group Function Operational Excellence and renamed Group Function Strategy and Operational Excellence. The unit is headed by Joakim Westh head of Group Function Operational Excellence. Product management is moved to business unit Networks. |
| As per January 24, 2007 Ericsson completed the cash tender offer for US-based Redback Networks. |
Changes in the Group Management Team made 2006:
| As per January 2006, Sivert Bergman, head of business unit Broadband Networks, was appointed integration manager for the Marconi acquisition and included in the Group Management Team. |
Changes in the Group Management Team made 2006 with effect 2007:
| As per January 2007, Kurt Jofs, Executive Vice President and Head of business unit Access is appointed head of the new business unit Networks. |
| As per January 2007, Jan Wäreby, is appointed Senior Vice President and head of business unit Multimedia and included in the Group Management Team. |
| As per January 2007, Joakim Westh, head of Group Function Operational Excellence, also assumes responsibility for Strategy management. |
| As per January 2007, Sivert Bergman, head of business unit Broadband Networks, leaves the Group Management Team as Marconi now is fully integrated. |
| As per January 2007, Torbjorn Nilsson, head of Group Function Strategy and Product management leaves the Group Management Team. |
For more information about management, please see Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C29, Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management.
HUMAN RESOURCES
We believe that every employee should be treated with respect and dignity. We value the rich diversity and creative potential of people with differing backgrounds and abilities. A culture of equal opportunities in which personal success depends on personal merit and performance is encouraged throughout our operations.
We have three core values: Professionalism, Respect and Perseverance. These values form the foundation of how we operate our business. Our core values define how we treat each other, our customers and our business partners and therefore they define our culture. Characteristics of our culture are exhibited by a passion to win; employee diversity, honesty, trust and support for each other; integrity and high ethical standards; and leadership by example at all levels. We believe the best way to further develop our business is to remain accountable to ourselves and to our customers.
146
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Every year we conduct an employee satisfaction survey to assess our Human Capital Index and employee Empowerment Index.
We maintain an open management style that involves our employees in both daily decisions that affect them as well as longer-term matters. We are fully committed to keeping all employees informed about the implications of major business changes and other relevant matters. Key business priorities are communicated throughout the organization and form part of the basis for employee compensation and incentive plans. Details of these plans appear in Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C29, Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management. We also have constructive relationships with a variety of trade unions, including formal recognition and active dialogue where appropriate.
PRIMARY MANUFACTURING AND ASSEMBLY FACILITIES
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | 2003 | |||||||||||||
Sites | Sq Meters | Sites | Sq Meters | Sites | Sq Meters | Sites | Sq Meters | |||||||||
Sweden |
8 | 231,500 | 9 | 256,615 | 10 | 277,415 | 10 | 310,000 | ||||||||
China |
3 | 20,860 | 3 | 15,200 | 3 | 15,200 | 3 | 9,500 | ||||||||
Italy |
2 | 20,100 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 0 | ||||||||
Brazil |
1 | 18,400 | 1 | 15,840 | 1 | 15,840 | 1 | 22,100 | ||||||||
Germany |
1 | 13,900 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 0 | ||||||||
India |
1 | 5,364 | 1 | 5,364 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 0 | ||||||||
Other |
2 | 8,100 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 0 | 0 | ||||||||
Total |
18 | 317,560 | 14 | 293,019 | 14 | 308,455 | 14 | 341,600 | ||||||||
During 2006, manufacturing and assembly facilities related to Marconi added an aggregate of 39,000 square meters in Italy, Germany and USA.
During 2006, our Defense unit was divested and related leased facility was transferred.
SUPPLY
Manufacturing and assembly
Systems manufacturing consists of two basic production activities, module and node. However, we outsource about half of our systems module production to several electronics manufacturing service (EMS) companies. Most of our node production is done in-house. We have 18 significant manufacturing and assembly locations worldwide with a total of approximately 320,000 square meters of floor space. We lease all of these facilities except one in China and one in Brazil as well as some former Marconi facilities in Germany, Italy and the US.
The Systems segment consumes more than two-thirds of the total floor space, with Cables and Power modules consuming most of the rest. In Sweden, the majority of the floor space within our production facilities is used for module production with the balance mostly used for node assembly and testing. Including the EMS production, approximately 35-40 (35-40) percent of Systems module production and 75-80 (75-80) percent of Systems node production is performed in Sweden.
We intend to continue to outsource module production where adequate manufacturing capacity and expertise are available on favorable terms. Such outsourcing of the major part of module manufacturing provides us greater flexibility to adapt to economic and market changes. However, the timing and level of out-sourcing is a balance between short-term demand and longer-term flexibility. Therefore, we generally plan to use our own production capabilities to absorb temporary changes in volumes.
147
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
We manage our own production capacity on a global basis by allocating production to sites where capacity is available and costs are competitive. At year-end 2006, excluding Marconi operations, our overall utilization was close to 100 percent as we continuously adjust our production capacity to meet expected demand.
The table Primary Manufacturing and assembly facilities above summarizes our major manufacturing and assembly facilities as well as the total square meters of floor space at year-end.
Suppliers
Most of our node production, i.e., assembly, integration and testing of modular subsystems into complete system nodes such as radio base stations, mobile switching centers etc., is done in-house. About half of our module production, i.e., production of subsystems such as circuit boards, radio frequency (RF) modules, antennas etc., is outsourced to a group of electronics manufacturing services companies including Celestica, Elcoteq, Flextronics, Jabil and Solectron, of which the vast majority is in low-cost countries. We also purchase customized and standardized equipment, components and services from several global providers as well as from numerous local and regional suppliers.
A number of our suppliers design and manufacture highly specialized and customized components for our end-to-end solutions as well as individual nodes. We generally attempt to negotiate global supply agreements with our primary suppliers. While we are not dependent on any one supplier for the provision of standardized equipment or components and seek to avoid single source supply situations, a need to switch to an alternative supplier may require us to allocate additional resources to ensure that our technical standards and other requirements are met. This process could take some time to complete. Accordingly, a need to switch to an alternative supplier could potentially have an adverse effect on our operations in the short term.
For more information, see Risk FactorsStrategic and Operational Risks.
Sources and availability of materials
We purchase raw materials, electronic components, ready-made products and services from a significant number of domestic and foreign suppliers. Variations in market prices for copper, aluminum, steel, precious metals, plastics and other raw materials have a limited effect on our total cost of goods sold. Our purchases mainly consist of electronic components as well as ready-made products and services. To a limited extent, we are involved in the production of certain components such as power modules and cables, which are used in our systems products as well as sold externally to other equipment manufacturers.
Based on our most recent sourcing agreements, the increase in oil and metal prices during 2006 had only a limited negative effect on our costs and did not affect the availability of the electronic components or ready-made products and services that we require. To the extent possible, we rely on alternative supply sources for the purchased elements of our products to avoid sole source situations and to secure sufficient supply at competitive prices. Assuming there will only be a moderate increase in market demand, we do not foresee any supply constraints to meet our expected production requirements during 2007.
148
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
This Annual Report includes forward-looking statements about future market conditions, operations and results. Expressions such as believe, expect, anticipate, intend, may, could, plan and similar words are intended to help identify forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements may be found throughout this document, but in particular in the sections captioned Operational Review, Board of Directors Report and Information on the Company and include statements regarding:
| our goals, strategies and performance expectations; |
| the markets we currently or soon intend to address; |
| our liquidity, capital resources, capital expenditures and our credit ratings; |
| the expected demand for our existing as well as new products and services; |
| our joint venture and strategic cooperation activities; |
| technology and industry trends including competition and our customer structure; and |
| our plans for new products and services including research and development expenditures. |
Although we believe that the expectations reflected in such statements are reasonable, we cannot assure you that these expectations will materialize. Because forward-looking statements are based on assumptions and estimates, and are subject to risks and uncertainties, actual results could differ materially from those described or implied herein. Important factors that could affect whether and to what extent any of our forward-looking statements materialize include, but are not limited to:
| our ability to respond to changes in the telecommunications market and general market conditions in a cost effective and timely manner; |
| developments in political, economic and regulatory fields in the markets in which we operate, including allegations of health risks from electromagnetic fields and cost of radio licenses for our customers; |
| effectiveness of our strategies and their execution including partnerships, acquisitions and divestitures; |
| financial risks, including foreign exchange rate changes, interest rate changes, changes in tax liabilities, credit risks in relation to counterparties, customer defaults under significant customer financing arrangements and risks of confiscation of assets in foreign countries; |
| reduction in the number of customers due to e.g. mergers, and the negative business consequences of a loss of, or significant decline in, our business with a major customer; |
| impact of changes in product demand, price erosion, competition from existing or new competitors or new technology and the risk that our products and services may not sell at the rates or levels we anticipate; |
| our ability to develop commercially viable products, systems and services, to acquire licenses of necessary technology, to protect our intellectual property rights through patents and trademarks and to defend them against infringement, and results of patent litigation; |
| supply constraints, including component or production capacity shortages, suppliers abilities to cost effectively deliver quality products on time and in sufficient volumes, and risks related to concentration of proprietary or outsourced production in a single facility or sole source situations with a single vendor; and |
| our ability to recruit and retain qualified management and other key employees. |
Certain of these risks and uncertainties are described further in Risk Factors. We undertake no obligation to publicly update or revise any forward-looking statements included in this Annual Report, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise, except as required by applicable law or stock exchange regulation.
149
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
STOCK EXCHANGE TRADING
Ericssons Class A and Class B shares are traded on the Stock-holm Stock Exchange (Stockholmsbörsen) and the Class B shares are also traded on the London Stock Exchange.
In the United States, the Class B shares are traded on NAS-DAQ in the form of American Depositary Shares (ADS) evidenced by American Depositary Receipts (ADR) under the symbol ERIC. Each ADS represents 10 Class B shares. On August 24, 2006, the Ericsson stock ticker on NASDAQ was changed from ERICY to ERIC.
Approximately 40 (43) billion shares were traded in 2006, of which about 88 (73) percent on the Stockholm Stock Exchange, about 12 (16) percent on NASDAQ, and less than 1 (1) percent on the London Stock Exchange. Trading volume in Ericsson shares increased by approximately 14 percent on the Stockholm Stock Exchange and decreased by approximately 27 percent on NAS-DAQ as compared to 2005.
SHARE PRICE TREND
In 2006, Ericssons total market value increased by about 1 percent to approximately SEK 446 billion (SEK 441 billion in 2005). The OMX SP Index on the Stockholm Stock Exchange increased by 24 percent, the NASDAQ telecom index increased by approximately 21 percent and the NASDAQ composite index increased by approximately 7 percent in 2006.
SHARE DATA |
||||||||||
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | 2003 | 2002 | ||||||
Earnings per share, diluted (SEK) 1) |
1.65 | 1.53 | 1.11 | -0.69 | -1.51 | |||||
P/E ratio, Class B shares 1) |
17 | 18 | 19 | | | |||||
Dividend (SEK) |
0.50 | 0.45 | 0.25 | 0 | 0 |
1) | For 2004 restated in accordance with IFRS. |
150
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
SHARE PRICES ON THE STOCKHOLM STOCK EXCHANGE (SEK)
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | 2003 | 2002 | ||||||
Class A at last day of trading |
27.60 | 27.50 | 21.70 | 13.90 | 8.60 | |||||
Class A high for year (March 24, 2006) |
30.90 | 28.70 | 26.10 | 16.80 | 42.89 | |||||
Class A low for year (June 13, 2006) |
20.90 | 19.80 | 14.00 | 5.55 | 3.80 | |||||
Class B at last day of trading |
27.65 | 27.30 | 21.20 | 12.90 | 6.10 | |||||
Class B high for year (March 24, 2006) |
31.00 | 29.00 | 24.50 | 14.60 | 44.78 | |||||
Class B low for year (June 13, 2006) |
20.90 | 19.40 | 12.70 | 4.11 | 2.96 |
OFFER AND LISTING DETAILS
Principal trading marketThe Stockholm Stock Exchange share prices
The tables above and below state the high and low sales prices for our Class A and Class B shares as reported by the Stockholm Stock Exchange for the last five years. The equity securities listed on the Stockholm Stock Exchange Official Price List of Shares currently comprise the shares of 276 companies (of which 51 from the former A list). Trading on the exchange generally continues until 5:30 p.m. each business day. In addition to official trading on the exchange, there is also trading off the exchange during official trading hours and also after 5:30 p.m. Trading on the exchange tends to involve a higher percentage of retail clients, while trading off the exchange often involves larger Swedish institutions, banks arbitraging between the Swedish market and foreign markets, and foreign buyers and sellers purchasing shares from or selling shares to Swedish institutions.
The exchange publishes a daily Official Price List of Shares which includes the volume of recorded transactions in each listed stock, together with the prices of the highest and lowest recorded trades of the day. The Official Price List of Shares reflects price and volume information for trades completed by the members.
Host market NASDAQ ADS Prices
The table below states the high and low sales prices quoted for our ADSs on NASDAQ for the last five years. The NASDAQ quotations represent prices between dealers, not including retail mark-ups, markdowns or commissions, and do not necessarily represent actual transactions.
The annual high and low market prices on these markets are shown in the table Annual high and low market prices below.
ANNUAL HIGH AND LOW MARKET PRICES
THE STOCKHOLM STOCK EXCHANGE | NASDAQ | |||||||||||
SEK per Class A share | SEK per Class B share | USD per ADS 1) | ||||||||||
Period |
High | Low | High | Low | High | Low | ||||||
2002 |
42.89 | 3.80 | 44.78 | 2.96 | 43.33 | 3.40 | ||||||
2003 |
16.80 | 5.55 | 14.60 | 4.11 | 18.85 | 5.20 | ||||||
2004 |
26.10 | 14.00 | 24.50 | 12.70 | 34.57 | 17.93 | ||||||
2005 |
28.70 | 19.80 | 29.00 | 19.40 | 37.19 | 27.78 | ||||||
2006 |
30.90 | 20.90 | 31.00 | 20.90 | 41.14 | 28.88 |
Share market prices prior to August 8, 2002, have been adjusted for the stock dividend element of the stock issue.
1) | One ADS = 10 Class B shares. (Prior to October 23, 2002, one ADS = one Class B share. Share prices have been adjusted accordingly.) |
151
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
The table below states the high and low sales prices for each quarter of 2005 and 2006.
QUARTERLY HIGH AND LOW MARKET PRICES
THE STOCKHOLM STOCK EXCHANGE | NASDAQ | |||||||||||
SEK per Class A share | SEK per Class B share | USD per ADS 1) | ||||||||||
Period |
High | Low | High | Low | High | Low | ||||||
2005 |
||||||||||||
First Quarter |
22.40 | 19.80 | 22.10 | 19.40 | 32.49 | 27.78 | ||||||
Second Quarter |
26.10 | 19.80 | 26.30 | 19.70 | 33.87 | 27.80 | ||||||
Third Quarter |
28.40 | 24.30 | 28.50 | 24.30 | 36.99 | 31.74 | ||||||
Fourth Quarter |
28.70 | 25.30 | 29.00 | 25.20 | 37.19 | 32.17 | ||||||
2006 |
||||||||||||
First Quarter |
30.90 | 25.80 | 31.00 | 25.60 | 39.37 | 33.63 | ||||||
Second Quarter |
29.90 | 20.90 | 30.00 | 20.90 | 39.28 | 28.88 | ||||||
Third Quarter |
25.70 | 21.00 | 25.80 | 20.90 | 35.35 | 29.13 | ||||||
Fourth Quarter |
28.45 | 24.80 | 28.60 | 24.85 | 41.14 | 33.95 |
1) | One ADS = 10 Class B shares |
The table below states the high and low sales prices for each of the last ten months (August 2006 to May 2007).
MONTHLY HIGH AND LOW MARKET PRICES
THE STOCKHOLM STOCK EXCHANGE | NASDAQ | |||||||||||
SEK per Class A share | SEK per Class B share | USD per ADS 1) | ||||||||||
Period |
High | Low | High | Low | High | Low | ||||||
August 2006 |
24.50 | 21.00 | 24.50 | 20.90 | 33.93 | 29.16 | ||||||
September 2006 |
25.70 | 23.50 | 25.80 | 23.40 | 35.35 | 32.06 | ||||||
October 2006 |
27.85 | 24.80 | 28.00 | 24.85 | 38.24 | 33.95 | ||||||
November 2006 |
28.45 | 26.40 | 28.60 | 26.40 | 40.41 | 37.52 | ||||||
December 2006 |
28.00 | 26.00 | 28.10 | 25.95 | 41.14 | 38.40 | ||||||
January 2007 |
29.70 | 27.50 | 29.90 | 27.45 | 42.13 | 37.98 | ||||||
February 2007 |
39.66 | 24.70 | 27.85 | 24.70 | 39.66 | 35.26 | ||||||
March 2007 |
26.55 | 23.95 | 26.70 | 23.80 | 38.24 | 33.94 | ||||||
April 2007 |
27.10 | 25.20 | 27.20 | 25.25 | 40.00 | 36.24 | ||||||
May 2007 |
26.40 | 24.85 | 26.55 | 25.00 | 39.47 | 36.80 |
1) | One ADS = 10 Class B shares |
SHARE CAPITAL
As of December 31, 2006, Ericssons share capital was SEK 16,132,258,678 (16,132,258,678) represented by 16,132,258,678 (16,132,258,678) shares. The par value of each share is SEK 1.00. As of December 31, 2006, the shares were divided into 1,308,779,918 (1,308,779,918) Class A shares, each carrying one vote, and 14,823,478,760 (14,823,478,760) Class B shares, each carrying one-tenth of one vote. As of December 31, 2006, Ericsson held 251,013,892 Class B shares as treasury shares. No class C shares, each carrying one-thousandth of one vote, currently exist.
There have been no share repurchases by Ericsson during 2006.
152
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
CHANGES IN NUMBER OF SHARES AND CAPITAL STOCK 2002-2006
Number of shares | Capital stock | |||||
2002 |
Conversions of convertible debentures | 560 | 560 | |||
2002 |
New issue (Class B shares) 1:1 | 7,908,754,111 | 7,908,754,111 | |||
2003 |
New issue (Class C shares, later converted to Class B) | 158,000,000 | 158,000,000 | |||
2003 |
December 31 | 16,132,258,678 | 16,132,258,678 | |||
2004 |
December 31 (no changes) | 16,132,258,678 | 16,132,258,678 | |||
2005 |
December 31 (no changes) | 16,132,258,678 | 16,132,258,678 | |||
2006 |
December 31 (no changes) | 16,132,258,678 | 16,132,258,678 |
SHAREHOLDERS
As of December 31, 2006, we had 814,841 shareholders registered at VPC (the Swedish Securities Register Center), of which 1,640 holders with a US address. According to information provided by Citibank, there were 117,866,408 ADSs outstanding as of December 31, 2006, and 5,892 registered holders of such ADSs. A significant number of the ADSs are held of record by banks, brokers and/or nominees for the accounts of their customers. As of December 31, 2006, banks, brokers and/or nominees held ADSs on behalf of 242,519 accounts.
According to information known at year-end 2006, more than 80 percent of our Class A and Class B shares were owned by institutions, Swedish and international.
TEN LARGEST COUNTRIES OF OWNERSHIP
As of December 31, | ||||||
Percent of capital |
2006 | 2005 | ||||
Sweden |
50.0 | % | 54.1 | % | ||
United States |
27.1 | % | 26.5 | % | ||
United Kingdom |
6.8 | % | 4.3 | % | ||
Luxembourg |
3.9 | % | 3.8 | % | ||
Switzerland |
1.9 | % | 1.8 | % | ||
France |
1.4 | % | 1.1 | % | ||
Belgium |
1.3 | % | 0.9 | % | ||
Netherlands |
1.1 | % | 0.9 | % | ||
Denmark |
0.9 | % | 0.9 | % | ||
Germany |
0.7 | % | 1.1 | % | ||
Other countries |
4.9 | % | 4.0 | % | ||
Source: SIS Ägarservice AB
153
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
The following table sets forth share information, as of December 31, 2006, with respect to our largest shareholders registered at VPC and known by us, ranked by percentage of voting rights:
LARGEST SHAREHOLDERS BY VOTING RIGHTS DECEMBER 31, 2006
Identity of person or group1) |
Number of Class A shares |
Percentage of total Class A shares |
Number of Class B shares |
Percentage of total Class B shares |
Voting rights, percent |
Percentage of capital |
||||||||||
Investor AB |
513,320,192 | 39.22 | 297,073,324 | 2.00 | 19.46 | 5.02 | ||||||||||
AB Industrivärden |
372,000,000 | 28.42 | 5,000,000 | 0.03 | 13.35 | 2.34 | ||||||||||
SHB Pensionsstiftelse |
83,903,000 | 6.41 | | | 3.01 | 0.52 | ||||||||||
Livförs. AB Skandia |
63,806,641 | 4.87 | 69,931,826 | 0.47 | 2.54 | 0.83 | ||||||||||
Pensionskassan SHB Förs.fören. |
63,360,000 | 4.84 | | | 2.27 | 0.39 | ||||||||||
Swedbank Robur fonder |
7,440,973 | 0.57 | 403,173,269 | 2.72 | 1.71 | 2.54 | ||||||||||
Alecta |
19,966,000 | 1.53 | 240,000,000 | 1.62 | 1.58 | 1.61 | ||||||||||
AMF Pension |
4,763,682 | 0.36 | 251,730,000 | 1.70 | 1.07 | 1.59 | ||||||||||
SEB Trygg Försäkring |
23,024,095 | 1.76 | 51,939,000 | 0.35 | 1.01 | 0.46 | ||||||||||
SHB/SPP fonder |
99,552 | 0.07 | 278,006,658 | 1.87 | 0.99 | 1.71 | ||||||||||
Tredje AP-fonden |
12,245,095 | 0.94 | 120,019,925 | 0.81 | 0.87 | 0.82 | ||||||||||
Första AP-fonden |
7,472,938 | 0.57 | 158,151,211 | 1.07 | 0.83 | 1.03 | ||||||||||
SEB fonder |
3,135,549 | 0.24 | 187,367,096 | 1.26 | 0.77 | 1.15 | ||||||||||
Nordea fonder |
1,944,145 | 0.15 | 191,078,855 | 1.29 | 0.75 | 1.19 | ||||||||||
SHB Personalstiftelse |
20,000,000 | 1.52 | | | 0.72 | 0.12 | ||||||||||
Fjärde AP-fonden |
2,812,755 | 0.21 | 129,821,845 | 0.88 | 0.57 | 0.82 | ||||||||||
Andra AP-fonden |
| | 149,123,659 | 1.01 | 0.53 | 0.92 | ||||||||||
Oktogonen |
12,903,000 | 1.00 | | | 0.46 | 0.08 | ||||||||||
Foreign owners2) |
18,808,834 | 1.44 | 8,054,883,408 | 54.34 | 29.53 | 50.05 | ||||||||||
of which Oppenheimer Funds Inc. |
| | 334,046,626 | 2.25 | 1.20 | 2.07 | ||||||||||
of which Barclays |
33,400 | 0.02 | 292,853,578 | 2.00 | 1.05 | 1.82 | ||||||||||
of which Fidelity |
| | 255,287,828 | 1.72 | 0.91 | 1.58 | ||||||||||
Others |
77,773,467 | 5.88 | 4,236,178,684 | 28.58 | 17.98 | 26.81 | ||||||||||
Total |
1,308,779,918 | 100 | % | 14,823,478,760 | 100 | % | 100 | % | 100 | % | ||||||
1) | Sources: SIS Ägarservice AB and VPC AB, December 31, 2006, and Capital Precision, December 2006. |
2) | Including Nats Cumco as Nominee: 1,134,962,281 Class B shares. |
154
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
The following table indicates changes in holdings of the Class A and Class B shares, respectively, held by major shareholders and percent of voting rights, as of December 31, 2004, 2005 and 2006.
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | ||||||||||||||||
Person or group (percent) |
Class A shares |
Class B shares |
Voting rights |
Class A shares |
Class B shares |
Voting rights |
Class A shares |
Class B shares |
Voting rights | |||||||||
Investor AB |
39.22 | 2.00 | 19.46 | 39.22 | 2.00 | 19.46 | 39.22 | 2.00 | 19.46 | |||||||||
AB Industrivärden |
28.42 | 0.03 | 13.35 | 28.42 | 0.03 | 13.35 | 28.42 | | 13.33 | |||||||||
Svenska Handelsbankens Pensionsstiftelse |
6.41 | | 3.01 | 6.41 | | 3.01 | 6.41 | | 3.01 | |||||||||
Livförsäkrings AB Skandia |
4.87 | 0.47 | 2.54 | 4.51 | 0.55 | 2.40 | 4.51 | 0.50 | 2.38 | |||||||||
Pensionskassan SHB Försäkringsförening |
4.84 | | 2.27 | 4.84 | | 2.27 | 4.84 | | 2.27 | |||||||||
Swedbank Robur Fonder |
0.57 | 2.72 | 1.71 | 0.57 | 2.54 | 1.62 | 0.51 | 2.65 | 1.62 | |||||||||
Alecta |
1.53 | 1.62 | 1.58 | 1.05 | 2.50 | 1.82 | 0.19 | 1.25 | 0.75 | |||||||||
AMF Pension |
0.36 | 1.70 | 1.07 | 0.36 | 1.81 | 1.13 | 0.36 | 2.15 | 1.33 | |||||||||
SEB Trygg Försäkring |
1.76 | 0.35 | 1.01 | 2.13 | 0.39 | 1.21 | 2.13 | 0.39 | 1.22 | |||||||||
SHB/SPP Fonder |
0.07 | 1.87 | 0.99 | 0.05 | 2.13 | 1.15 | 0.24 | 1.74 | 1.05 | |||||||||
Tredje AP-fonden |
0.94 | 0.81 | 0.87 | 0.91 | 1.02 | 0.97 | 0.94 | 0.97 | 0.97 | |||||||||
Första AP-fonden |
0.57 | 1.07 | 0.83 | 0.57 | 1.13 | 0.87 | 0.57 | 1.17 | 0.90 | |||||||||
SEB fonder |
0.24 | 1.26 | 0.77 | 0.27 | 1.28 | 0.81 | 0.27 | 1.25 | 0.80 | |||||||||
Nordea Fonder |
0.15 | 1.29 | 0.75 | 0.20 | 1.67 | 0.98 | 0.26 | 1.64 | 1.01 | |||||||||
Svenska Handelsbankens Personalstiftelse |
1.52 | | 0.72 | 1.53 | | 0.72 | 1.53 | | 0.72 | |||||||||
Fjärde AP-fonden |
0.21 | 0.88 | 0.57 | 0.22 | 1.41 | 0.85 | 0.22 | 1.32 | 0.81 | |||||||||
Andra AP-fonden |
| 1.01 | 0.53 | 0.10 | 1.17 | 0.67 | ||||||||||||
Oktogonen |
1.00 | | 0.46 | |||||||||||||||
Foreign owners |
1.44 | 54.34 | 29.53 | 1.24 | 49.86 | 27.06 | 1.82 | 50.15 | 27.48 | |||||||||
of which Oppenheimer Funds Inc. |
| 2.25 | 1.20 | |||||||||||||||
of which Barclays |
0.02 | 2.00 | 1.05 | |||||||||||||||
of which Fidelity |
| 1.72 | 0.91 | | 2.29 | 1.22 | | 5.52 | 2.93 | |||||||||
Others |
5.88 | 28.58 | 17.98 | 7.40 | 29.56 | 19.17 | 5.85 | 32.75 | 20.04 | |||||||||
Total |
100.00 | 100.00 | 100.00 | 100.00 | 100.00 | 100.00 | 100.00 | 100.00 | 100.00 | |||||||||
Source: SIS Ägarservice AB and VPC AB, December 31, 2006, and Capital Precision, December 2006.
Our major shareholders do not have different voting rights than other shareholders.
As far as we know, the Company is not directly or indirectly owned or controlled by another corporation, by any foreign government or by any other natural or legal person(s) severally or jointly.
As of December 31, 2006, the total number of voting securities of the Company owned by top executives and directors as a group was:
Number of Class A shares |
Number of Class B shares |
Voting rights, percent | ||||
Top executives and directors as a group (28 persons) |
6,080 | 18,149,028 | 0.07 |
For individual holdings, see Corporate Governance Report.
155
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
The Annual General Meeting of Shareholders will take place at the Annex to the Globe Arena, Globentorget, Stockholm, at 3.00 p.m. on Wednesday, April 11, 2007.
ENTITLED TO ATTEND AND NOTICE OF ATTENDANCE
Shareholders, who wish to attend the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders, must
| have been entered into the share register kept by VPC AB (the Swedish Securities Register Centre) as of Tuesday, April 3, 2007; and |
| give notice of attendance to the Company no later than at 4 p.m. (Sweden time) on Tuesday, April 3, 2007, at the Companys web site www.ericsson.com, at telephone no.: +46 8 775 01 99 weekdays between 10 a.m. and 4 p.m. or at fax no.: +46 8 775 80 18. Notice of attendance may also be given by post to: Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, Group Function Legal Affairs, Box 47021, 100 74 Stockholm, Sweden |
When giving notice of attendance, please state name, date of birth, address, telephone no. and number of assistants. The personal data that Ericsson receives with the notice of attendance will be computer processed for the purpose of the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders 2007 only.
SHARES REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF A NOMINEE
Shareholders, whose shares are registered in the name of a nominee, must request the nominee to enter temporarily the shareholder into the share register as of Tuesday, April 3, 2007 to be entitled to participate at the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders. The shareholder is requested to inform the nominee well before that day.
PROXY
Shareholders, represented by proxy, shall issue a power of attorney for the representative. To a power of attorney issued by a legal entity, a copy of the certificate of registration (or, if no such certificate exists, a corresponding document of authority) of the legal entity shall be attached. The documents must not be older than one year. In order to facilitate the registration at the Annual General Meeting, power of attorney in its original, certificates of registration and other documents of authority should be sent to the Company at the address above so as to be available by Tuesday, April 10, 2007.
DIVIDEND
The Board of Directors has decided to propose the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders to resolve on a dividend of SEK 0.50 per share for the year 2006 and Monday, April 16, 2007 as record day for dividend.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION FROM ERICSSON
| Interim reports 2007: April 26, 2007 (Q1) July 20, 2007 (Q2) October 25, 2007 (Q3) February 1, 2008 (Q4) |
| Annual Report 2007: March, 2008 |
| Form 20-F for the US market 2007: During Q2, 2008 |
156
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Annual reports and other financial reports can be downloaded or ordered on our web site: www.ericsson.com/investors or ordered via e-mail or mail.
For printed publications, contact:
Strömberg Distribution i Huddinge AB
SE-120 88 Stockholm,
Sweden
Phone: +46 8 449 89 57
E-mail: ericsson@strd.se
In the United States, Ericssons Transfer Agent Citibank:
Citibank Shareholder Services
Registered holders: +1 877 881 5969
Interested investors: +1 800 808 8010
E-mail: ericsson@shareholders-online.com
www.citibank.com/adr
Ordering a hard copy of the Annual Report:
http://www.sccorp.com/annualreport/ericsson.htm
Phone toll free: +1 866 216 0460
Contact information:
Investor Relations for Europe, Middle East, Africa and AsiaPacific:
Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson
SE-164 83 Stockholm,
Sweden
Telephone: +46 8 719 00 00
E-mail: investor.relations.se@ericsson.com
Investor Relations for the Americas:
Ericsson
The Grace Building
1114 Ave of the Americas, Suite #3410
New York, NY 10036,
USA
Telephone: +1 212 685 4030
E-mail: investor.relations@ericsson.com
157
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Ericssons compensation system is based on three principles: fairness, performance and competitiveness to attract and retain talent. However, we recognize that compensation is local and as such we expect local management to create their own systems based on these principles. Performance shall be encouraged by aligning all employee efforts to the strategic direction of the organization. Individuals and teams shall be rewarded according to their contribution to targets.
CLEAR CONTROLS
Compensation processes by the nature of their sensitivity require clear controls. In Ericsson these are based on three pillars: the Board of Directors and Remuneration Committee authorization, audit controls and our internal system that requires two levels of managers to approve any compensation decision. In addition, the Annual General Meeting approves the compensation principles for the group management and also the terms of our long-term variable compensation program. The Remuneration Committee is also supported by an independent remuneration expert to help in obtaining an independent opinion and advice on remuneration issues.
COMPENSATING FOR PERFORMANCE
The compensation package for our employees consists mainly of the following three parts:
| fixed salary (cash) |
| short-term variable salary (annual cash); |
| long-term variable compensation (Ericsson shares). |
For more details please see Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C29, Information regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management.
We have a preference where possible to encourage variable compensation because it better supports performance, enables the company to have a more flexible pay-roll cost and it supports employee alignment to clear targets. The companys success becomes team success.
SHORT-TERM VARIABLE SALARY
We have global short-term variable plans for management and for sales professionals. The Board of Directors and the Remuneration Committee decide on all Ericsson group targets, which are then cascaded to unit related targets, all subject to approval by the normal two level management approval process. The Remuneration Committee monitors appropriateness of the target levels throughout the year and has the authority to revise them. Examples of group targets for 2006 were financial performance, employee satisfaction, customer satisfaction and operational targets.
Employees not covered by global short term variable plans may be eligible for local plans. These vary in design. Sweden, for example, has a plan for all employees that can give a variable pay of up to 8 percent of fixed salary for maximum target achievement, equaling one months fixed salary.
The target payout levels vary depending on local competitive practice, but in general the following is valid for the short-term variable plans for management globally:
Percent of fixed salary |
Target achievement |
Maximum target achievement |
||||
Most management jobs |
1020 | % | 2040 | % | ||
Group Management including CEO |
3040 | % | 6080 | % |
158
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
LONG-TERM VARIABLE PLAN
As long-term variable compensation, we have a global Stock Purchase Plan for employees in 86 countries. The plan is based on the participants own investments in shares at market price and matching after three years by the Company at different levels ranging from one share for all employees to nine shares for the CEO. Matching of more than two shares is performance tested. During 2006, 17,000 employees around the world purchased 20 million Ericsson shares for future matching by the Company. Matching of shares, which occurs when vesting period ends and conditions are fulfilled/not fulfilled, under the first performance matching program, which started in 2004, will begin during 2007.
PENSIONS
Pension benefits are also set depending on local competitiveness and local practice. In addition to any national system for social security, pension benefits may contain various supplementary Company plans. Group Management including CEO have two supplementary plans: the ITP plan (for all salaried staff in Sweden) and a defined contribution plan based on premiums invested monthly in a pension fund. All costs for these pensions are accounted for annually during active service in the Company. The pensions can be paid out from the age of 60.
For further information on compensation principles, payout to the President and CEO and group management, as well as costs, see notes to the Consolidated Financial Statementsnote C29, Information regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management.
159
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE REPORT 2006
Corporate governance is a generic term describing the ways in which rights and responsibilities are distributed among the various corporate bodies according to the rules, processes or laws they are subject to. In practice, corporate governance defines the decision-making systems and structure through which owners directly or indirectly control a company.
OUR COMMITMENT TO CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
At Ericsson we are committed to high standards of corporate governance and pride ourselves on how we conduct our business.
We have policies and directives that guide all employees in how to work to meet legal and regulatory requirements and the ethical standards that we set for ourselves. The Companys reputation for integrity and good corporate citizenship stems from its core values of professionalism, respect and perseverance.
While these ideals and values are embedded in our ways of working, we know that controls and procedures are integral to maintaining our high standards and we are constantly seeking ways to make our corporate governance even more effective and reliable.
This Corporate Governance Report describes the corporate governance, direction and management of Ericsson, including information on how the Board of Directors ensures the quality of the financial reports and its interaction with Ericssons independent auditors. The auditors have not reviewed Ericssons Corporate Governance Report 2006. The report does not constitute a part of our formal annual report.
HIGH STANDARDS IN BUSINESS ETHICS
Our Code of Business Ethics sets out how we work to achieve and maintain our high standards.
160
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
This document has been translated into more than 20 languages to ensure that everyone who works for Ericsson understands our policies and directives and the importance of conducting all business activities in an ethical manner. We also arrange corporate governance training for executives so that they can reinforce the messages among Ericssons widespread work-force. All employees must regularly review the Code of Business Ethics and acknowledge that they have understood its principles. Our Code of Business Ethics satisfies the applicable requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and NASDAQ. The Code can be found at: www.ericsson.com/ericsson/corporate_responsibility/ employees/code_businessethics.shtml Information on our website does not form part of this document.
COMPLIANCE WITH REQUIREMENTS
As a Swedish public limited liability company, Ericsson is governed on the basis of its Articles of Association and the Swedish Companies Act. We also comply with the listing requirements of the Stockholm Stock Exchange, including the Swedish Code of Corporate Governance (the Code). The Code is based on the comply or explain principle, which means that a company may deviate from individual rules but is required to explain why.
In addition, we comply with the listing requirements of the other stock exchanges we are listed on, that is the London Stock Exchange and NASDAQ. We also satisfy the applicable NASDAQ corporate governance requirements, subject to a few exemptions principally reflecting mandatory Swedish legal requirements, see NASDAQ Corporate Governance Exemptions below. Moreover, we comply with the applicable requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, including the certification of our Annual Report on the SECs (Securities and Exchange Commissions) Form 20-F by the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer. The Sarbanes-Oxley Act, commonly called SOX, is a United States federal law establishing, among other things, enhanced corporate governance standards and is applicable to Ericsson as we have securities quoted on NASDAQ.
APPLICATION OF THE SWEDISH CODE OF CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
Ericsson has been applying the Code since July 2005. To ensure Ericssons compliance with the Code, our group steering documents and procedures have been evaluated and adapted to also reflect the requirements of the Code. Internal processes, such as reporting information on the corporate governance website, as well as procedures in connection with the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders, have likewise been adapted to meet the requirements of the Code.
Ericsson does not report any deviations from the Code in 2006.
CORPORATE BODIES IN CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
The governance and control of Ericsson is carried out through a number of corporate bodies.
At General Meetings of Shareholders, the shareholders exercise their voting rights with regard to, for example, the composition of the Board of Directors of Ericsson and election of external auditors.
A Nomination Committee proposes candidates to serve as Board members, the Board Chairman and external auditors.
The Board is responsible for Ericssons long-term development and strategy as well as controlling and evaluating the Companys daily operations. In addition, the Board appoints the President of Ericsson, who is also the Chief Executive Officer (CEO). The duties of the Board are partly exercised through its three Committees; the Audit, Finance and Remuneration Committees.
161
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
The President and CEO is in charge of the day-to-day management of Ericsson in accordance with guidelines and instructions provided by the Board.
Ericsson reports three operating segments, Systems, Phones and Other Operations for the year ending December 31, 2006. The President and CEO is also head of the Systems segment, and the heads of the business units and market units in Systems report directly to him. The heads of the five units in Other Operations also report to the President and CEO.
For more information on general aspects of Swedish corporate governance, please refer to a memorandum Special features of Swedish corporate governance posted on the website of the Swedish Corporate Governance Board www.corporategovernanceboard.se. Information on this website does not form part of this document.
MEETINGS WITH THE SHAREHOLDERS
In accordance with the Swedish Companies Act and Ericssons Articles of Association, shareholders who exercise their voting rights at the Annual General Meeting determine the composition of the Board of Directors and all other issues voted on at General Meetings of Shareholders.
The Annual General Meeting is held in Stockholm, generally at the end of March or beginning of April. The exact date is advertised, along with the agenda and information on how shareholders can give notice of attendance, on Ericssons website and in the Swedish newspapers Svenska Dagbladet, Dagens Nyheter and Post-och Inrikes Tidningar, as well as in the European edition of Financial Times, as a courtesy to our shareholders abroad. Shareholders who cannot participate in person may be represented by proxy (proxies are valid for a maximum of one year). To allow non-Swedish speaking shareholders to participate, the Annual General Meeting is simultaneously interpreted into English. All information material is also available in English.
Resolutions at General Meetings of Shareholders are normally passed by simple majority. However, the Swedish Companies Act requires special quorums and majorities in certain cases. At General Meetings of Shareholders each Class A share carries one vote and each Class B share one-tenth of one vote. For more information on the shares of Ericsson, please see Share Information in the Annual Report.
162
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
The Annual General Meeting offers shareholders the opportunity to raise questions regarding the Company and the results of the year under review. The members of the Board of Directors, the executive management as well as the external auditors are normally all present to answer such questions.
Shareholders and other interested parties can also correspond in writing with the Board of Directors or executive management at any time.
The Board of Directors Secretariat can be contacted by e-mail at boardsecretariat@ericsson.com, or by post: Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson The Board of Directors Secretariat SE-164 83 Stockholm, Sweden
ERICSSONS ANNUAL GENERAL MEETING 2006
1,106 shareholders, representing 57.4 percent of the votes and 30.9 percent of the capital of Ericsson, attended the Annual General Meeting held on April 10, 2006, at the Annex to the Globe Arena in Stockholm. Ericssons Board of Directors, Group management and the external auditors, were present at the meeting. Decisions of the 2006 Annual General Meeting include:
| Re-election of Michael Treschow as Chairman of the Board of Directors, re-election of Marcus Wallenberg and election of Sverker Martin-Löf as Deputy Chairmen. |
| Re-election of Sir Peter L. Bonfield, Ulf J. Johansson, Nancy McKinstry and Carl-Henric Svanberg as members of the Board of Directors and election of Börje Ekholm, Katherine Hudson and Anders Nyrén as new members of the Board of Directors. |
| Resolution to adopt the Parent Company Income Statement and Balance Sheet and the Consolidated Income Statement and Balance Sheet. |
| Discharge of liability of the members of the Board of Directors and the President for the fiscal year 2005. |
| Resolution that a dividend of SEK 0.45 per share be paid for the year 2005. |
| Resolution that the number of Board members be 10 with no deputies. |
| Resolution that Board of Directors fees be paid as follows: Chairman SEK 3,750,000; other non-employed Board members SEK 750,000 each; in addition SEK 350,000 to the Chairman of the Audit Committee and SEK 250,000 each to the other two non-employed members of the Audit Committee; and SEK 125,000 each to the Chairmen and other non-employed members of the Finance and Remuneration committees. |
| Approval of the Nomination Committees proposals for the procedure for appointing the members of the Nomination Committee and the assignment of the Nomination Committee. |
| Amendments of the Articles of Association to reflect the new Swedish Companies Act that came into effect on January 1, 2006. |
| Approval of the principles on remuneration and other employment terms for Ericssons top executives. |
| Resolution to implement a Long-Term Incentive Plan for 2006 and transfer of own shares as a part thereof. |
ERICSSONS ANNUAL GENERAL MEETING 2007
Ericssons Annual General Meeting 2007 will take place on April 11, 2007, at the Globe Arena in Stockholm. This was announced in conjunction with the release of the third quarter financial report in 2006.
163
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
NOMINATION COMMITTEE
The Nomination Committee, appointed on the basis of the procedure resolved by the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders 2006, consists of Michael Trewchow (Chairman of the Board of Directors) and of the four members appointed by the four largest shareholders by voting power as of April 28, 2006: Jacob Wallenberg (Investor AB), Carl-Olof By (AB Industrivärden, Chairman of the Nomination Committee), Caroline af Ugglas (Livförsäkringsaktiebolaget Skandia), Tomas Nicolin (Alecta Pensionsförsäkring).
THE TASKS OF THE NOMINATION COMMITTEE
The main task of the Nomination Committee is to propose candidates for election to the Board of Directors, including the Chairman and the Deputy Chairmen. The Nomination Committee must take into consideration the various rules on independence of the Board in relation to the Company, its senior management and major shareholders, in accordance with the requirements of the Code.
In years in which election of auditors are held, the Nomination Committee also proposes candidates for election of auditors, based on the preparations carried out by the Audit Committee of the Board. The Nomination Committee also proposes a candidate for election of the Chairman of General Meetings of Shareholders and prepares proposals concerning the level of remuneration for Directors elected by the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders not employed by Ericsson, the auditors and members of the Nomination Committee for resolution by the Annual General Meeting. So far, the Nomination Committee has not proposed any fee to be paid to the Nomination Committee.
Recommendations to the Nomination Committee may be submitted by e-mail to nomination.committee@ericsson.com, or by post to:
Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson
The Nomination Committee
c/o General Counsels Office
SE-164 83 Stockholm
Sweden
WORK OF THE NOMINATION COMMITTEE FOR THE ANNUAL GENERAL MEETING 2007
The Nomination Committee held five meetings and had informal contacts between meetings. The Nomination Committee has thoroughly familiarized itself with how the Board work is conducted and functions and has made assessments in terms of the competence and experience that is required by the Board. In addition to matters prepared each year by the Nomination Committee, the Nomination Committee for the Annual General Meeting 2007 has, in close cooperation with the Boards Audit Committee, prepared a proposal for the election of auditors for resolution by the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders 2007.
A report on the work of the Nomination Committee will be published on Ericssons website in connection with the notice of the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders 2007.
BOARD OF DIRECTORS
The Board of Directors is ultimately responsible for the organization of the Company and the management of the Companys operations. It develops guidelines and instructions for the day-to-day management of the Company, conducted by the President and CEO who ensures the Board of Directors receives regular reports regarding the Groups business developmentits results, financial position and liquidityand events of importance to the Group.
164
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
According to the Articles of Association, Ericssons Board of Directors shall consist of a minimum of five directors and a maximum of 12 directors, with no more than six deputies. Directors are elected by the shareholders at the Annual General Meeting for the period from the date of the Annual General Meeting until the close of the following Annual General Meeting, but can serve any number of consecutive terms. In addition, under Swedish law, unions have the right to appoint three directors and their deputies to the Ericsson Board of Directors.
Ericsson abides by strict rules and regulations regarding conflicts of interest. Directors and the President and CEO cannot participate in any decision regarding agreements between themselves and the Company, or between the Company and any third party or legal entity that the individual has an interest in.
Further, the Audit Committee has implemented a procedure for the approval of related-party transactions in accordance with NASDAQs corporate governance rules as well as a pre-approval process for non-audit services carried out by the external auditors, in order to ensure their independence.
MEMBERS OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS
Our Board of Directors consists of 10 Directors, elected by the shareholders at the Annual General Meeting for the period until the close of the next Annual General Meeting, and three employee representatives, each with a deputy, appointed by the trade unions. The Chairman of the Board is elected by the Annual General Meeting. The President and CEO of the Company may be elected as a director, but the Swedish Companies Act prohibits the President of a public company from being elected Chairman of the Board.
WORK PROCEDURE OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS
The Board of Directors has adopted a work procedure for its activities that outlines rules regarding the distribution of tasks between the Board and its Committees as well as between the Board, its Committees and the President and CEO. The work procedure is reviewed, evaluated and adopted by the Board as required, at least once a year. During 2006, the work procedure was adjusted by the Board at its meeting in December.
INDEPENDENCE OF THE DIRECTORS
In connection with its proposal to the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders 2006, the Nomination Committee elected by the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders 2005 made the assessment that, for the purposes of the Swedish Code of Corporate Governance, the following Directors are independent of the Company and its senior management, as well as of the Companys major shareholders: Sir Peter L. Bonfield, Katherine Hudson, Ulf J. Johansson, Nancy McKinstry and Michael Treschow.
WORK OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS
The Board holds at least six meetings each year. Material for each Board meeting is distributed according to a pre-established time plan by the Board of Directors Secretariat on behalf of the President and CEO. Each Board meeting generally includes reports by the Chairman of each of the three Committees based on the minutes from the Committee meetings, which were distributed to all Directors prior to the Board meeting. Further, a Board meeting typically includes the President and CEOs report on general business and market developments including the performance of the Company. At Board meetings held in conjunction with interim reports, the financial statements are discussed along with any proposed press release related to the interim report. A substantial part of the Boards ordinary work is devoted to strategy issues. Towards the end of the year, the Board performs an evaluation of the Board work, which serves as a guide for the work of the Nomination Committee. The Board is regularly informed of recent developments of legal and regulatory matters and addresses, whenever necessary, the adoption of and implementation of various corporate governance rules.
165
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
The Directors generally participate in all Board meetings and, to the extent possible, also attend General Meetings of Shareholders.
The Board is also responsible for financial oversight and meets regularly with Ericssons external auditors to receive and consider the auditors observations regarding the annual report, interim reports and internal controls. The auditors attend the regularly scheduled Audit Committee meetings and meet with the entire Board at least twice a year. At least one meeting with the auditors takes place without the presence of the President and CEO or other members of the management team.
To assist Directors in their work for Ericsson, training sessions are held each year to enhance the Directors knowledge of Group operations. Training is also provided to new Directors and to cover specific issues as needed.
WORK OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS IN 2006
In 2006, ten Board meetings were held. The Directors attendance at Board and Committee meetings during 2006 is reflected in the table Directors Attendance and Board of Directors Fees. Apart from general Board matters referred to above, matters addressed by the Board during 2006 include:
| integration of the operations acquired from Marconi; |
| acquisition of the Swedish company Netwise AB; |
| divestment of the defense operations, Ericsson Microwave Systems AB to Saab AB; |
| a new organization as from January 1, 2007, under three business units; |
| long-term and short-term strategy with regard to the operator consolidation driven by convergence and development and the changes in the competitive landscape, and |
| acquisition of the US company Redback Networks Inc. |
166
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Training sessions for the Board of Directors in 2006 included Research and Development, Human Resources and Corporate Responsibility.
BOARD WORK EVALUATION
The Chairman of the Board initiates and leads a thorough evaluation of Board work and the Board procedures each year. The evaluation process includes written questionnaires, as well as interviews and discussions. During 2006, the Chairman held individual discussions with each Director and each Director answered three separate written questionnaires, i.e. one covering the Board work in general, one covering the Chairmans performance, and one covering the President and CEOs performance. The Chairman and the President and CEO are neither involved in the development, compilation or evaluation of the questionnaires related to their respective performances, nor present when their respective performance is evaluated.
COMMITTEES OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS
The Board of Directors has established three Committees: the Audit, Finance and Remuneration Committees. The Board appoints each of the Committee members amongst the Board members. The work of the Committees is principally preparatory, that is they prepare matters for final resolution by the Board. However, the Board has authorized each Committee to determine certain issues in limited areas and may also provide extended authorization to a Committee to determine specific matters. The Board of Directors and each Committee have the right to engage external expertise, either in general or in respect to specific matters, if deemed appropriate.
Prior to each Board meeting, each Committee submits a report to the Board on the issues handled, resolved or referred to the Board since the previous ordinary Board meeting. The minutes of each Committee meeting are attached to the minutes of the Board meeting following each Committee meeting.
167
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
DIRECTORS ATTENDANCE AND BOARD OF DIRECTORS FEES 2006
Board Committee | Board and committee fee | |||||||||
Board Meetings |
Audit | Finance | Remuneration | |||||||
Michael Treschow |
10 | | 11 | 8 | 4,000,000 | |||||
Sverker Martin-Löf |
10 | 9 | | | 1,100,000 | |||||
Marcus Wallenberg |
10 | | 11 | | 875,000 | |||||
Peter L. Bonfield |
10 | 9 | | | 1,000,000 | |||||
Börje Ekholm1) |
8 | | | 4 | 875,000 | |||||
Katherine Hudson1) |
7 | | | | 750,000 | |||||
Ulf J. Johansson2) |
9 | 6 | | 4 | 1,000,000 | |||||
Nancy McKinstry |
10 | | | 8 | 875,000 | |||||
Anders Nyrén1) |
8 | | 7 | | 875,000 | |||||
Carl-Henric Svanberg |
10 | | | | | |||||
Arne Mårtensson3) |
3 | | 4 | | | |||||
Eckhard Pfeiffer3) |
3 | 2 | | | | |||||
Monica Bergström4) |
10 | | | 4 | 10,400 | |||||
Jan Hedlund |
10 | 9 | | | 10,900 | |||||
Torbjörn Nyman |
10 | | 11 | | 11,100 | |||||
Anna Guldstrand |
10 | | | | 10,000 | |||||
Per Lindh5) |
9 | | | 4 | 9,400 | |||||
Arne Löfving 6) |
6 | | | | 6,000 | |||||
Kristina Davidsson7) |
4 | | | | 4,000 | |||||
Total |
10 | 9 | 11 | 8 | 11,411,800 | |||||
1) | Appointed as Member of the Board of Directors as of April 10, 2006. |
2) | Resigned from the Remuneration Committee and joined the Audit Committee as of April 10, 2006. |
3) | Resigned from the Board of Directors as of April 10, 2006. |
4) | Joined the Remuneration Committee as of April 10, 2006. |
5) | Resigned from the Remuneration Committee as of April 10, 2006. |
6) | Resigned from the Board of Directors as of 31 July, 2006. |
7) | Joined the Board of Directors as of August 1, 2006. |
The Audit Committee
The Audit Committee, on behalf of the Board, monitors the integrity of the financial statements, compliance with legal and regulatory requirements and the effectiveness of our systems of internal control over financial reporting.
The Audit Committee is primarily responsible for reviewing annual and interim financial reports, overseeing the external audit process, including audit fees and the internal audit function, and resolving matters arising during the course of reviews and audits. This involves:
| reviewing, with management and the external auditors, the audited financial statements including conformity with generally accepted accounting principles; |
| reviewing, with management, the reasonableness of significant estimates and judgments made in preparing the financial statements, as well as the quality of the disclosures in the financial statements; |
| reviewing matters arising from reviews and audits performed. |
168
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
The Audit Committee is also involved in the preparatory work of proposing candidates for the election of auditors, when applicable, and monitors their ongoing independence and performance, as well as monitoring Group transactions to avoid conflicts of interest. To achieve this, the Audit Committee has implemented approval procedures for audit and other services performed by the external auditors (see Audit Committee Pre-approval Policies and Procedures.); a pre-approval process for transactions with related parties; and a whistle-blower procedure for the reporting of violations in relation to accounting, internal controls and auditing matters. The procedure for the reporting of these violations has been adjusted in 2006 to meet EU recommendations and French legal requirements in relation to whistle-blower procedures. These recommendations and requirements aim to limit misuse of the procedure and to secure handling of personal data in relation to reports made under such procedure.
Alleged violations are investigated by Ericssons internal audit function in conjunction with the relevant Group Function. Information regarding any incidents, including measures taken, details of the responsible Group Function and the status of any investigation are reported to the Audit Committee.
The Audit Committee itself does not perform audit work. Ericsson has an internal audit function, which reports to the Audit Committee and performs independent audits.
Members of the Audit Committee
The Audit Committee consists of four members appointed by the Board from among its members. In 2006, the Audit Committee comprised Sverker Martin-Löf (Chairman of the Committee), Sir Peter L. Bonfield, Ulf J. Johansson (succeeding Eckhard Pfeiffer from April, 2006) and Jan Hedlund. All members, except the employee representative, are independent from the Company and senior management. Each member is financially literate and familiar with the accounting practices of an international company comparable to Ericsson. At least one member must be an audit committee financial expert. The Board of Directors has determined that Sverker Martin-Löf, Sir Peter L. Bonfield and Ulf Johansson satisfy these requirements.
The Audit Committee has appointed an external expert advisor, Mr. Peter Markborn, to assist and advise the Committee.
Work of the Audit Committee
The Audit Committee held nine meetings during 2006attendance is reflected in the table Directors Attendance and Board of Directors Fees 2006. The work of the Audit Committee during the year included: review of financial reports, the scope and execution of audits performed, the independence of the external auditors, the internal audit function and audit fees. Further, the Audit Committee has, together with the external auditors, reviewed each interim report prior to publishing. Part of the Committees work during the year has been to continuously monitor the progress of the Companys implementation of the rules and regulations of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. In addition, certain services other than audits performed by the external auditors have been approved by the Audit Committee under the pre-approval policies and procedures. Further, the Audit Committee has approved certain related-party transactions in accordance with the pre-approval process implemented by the Committee.
The Finance Committee
The Finance Committee is primarily responsible for:
| handling matters regarding acquisitions and divestments; |
| capital contributions to companies inside and outside the Ericsson Group; |
169
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
| raising of loans, issuances of guarantees and similar undertakings and approvals of financing support to customers; and |
| continually monitoring the Groups financial risk exposure. |
The Finance Committee is authorized to determine matters such as direct or indirect financing, provision of credits, granting securities and guarantees and certain investments, divestments and financial commitments, or can delegate this power.
Members of the Finance Committee
The Finance Committee consists of four members appointed by the Board from among its members. In 2006, the Finance Committee comprised Marcus Wallenberg (Chairman of the Committee), Anders Nyrén, Torbjörn Nyman and Michael Treschow.
Work of the Finance Committee
The Finance Committee held eleven meetings during 2006attendance is reflected in the table Directors Attendance and Board of Directors Fees 2006. The work included: resolutions on matters such as customer financing and credit facility arrangements, and on certain acquisitions and divestments. The Finance Committee also monitored the financial risk exposure and risk limits and was informed on a large amount of finance-related matters such as the status of ongoing acquisitions, in particular the integration of the operations acquired from Marconi.
The Remuneration Committee
The Remuneration Committees main responsibility is to advise the Board of Directors regarding salary and other remuneration, including retirement compensation of the President and CEO, Executive Vice Presidents and other officers reporting directly to the President and CEO. Other responsibilities include:
| developing and monitoring strategies and general guidelines for employee compensation, including variable plans and retirement compensation; |
| approving variable pay under the previous years plan (beginning of each year); |
| preparation of the long-term variable plan for referral to the Board and subsequent resolution by the General Meeting of Shareholders, and |
| Preparation of the targets for variable pay for the following year for resolution by the Board. |
To achieve this, the Committee holds annual strategic compensation reviews with representatives of the Company to determine the direction to follow, allowing program designs and pay policies to be aligned with the business situation. Consideration is given to trends in compensation, legislative changes, disclosure rules and the general global environment surrounding executive pay. The Committee reviews salary survey data to approve any base pay increase for executives, effective from the following January.
Members of the Remuneration Committee
The Remuneration Committee consists of four members appointed by the Board from among its members. In 2006 the Remuneration Committee comprised Michael Treschow (Chairman of the Committee), Nancy McKinstry, Monica Bergström (succeeding Per Lindh as from April 2006) and Börje Ekholm (succeeding Ulf J. Johansson as from April 2006).
170
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
The Remuneration Committee has appointed an independent expert advisor, Mr. Gerrit Aronson, to assist and advise the Committee.
Work of the Remuneration Committee
The Remuneration Committee held eight meetings during 2006attendance is reflected in the table Directors Attendance and Board of Directors Fees 2006. The Committee reviewed and prepared for the Board a proposal for a long-term variable compensation plan, which was resolved by the 2006 Annual General Meeting of Shareholders, and started to prepare a long-term variable compensation plan to be presented to the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders 2007. Further, the Committee proposed to the Board a structure for variable pay for the Group Management Team and the Extended Management Team. The Committee also prepared proposals for salaries and variable pay for 2006, including compensation of the President and CEO and of officers reporting directly to him. For further information on compensation, fixed and variable pay, please see Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C29, Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management in the Annual Report.
MEMBERS OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS
BOARD MEMBERS ELECTED BY THE ANNUAL GENERAL MEETING OF SHAREHOLDERS
Michael Treschow (first elected 2002)
Chairman of the Board of Directors
Chairman of the Remuneration Committee
Member of the Finance Committee
Born 1943, Master of Engineering, Lund Institute of Technology. Board Chairman: AB Electrolux and the Confederation of Swedish Enterprise. Board member: ABB Ltd. and B-business partners. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 770,000 Class B shares
Principal work experience and other information: President and CEO of AB Electrolux 19972002. Earlier positions mainly include positions within Atlas Copco, where he served as President and CEO 19911997. Member of the Royal Academy of Engineering Sciences.
Marcus Wallenberg (first elected 1996)
Deputy Chairman of the Board of Directors
Chairman of the Finance Committee
Born 1956, Bachelor of Science of Foreign Service, Georgetown University, USA. Board Chairman: Skandinaviska Enskilda Banken, Saab AB, and International Chamber of Commerce (ICC). Board member: AstraZeneca plc, AB Electrolux, Stora Enso Oy, the Knut and Alice Wallenberg Foundation and Thisbe AB. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 710,000 Class B shares
Principal work experience and other information: Positions within Investor AB, where he served as President and CEO 19992005. Prior to this he was Executive Vice President at Investor. Previous employers include Stora Feldmühle AG, Citicorp, Citibank and Deutsche Bank.
1) | The number of Class B shares (and Class A shares and options, if applicable) includes holdings by related natural or legal persons. |
171
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Sverker Martin-Löf (first elected 1993)
Deputy Chairman of the Board of Directors
Chairman of the Audit Committee
Born 1943, Doctor of Technology and Master of Engineering, Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm. Board Chairman: Skanska, Svenska Cellulosa Aktiebolaget SCA and SSAB. Deputy Chairman: Industrivärden. Board member: Confederation of Swedish Enterprise and Svenska Handelsbanken. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 52,000 Class B shares
Principal work experience and other information: President and CEO of Svenska Cellulosa Aktiebolaget SCA 19902002, where he was employed 19771983 and 19862002. Previous positions at Sunds Defibrator and Mo och Domsjö AB.
Sir Peter L. Bonfield (first elected 2002)
Member of the Audit Committee
Born 1944, Honors degree in Engineering, Loughborough University, Leicestershire, UK. Board Chairman: Supervisory BoardNXP. Deputy Chairman: British Quality Foundation. Board member:
AstraZeneca plc, Mentor Graphics Inc., Sony Corporation, and TSMC. Holdings in Ericsson: None
Principal work experience and other information: CEO and Chairman of the Executive Committee of British Telecommunications plc (19962002). Chairman and CEO of ICL plc (19901996). Positions with STC plc and Texas Instruments Inc. Member of the International Advisory Group of Citigroup and of the International Advisory Panel of the University of London. Non-executive Director of Actis Capital LLP, and HMG Department for Constitutional Affairs. Trustee of Cutty Sark Trust.
Börje Ekholm (elected 2006)
Member of the Remuneration Committee
Born 1963, Master of Science in Electrical Engineering, Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm. Master of Business Administration, Insead, France. Board member: AB Chalmersinvest, Greenway Medical Techn. Inc. and Husqvarna AB. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 58,803 Class B shares
Principal work experience and other information: President and CEO of Investor AB since 2005. Prior to this, Börje Ekholm was head of Investor Growth Capital Inc and New Investments. Previous positions at Novare Kapital AB and McKinsey & Co Inc.
Katherine M. Hudson (elected 2006)
Born 1947, Bachelor of Science in Management, Indiana University, USA. Board member (and Lead Director): Charming Shoppes Inc. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 52,000 Class B shares
Principal work experience and other information: President and CEO of Brady Corporation 19942003. Management positions with Eastman Kodak Company, where she was employed for 24 years.
1) | The number of Class B shares (and Class A shares and options, if applicable) includes holdings by related natural or legal persons. |
172
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
1) | The number of Class B shares (and Class A shares and options, if applicable) includes holdings by related natural or legal persons. |
Ulf J. Johansson (first elected 2005)
Member of the Audit Committee
Born 1945, Doctor of Technology and Master of Science in Electrical Engineering, Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm. Board Chairman: Acando AB, Eurostep Group AB, Novo A/S, and Novo Nordisk Foundation. Board member: Trimble Navigation Ltd. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 32,176 Class B shares
Principal work experience and other information: Founder of Europolitan Vodafone AB, where he was the Chairman of the Board 19902005. Previous positions at Spectra-Physics AB, where he was the President and CEO, Ericsson Radio Systems AB. Member of the Royal Academy of Engineering Sciences.
Nancy McKinstry (first elected 2004)
Member of the Remuneration Committee
Born 1959, Master of Business Administration in Finance and Marketing, Columbia University, USA. Bachelor of Arts in Economics, University of Rhode Island, USA. Board Chairman: CEO and Chairman of the Executive Board of Wolters Kluwer n.v. Board member: The American Chamber of Commerce, the Netherlands, and Tias Nimbas Business School. Holdings in Ericsson: None
Principal work experience and other information: CEO and Chairman of the Executive Board of Wolters Kluwer n.v. President and CEO of CCH Legal Information Services (19961999). Previous positions at Booz, Allen & Hamilton, and New England Telephone Company. Member of the Advisory Council of ABN AMRO Holding n.v. and the Advisory Board of the University of Rhode Island.
Anders Nyrén (elected 2006)
Member of the Finance Committee
Born 1954, Graduate from Stockholm School of Economics, Master of Business Administration from Anderson School of Management, UCLA, USA. Board Chairman: Association of Exchange Listed Companies and Association for Generally Accepted Principles in the Securities Market. Deputy Chairman: Sandvik AB, Svenska Han-delsbanken. Board member: Svenska Cellulosa Aktiebolaget SCA AB, Industrivärden, Skanska, SSAB, and Ernströmsgruppen. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 33,428 Class B shares
Principal work experience and other information: President and CEO of Industrivärden since 2001. CFO and EVP of Skanska AB 19972001. Nordbanken 19961997. CFO and EVP of Securum AB 19921996. Managing Director of OM International AB 19871992. Earlier positions at STC Scandinavian Trading Co AB and AB Wilhelm Becker.
Carl-Henric Svanberg (first elected 2003)
Born 1952, Master of Science, Linköping Institute of Technology. Bachelor of Science in Business Administration, University of Uppsala. Board Chairman: Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications AB. Deputy Chairman: Assa Abloy AB. Board member: The Confederation of Swedish Enterprise and Hexagon. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 15,683,577 Class B shares
Principal work experience and other information: President and CEO of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson since 2003. Prior to this, Carl-Henric Svanberg was the President and CEO of Assa Abloy AB (1994
173
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
2003). Various positions within Securitas AB (19861994) and ABB Group (19771985). Carl-Henric Svanberg does not have material shareholdings or part ownerships in companies with which the Company has material business relationships.
BOARD MEMBERS AND DEPUTIES APPOINTED BY THE UNIONS:
Jan Hedlund (first appointed 1994)
Employee representative.
Member of the Audit Committee
Born 1946. Appointed by the union IF Metall. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 1,603 Class B shares
Monica Bergström (first appointed 1998)
Employee representative.
Member of the Remuneration Committee
Born 1961. Appointed by the union SIF. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 3,694 Class B shares
Torbjörn Nyman (first appointed 2004)
Employee representative.
Member of the Finance Committee
Born 1961. Appointed by the union The Swedish Association of Graduate Engineers. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 10,440 Class B shares
Per Lindh (first appointed 1994)
Deputy employee representative.
Born 1957. Appointed by the union SIF. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 203 Class B shares
Anna Guldstrand (first appointed 2004)
Deputy employee representative.
Born 1964. Appointed by the union The Swedish Association of Graduate Engineers. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 4,146 Class B shares, 900 options.
Kristina Davidsson (appointed 2006)
Deputy employee representative.
Born 1955. Appointed by the union IF Metall. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 1,026 Class B shares
Carl-Henric Svanberg is the only Director who holds an operational management position at Ericsson. No Director has been elected pursuant to an arrangement or understanding with any major shareholder, customer, supplier or other person.
1) | The number of Class B shares (and Class A shares and options, if applicable) includes holdings by related natural or legal persons. |
174
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
COMPANY MANAGEMENT
THE PRESIDENT AND CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICEROPERATIONAL MANAGEMENT
The Board of Directors appoints the President and CEO and the Executive Vice Presidents. Management of day-to-day operations is the responsibility of the President and CEO and the Group Management Team which, in addition to the President and CEO, consist of the Chief Financial Officer, the Chief Technology Officer, the heads of Group Functions and the heads of Business Units Access, Systems, Global Services and Business Unit Broadband Networks.
GROUP FUNCTIONS
Ericssons Group Functions perform tasks pertaining to group-wide matters that logically do not fall into a specific operational unit: Communications, Finance, Human Resources & Organization, Legal Affairs, Operational Excellence, Research & Development, Sales & Marketing, and Strategy & Product Management.
The Group Functions formulate Group strategy, issue policies and directives, perform business control, resource allocation and risk management. They are also responsible for consolidation and reporting of financial performance, financing and cash management, legal issues, communication with various stakeholders including employees, investors, press and media as well as coordination and administration of a number of Group-wide issues. Other important Group-wide matters, such as Corporate Responsibility, are managed by Group Functions in conjunction with a network of experts from various parts of the Company.
OPERATIONAL UNITS
Our operations are carried out in three business segments; Systems, Phones and Other Operations. Systems, our largest segment, is organized into business units responsible for the provision of products and services, and market units, responsible for marketing, sales and customer support. For more information regarding our business segments and information on the new organisation effective as from January 1, 2007, please see the Board of Directors Report and Information on the Company in the Annual Report. Management of each operating unit has significant authority and responsibility in relation to day-to-day operations, while governance is carried out by steering committees that include representatives of the Group Management Team, the Extended Management Team and the units own management.
MEMBERS OF THE GROUP MANAGEMENT TEAM
Carl-Henric Svanberg
President and CEO and member of the Board of Directors (since 2003)
Born 1952, Master of Science, Linköping Institute of Technology, Bachelor of Science in Business Administration, University of Uppsala. Chairman: Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications AB. Deputy Chairman: Assa Abloy AB. Board member: The Confederation of Swedish Enterprise and Hexagon. Holdings in Ericsson1): 15,683,577 Class B shares
Background: President and CEO of Assa Abloy AB (19942003). Various positions within Securitas AB (19861994) and ABB Group (19771985).
1) | The number of Class B shares (and Class A shares, if applicable) includes holdings by related natural or legal persons. Options and matching rights are reported in Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements Note C29, Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management in the Annual Report. |
175
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Karl-Henrik Sundström
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer and head of Group Function Finance (since 2003)
Born 1960, Bachelor in Finance, University of Uppsala, Advanced Management Program, Harvard Business School, USA. Board member: Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications AB. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 34,230 Class B shares
Background: Prior to assuming his position, Karl-Henrik Sundström was head of Business Unit Global Services.
Kurt Jofs
Executive Vice President and head of Business Unit Access (since 2004)
Born 1958, Master of Science, Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm. Board Chairman: Peoples Travel Group. Board member: Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications AB. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 229,522 Class B shares
Background: President and CEO of Linjebuss and ABB Ventilation Products.
Bert Nordberg
Executive Vice President and head of Group Function Sales & Marketing (since 2004)
Born 1956, Bachelor in Electronic Engineering, Malmö, Engineer in the Marines, Berga, university courses in International Management, Marketing and Finance, Insead University, France. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 43,817 Class B shares
Background: Prior to assuming this position, Bert Nordberg was head of Business Unit Systems and held other various positions within Ericsson.
Björn Olsson
Executive Vice President and head of Business Unit Systems (since 2004)
Born 1956, Master of Science in Industrial Engineering and Management, Linköping Institute of Technology. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 40,176 Class B shares
Background: Prior to assuming this position, Björn Olsson was Chief Information Officer. He has held various positions within Ericsson since 1981.
Hans Vestberg
Executive Vice President and head of Business Unit Global Services (since 2003, appointed Executive Vice President in 2005)
Born 1965, Bachelor in Business Administration, University of Uppsala. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 27,364 Class B shares
Background: Previous to his current position, Hans Vestberg was Vice President and head of Market Unit Mexico (20022003). Hans Vestberg has held various positions in the Company since 1988.
1) | The number of Class B shares (and Class A shares, if applicable) includes holdings by related natural or legal persons. Options and matching rights are reported in Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements Note C29, Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management in the Annual Report. |
176
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Marita Hellberg
Senior Vice President and head of Group Function Human Resources & Organization (since 2003)
Born 1955, Bachelor in Social Studies, Stockholm University, Advanced Management Program, Cedep, France. Board member: Utbildningsradion, and Teknikföretagen. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 47,091 Class B shares
Background: Prior to assuming this position Marita Hellberg was Senior Vice President of Human Resources of NCC Group.
Torbjörn Nilsson
Senior Vice President (since 1998) and head of Group Function Strategy & Product Management (since 2003)
Born 1953, Master of Science, Lunds University, Master of Business Administration, Stockholm University. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 69 541 Class B shares
Background: Prior to his position above, Torbjörn Nilsson was head of Group Function Marketing & Strategic Business Development. Torbjörn Nilsson has held various management positions within the Company since 1978.
Carl Olof Blomqvist
Senior Vice President, General Counsel and head of Group Function Legal Affairs (since 1999)
Born 1951, Master of Law, LLM, University of Uppsala, Sweden. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 6,080 Class A shares and 46,491 Class B shares
Background: Prior to assuming this position, Carl Olof Blomqvist was a partner of Mannheimer Swartling law firm.
Henry Sténson
Senior Vice President and head of Group Function Communications (since 2002)
Born 1955, Studied law, sociology and political science, Linköping University and at the Swedish War Academy, Karlberg, Stockholm. Board member: Studsvik and the Stockholm Chamber of Commerce. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 42,574 Class B shares
Background: Prior to assuming his position above, Henry Sténson was head of SAS Group Communication, SAS AB.
Håkan Eriksson
Senior Vice President, Chief Technology Officer and head of Group Function Research & Development (since 2004)
Born 1961, Master of Science and Honorary Ph D, Linköping Institute of Technology. Deputy Chairman: Section XI, Research and Education, Swedish Royal Engineering Academy. Board member: Linköping University, Anoto. Holdings in Ericsson 1): 22,980 Class B shares
Background: Prior to assuming this position, Håkan Eriksson was Senior Vice President and head of Research & Development. He has held various positions within Ericsson since 1986.
1) | The number of Class B shares (and Class A shares, if applicable) includes holdings by related natural or legal persons. Options and matching rights are reported in Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements Note C29, Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management in the Annual Report. |
177
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Joakim Westh
Senior Vice President and head of Group Function Operational Excellence (since 2004)
Born 1961, Master of Science, Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm, Master of Science within Aeronautics & Astronautics, MIT, Boston, USA. Board chairman: Absolent AB. Board member: VKR Holding A/S. Holdings in Ericsson1): 124,886 Class B shares
Background: Member of Assa Abloy Executive Management Team. Before this, Joakim Westh was a partner with McKinsey & Co. Inc.
Sivert Bergman
Senior Vice President and head of Business Unit Broadband Networks (since 2006)
Born 1946, Senior high school degree of Electric Engineering, Trollhättan, complemented with studies in mathematics. Holdings in Ericsson1): 7,260 Class B shares
Background: Prior to assuming this position, Sivert Bergman was head of Business Unit Transmission and Transport Networks. Sivert Bergman has held various management positions in the Company since 1979.
EXTENDED MANAGEMENT TEAM
The Extended Management Team consists of the officers of the Group Management Team and:
| Cesare Avenía, Vice President and head of Market Unit South East Europe. |
| Rory Buckley, Vice President and head of Market Unit North East Asia; |
| Ragnar Bäck, Chairman of the Market Units within the Central and Eastern Europe, Middle East & Africa (CEMA) regions; |
| Jan Campbell, Vice President and head of Market Unit Central Europe; |
| Mats Granryd, Vice President and head of Market Unit India & Sri Lanka; |
| Jef Keustermans, Vice President and head of Market Unit Northern Europe; |
| Ingemar Naeve, Vice President and head of Market Unit Iberia and Global Customer Account executive Telefónica; |
| Mats Olsson, Vice President and head of Market Unit Greater China; |
| Torbjörn Possne, Vice President and Global Customer Account executive Deutsche Telekom; |
| Angel Ruiz, Vice President and head of Market Unit North America; |
| Jan Signell, Vice President and head of Market Unit South East Asia; and |
| Gerhard Weise, Vice President and head of Market Unit Mexico. |
During 2006, the officers below were also members of the Extended Management Team of the Company:
| Sandeep Chennakeshu: former President Ericsson Mobile Platforms AB. Sandeep Chennakeshu left the Company on April 29, 2006. |
| Kinson Loo: former Vice President and Global Customer Account executive for Hutchison. Kinson Loo left the Company on June 30, 2006. |
| Anders Olin: former Vice President and Global Customer Account executive Vodafone. Anders Olin was appointed head of Sales & Marketing, Western Europe, within Group Function Sales & Marketing on October 1, 2006. |
178
1) | The number of Class B shares (and Class A shares, if applicable) includes holdings by related natural or legal persons. Options and matching rights are reported in Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements Note C29, Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management in the Annual Report. |
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Extended Management Team members are not involved in any business activities that compete with or in any other way negatively affect Ericssons business. None of the Extended Management Team members have been appointed by arrangement or understanding with shareholders, customers, suppliers or other parties.
COMPENSATION TO TOP EXECUTIVES
Principles for remuneration and other employment terms for Ericssons top executives were approved by the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders 2006. For further information on compensation, fixed and variable pay, see Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C29, Information Regarding Employees, Members of the Board of Directors and Management in the Annual Report.
AUDITORS
Ericssons external, independent auditors are elected by the shareholders at the Annual General Meeting for a period of four years. The auditors report to the shareholders at Shareholders Meetings.
The auditors;
| update the Board of Directors regarding the planning, scope and content of the annual audit; |
| examine the year-end financial statements and report findings to assess accuracy and completeness of the accounts and adherence to accounting procedures and principles; |
| advise the Board of Directors of additional services performed (non-auditing), the consideration paid and other issues that are needed to determine the auditors independence. For further information on the contacts between the Board and the auditors, please see Work of the Board of Directors above. |
All Ericsson quarterly reports are reviewed by our auditors.
STATUTORY AUDITORS
Peter Clemedtson
Authorized Public Accountant, PricewaterhouseCoopers.
Elected 2004 (as successor for the remaining mandate period of Carl-Eric Bohlin) until 2007.
Audit services performed in other large companies such as: Electrolux, KMT, Medivir, OMX, SEB.
Bo Hjalmarsson
Authorized Public Accountant, PricewaterhouseCoopers.
Elected 2003 until 2007.
Audit services performed in other large companies such as OMX, Sony Ericsson, Lundin Petroleum, Vostok Nafta.
Thomas Thiel
Authorized Public Accountant, KPMG.
Elected 2003 until 2007.
Audit services performed in other large companies such as Atlas Copco, Folksam, Handelsbanken, Holmen, Peab, Ratos, SKF, Swedish Match, Kungsleden.
179
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
DEPUTY AUDITORS
Jeanette Skoglund
Authorized Public Accountant, PricewaterhouseCoopers.
Elected 2003 until 2007.
Audit services performed in several large subsidiaries of global companies such as TDC Song.
Robert Barnden
Authorized Public Accountant, PricewaterhouseCoopers.
Elected 2004 (as successor for the remaining mandate period of Peter Clemedtson) until 2007.
Audit services performed in other large companies such as: AcandoFrontec, Nobia, SCA, Seco Tools, VSM Group.
Stefan Holmström
Authorized Public Accountant, KPMG.
Elected 2003 until 2007.
Audit services performed in other large companies such as: Länsförsäkringar, Posten, Swedish Meats, V&S Vin & Sprit.
FEES PAID TO EXTERNAL AUDITORS
Ericsson paid the fees (including expenses) listed in the table in Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C31, Fees to auditors in the Annual Report for audit-related and other services.
The Audit Committee reviews and pre-approves any non-audit services to be performed by the external auditors to ensure the auditors independence. Services other than audit services provided by the auditors from 2004 to 2006 are described in Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C31, Fees to auditors in the Annual Report.
AUDIT COMMITTEE PRE-APPROVAL POLICIES AND PROCEDURES
The Audit Committee makes recommendations to the Board of Directors regarding the auditors performance and fees. It reviews the scope and execution of audits performed (external and internal) and analyzes the result and the cost.
The Audit Committee has established pre-approval policies and procedures for services other than audits performed by the external auditors. Such services fall into two broad headings:
General Pre-Approval services that can be pre-approved by the Audit Committee without consideration to specific case-by-case service. Tax, transaction, risk management, corporate finance, attestation and accounting services and general services have received a general pre-approval of the Audit Committee, provided that the estimated fee level for the project does not exceed SEK 1 million. The external auditors must advise the Audit Committee of services rendered under the general pre-approval policy.
Specific Pre-Approvalall other audit-related, tax and other services must receive specific pre-approval. The Audit Committee Chairman has the delegated authority for specific pre-approval, providing service fees do not exceed SEK 2.5 million. The Chairman reports any pre-approval decisions to the Audit Committee at its
180
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
scheduled meetings. For other matters, an auditor submits an application to the CFO. If supported by the CFO, the application is presented to the Audit Committee for final approval.
Pre-approval authority may not be delegated to management. The policies and procedures include a list of prohibited services.
DISCLOSURE CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
Ericsson has controls and procedures in place to make sure that information to be disclosed under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, and under Ericssons agreements with the Stockholm and London stock exchanges and NASDAQ is done so on time, and that such information is provided to management, including the CEO and CFO, so that timely decisions can be made regarding required disclosure.
To assist managers in fulfilling their responsibility with regard to disclosures made by the Company to its security holders and the investment community, a Disclosure Committee was established in 2003. One of the main tasks of the Disclosure Committee is to monitor the integrity and effectiveness of the Companys disclosure controls and procedures.
Further, Ericsson has investments in certain entities that Ericsson does not control or manage. Accordingly, our disclosure controls and procedures with respect to such entities are necessarily substantially more limited than those we maintain with respect to our subsidiaries.
During the year, management, with the participation of Ericssons President and CEO and CFO, supervised and participated in an evaluation of the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures. As a result, Ericssons President and CEO and CFO concluded that the disclosure controls and procedures were effective at a reasonable assurance level.
There were no changes to our internal control over financial reporting during the period covered by the Annual Report 2006 that have materially affected, or are likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.
ERICSSONS DISCLOSURE POLICIES
Ericssons financial disclosure policies are designed to give transparent, informative and consistent communication with the investment community on a fair and equal basis, which will reflect in a fair market value for Ericsson shares. We want our shareholders and potential investors to have a good understanding of how our Company works, our operational performance, what our prospects are and the risks we face that these opportunities may not be realized.
To continue to achieve these goals, our financial reporting and disclosure must be:
| Transparentour disclosure should enhance understanding of the economic drivers and operational performance of our business, hence building trust and credibility. |
| Consistentwe aim for consistent and comparable disclosure within and between reporting periods. |
| Simpleinformation should be provided in as simple a manner as possible, so readers gain the appropriate level of understanding of our business operations and performance. |
| Relevantwe focus our disclosure on what is relevant to Ericssons stakeholders or required by regulation or listing agreements, to avoid information overload. |
| Timelywe utilize well-established disclosure controls and procedures to ensure that all disclosures are complete, accurate and performed on a timely basis. |
181
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
| Fair and equalwe publish all material information via press releases to ensure everyone receives the information at the same time. |
| A reflection of best practicewe strive to ensure that our disclosure is in line with industry norms and, if possible, lead the way to improved best-in-class standards. |
Our website (www.ericsson.com/investors) includes comprehensive information on Ericsson, including an archive of our annual and interim reports, on-demand-access to recent news and copies of presentations given by senior management at industry conferences. Information on our website does not form part of this document.
INDEPENDENCE REQUIREMENTS ON THE BOARD
The Ericsson Board of Directors is subject to, and complies with, a variety of independence requirements. However, it has sought and received exemptions from those NASDAQ requirements that are contrary to Swedish Law, see NASDAQ Corporate Governance Exemptions below.
Stockholm Stock Exchange listing requirements
| Only one person from senior management may be a member of the board (applies also to senior management in the companys subsidiaries). |
| The majority of the directors elected by the shareholders meetings (employee representatives not included) must be independent of the company and its management. An overall assessment should be made in each case in order to consider whether a director is independent or not. |
| At least two of the directors who are independent of the company and its management must also be independent of the companys major shareholders. One of these directors must be experienced in requirements placed on a listed company. |
The Swedish Code of Corporate Governance
Independence requirements on the board of directors (excluding employee representatives):
| Only one person from the senior management may be a member of the board. |
| A majority of the directors elected by the shareholders meetings must be independent of the company and its management. |
| At least two of the directors who are independent of the company and its management must also be independent of the companys major shareholders. |
Independence requirements on the Audit Committee:
| The majority of Audit Committee members must be independent of the company and senior management. |
| At least one member of the committee must be independent of the companys major shareholders. |
| A board member who is part of senior management may not be a member of the audit committee. |
Independence requirements on the remuneration committee:
| Committee members must be independent of the company and the senior management. |
The NASDAQ Marketplace Rules
Independence requirements on the board of directors:
| A majority of the members of the board of directors must be independent within the meaning of the NASDAQ rules. |
182
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Ericsson has obtained an exemption from NASDAQ allowing employee representative directors to be exempt from NASDAQs independence requirements.
Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and corresponding NASDAQ rules
Independence requirements on the audit committee:
| All members of the audit committee must be independent within the meaning of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. |
The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 includes a specific exemption for non-executive employee representatives.
NASDAQ Corporate Governance Exemptions
Pursuant to a 2005 amendment to NASDAQs Marketplace Rules, foreign private issuers such as Ericsson may follow home- country practice in lieu of certain NASDAQ corporate governance requirements.
Before the amendment was adopted, NASDAQs Marketplace Rules provided that foreign private issuers could, upon application, be exempt from certain of its corporate governance requirements when these requirements were contrary to the laws, rules or regulations, or generally accepted business practices of the issuers home jurisdiction.
Ericsson has received (and is entitled to continue to rely thereon under the 2005 amendment) exemptions from NASDAQs corporate governance requirements under the Marketplace Rules in order to allow:
| Employee representatives to be elected to the Board of Directors and serve on its Committees (including the Audit Committee), in accordance with Swedish law. |
| Shareholders to participate in the election of Directors and the Nomination Committee, in accordance with Swedish law and common market practice respectively. |
| Employee representatives on the Board to attend all Board and all Committee meetings (including the Audit Committee), in accordance with Swedish laws concerning attendance and decision making processes. |
In addition, Ericsson relies on the exemption provided by the 2005 amendment to overcome contradictions between NASDAQ and Swedish law requirements regarding quorums for its meetings of holders of common stock.
INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING FOR YEAR 2006
According to the Swedish Companies Act and the Swedish Code of Corporate Governance, the Board of Directors shall ensure that the Company has satisfactory internal controls and keep itself informed of the Companys internal control system and assess how well it is working. This report has been prepared in accordance with the Swedish Code of Corporate Governance, section 3.7.2, and is thereby limited to internal control over financial reporting.
The Swedish Corporate Governance Board has made a pronouncement regarding the Board of Directors reporting on internal control under the Code to the effect that: this report is to be included as a part of the Corporate Governance Report; it is not necessary for the Board of Directors to make a statement of how well the internal control over financial reporting has worked; and the Internal Control Report does not have to be examined by the auditors. In accordance with this pronouncement, we are not making any such statement in this report for 2006 and this report has not been examined by our auditors.
As the Company is listed in the United States, the requirements in SOX section 404 regarding assessment of the effectiveness of internal controls over financial reporting are applicable as from the fiscal year 2006. The
183
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Company has implemented detailed controls, documentation and testing procedures in accordance with the COSO framework, issued by the Committee Of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission, to ensure compliance with SOX 404.
INTERNAL CONTROL OVER THE FINANCIAL REPORTING
Ericsson has integrated risk management and internal control in its business processes. As defined in the COSO framework for internal control, components of internal control are: a control environment, risk assessment, control activities, information and communication, and monitoring.
Control environment
The Companys internal control structure is based on:
| the division of work between the Board of Directors and its Committees and the President and CEO; |
| a management system based on |
| the Companys organization and mode of operations, with well-defined roles and responsibilities and delegations of authority; |
| steering documents such as policies and directives, including a code of business ethics and conduct; and |
| a number of well-defined planning, operational and support processes. |
The most essential parts of the control environment regarding the financial reporting are included in steering documents related to accounting and financial reporting. Such steering documents are updated regularly for changes to, for example, laws, financial reporting standards and listing requirements, such as IFRS and SOX in the United States.
Risk assessment
Risks related to financial reporting are fraud and loss or embezzlement of assets, undue favorable treatment of counter-parties at the expense of the Company, and other risks of material misstatements in the financial statements, for example those related to recognition and measurement of assets, liabilities, revenue and cost or insufficient disclosure. Ericsson is managed through common processes, where risk management is integrated, applying various methods for risk assessment and control, to ensure that the risks the Company is exposed to are managed according to established policies. Accounting and reporting policies and directives cover areas of particular significance to support correct accounting, reporting and disclosure.
Control activities
The Companys business processes include financial controls regarding approval and accounting for business transactions. The financial closing and reporting process has controls regarding recognition, measurement and disclosure, including the application of critical accounting policies and estimates, in consolidated companies as well as on Group level. All legal entities, business units and market units in Ericsson have their own controller functions participating in planning and evaluation of each units performance. Their regular analysis of the financial reports for their respective units, together with analysis performed at Group level, is an important element of the internal control to ensure that the financial reports do not contain material errors.
For external financial reporting purposes, additional controls that all disclosure requirements are fulfilled are performed by a Disclosure Committee established by Company management.
184
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
The Company has implemented controls to ensure that the financial reports are prepared in accordance with IFRS. The Company also has detailed documentation of internal controls related to accounting and financial reporting, as well as monitoring of the performance and results of such controls, to ensure Ericsson can assess the effectiveness of the internal control in a way that is compliant with SOX requirements. A thorough review of materiality levels related to the financial reports has resulted in implementation of detailed control documentation in a number of subsidiaries with significant scale of operations. For other subsidiaries, overall controls related to the control environment and compliance with policies and directives related to financial reporting have been implemented.
Information and communication
The Company has information and communication channels supporting completeness and correctness of financial reporting, for example, by making internal instructions and policies regarding accounting and financial reporting widely known and accessible to all employees concerned, as well as regular updates and briefing documents regarding changes in accounting policies and reporting and disclosure requirements.
Legal and operational units make regular financial and management reports to internal steering groups and Company management, including analysis and comments of financial performance and risks. The Board of Directors receives financial reports monthly. The Audit Committee has established a whistle blower procedure for the reporting of violations in relation to accounting, internal controls and auditing matters.
Monitoring
The Companys financial performance is reviewed at each Board meeting. The committees of the Board fulfill important monitoring functions regarding remuneration, borrowing, investments, customer financing, cash management, financial reporting and internal control. The Audit Committee and the Board of Directors review all interim and annual financial reports before they are released to the market.
The Companys process for financial reporting is reviewed annually by Management and forms a basis for the evaluation of the internal management system and internal steering documents to ensure that these cover all significant areas related to financial reporting. Compliance with policies and directives is also monitored through annual self assessments and representation letters from heads and controllers in all consolidated companies as well as from business units and market units. The Company has an internal audit function, reporting to the Audit Committee, which performs independent audits.
185
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
MANAGEMENTS REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING
Ericssons management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for the Company. Ericssons internal control over financial reporting is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles and includes those policies and procedures that:
| pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the Company; |
| provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company; and |
| provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the Companys assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements. |
Although the purpose of internal control systems is to enable risks to be optimally managed, all internal control systems, no matter how well designed, have inherent limitations which may not prevent or detect misstatements. Therefore, even those systems determined to be effective can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation and presentation.
Ericssons management assessed the effectiveness of Ericssons internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2006. In making this assessment, management used the criteria set forth in Internal ControlIntegrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Based on this assessment, management has concluded that, as of December 31, 2006, Ericssons internal control over financial reporting was effective. PricewaterhouseCoopers AB has issued an attestation report on managements assessment of Ericssons internal control over financial reporting. Their report appears on page 42.
186
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
The following information is provided for purposes of complying with certain requirements of Form 20-F which are not satisfied in full by the information in the Swedish Annual Report.
EXCHANGE RATES
The following tables provide information with respect to the exchange rate for SEK per USD 1.00, based on the noon buying rate for cable transfers in SEK as certified for customs purposes by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York. The noon buying rate of June 4, 2007, was SEK 6.9161 per USD 1.00. The average is computed using the noon buying rate on the last business day of each month during the period indicated.
Year ended December 31 |
Average | |
2002 |
9.6571 | |
2003 |
8.0351 | |
2004 |
7.3320 | |
2005 |
7.5170 | |
2006 |
7.3718 |
Month |
High | Low | ||
September 2006 |
7.3450 | 7.2410 | ||
October 2006 |
7.4200 | 7.3072 | ||
November 2006 |
7.2096 | 6.8331 | ||
December 2006 |
6.9204 | 6.7674 | ||
January 2007 |
7.0829 | 6.7818 | ||
February 2007 |
7.0839 | 6.9436 | ||
March 2007 |
7.1060 | 6.9622 | ||
April 2007 |
7.0057 | 6.6975 | ||
May 2007 |
6.9376 | 6.7093 |
We describe the effects of exchange rate fluctuations on our business in the Board of Directors Report under the heading Risk Management and in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial StatementsNote C20, Financial Risk Management and Financial Instruments.
OPERATING RESULTS
Years ended December 31, 2005 and 2006
Please refer to Board of Directors Report.
Years ended December 31, 2004 and 2005
Net Sales
Consolidated
Consolidated net sales increased by SEK 15 percent, to SEK 151.8 billion in 2005 from SEK 132.0 billion in 2004. The increase was mainly driven by sales in the Systems segment. The effect of fluctuations in foreign exchange rates was not significant on reported sales.
187
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Systems
Net sales in segment Systems increased by 17 percent, to SEK 142.0 billion in 2005 from SEK 121.5 billion in 2004. Unit volume increases drove mobile network sales growth while network buildout projects and professional services drove growth of services sales. Sales of professional services were particularly encouraging as the Company was awarded a number of contracts for network management, including the largest contracts in Ericssons history. Within fixed networks, Ericsson was awarded a number of contracts for next-generation converged networks that include broadband access, IMS/softswitch and packet switching products.
All regions increased their sales; Western Europe by 6 percent, Central and Eastern Europe, Middle East and Africa by 21 percent, Asia Pacific sales by 10 percent, North America by 27 percent and Latin America by 33 percent.
Phones
Since the transfer of the Phones segment to Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications, on October 1, 2001, net sales are not reported for this segment.
Other Operations
Net sales decreased 6 percent to SEK 9.8 billion in 2005 from SEK 10.4 billion in 2004. There were positive sales developments within Mobile Platforms and Cables ( Network Technologies). These sales were not sufficient to compensate for lower sales by the other units within Other Operations.
Gross Margin
Gross margin increased by 14 percent to SEK 69.5 billion in 2005 compared with SEK 61.1 billion in 2004. The lower gross margins were mainly a reflection of a product mix that has a significantly higher proportion of services sales.
Operating Expenses
Operating expenses in 2005 were SEK 41.3 billion compared to SEK 39.3 billion in 2004. While sales increased 15 percent operating expenses increased only 5 percent. Operating expenses measured as a percentage of net sales decreased from 30 percent in 2004 to 27 percent in 2005, reflecting ongoing efficiency improvements as well as the continued benefits of the cost reduction measures completed in 2004.
Research and Development and Other Technical Expenses
Research and development and other technical expenses increased by SEK 1.1 billion, or 4 percent, to SEK 24.5 billion in 2005 compared with SEK 23.4 billion in 2004.
Selling and Administrative Expenses
Selling expenses increased by SEK 0.9 billion, or 6 percent, to SEK 16.8 billion in 2005 compared with SEK 15.9 billion in 2004.
Other Items
Other Operating income
Other operating revenues decreased to SEK 2.5 billion in 2005 compared with SEK 2.6 billion in 2004. The main items included in Other Operating income are license fees.
188
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Share in Earnings of Joint Ventures and Associated Companies
Share in earnings of JV and associated companies were stable and improved by SEK 0.1 billion from SEK 2.3 billion 2004 to 2.4 billion 2005. During the year 2005 the joint venture also achieved the significant milestone of retained earnings exceeding cumulative losses.
Operating Income
Operating Income increased by SEK 6.4 billion, from SEK 26.7 billion in 2004 to SEK 33.1 billion in 2005. The increase was mainly due to increase of sales and high margins, reflecting strong market growth.
During 2005 the operating expenses reflected ongoing efficiency improvements.
Financial Income and Expenses
Financial income decreased to SEK 2.7 billion in 2005 compared with SEK 3.5 billion in 2004. Financial expenses decreased SEK 1.6 billion to SEK 2.4 billion in 2005 compared with SEK 4.1 billion in 2004.
Taxes
Tax cost was SEK 8.9 billion 2005 compared with SEK 8.3 billion in 2004. The effective tax rate was 27 percent in 2005.
As of December 31, 2005, we had aggregate tax loss carry-forwards of SEK 28.0 billion, SEK 27.3 billion of which will not expire until 2011 or later.
Minority Interest
Net income attributable to minority interest after taxes was SEK 0.1 billion 2005, compared to SEK 0.3 billion in 2004.
Net Income/Loss
As a result principally of the above factors, the net income increased by SEK 6.7 billion from SEK 17.8 billion in 2004 to SEK 24.5 billion in 2005. Diluted earnings per share were SEK 1.53 in 2005 compared to SEK 1.11 in 2004.
MEMORANDUM AND ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION
Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson is entered under no. 5560160680 in the Company Register kept by the Swedish Companies Registration Office. Our Companys objective and purposes are described in §2 of the Articles of Association.
Our Articles of Association do not stipulate anything regarding a) a directors power to vote on a proposal, arrangement, or contract in which the director is materially interested, b) our directors power to vote for compensation to themselves, c) our directors borrowing powers, d) retirements rules for our directors or e) the number of shares required for a directors qualification. Applicable provisions are found in the Swedish Companies Act, as referred to in Certain Powers of Directors and the President below.
There are no age limit restrictions for directors and they are not required to own any shares in the Company.
189
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Share Capital, Increases of Share Capital and Preferential Rights of Shareholders
The Articles of Association of Ericsson provide that the share capital of the Company may not be less than SEK 6,000 million nor more than SEK 24,000 million, and that the number of shares in the Company shall amount to no less than 6,000,000,000 and no more than 24,000,000,000. The registered share capital is SEK 16,132,258,678 and the Company has in total issued SEK 16,132,258,678 shares.
The Companys shares are divided into three series: Class A shares, Class B shares and Class C shares; however, no Class C shares are currently outstanding. Under the Swedish Companies Act of 2005, applicable as of January 1, 2006 (the Swedish Companies Act), shareholders must approve each issue of additional shares either by deciding on the share issue at a shareholders meeting, or by a shareholders approval of a decision on a share issue by the Board, or by giving an authorization to the Board to decide about a share issue. If we decide to issue new Class A, Class B and Class C shares by means of a cash issue, or an issue against payment through set-off of claims, Class A, Class B and Class C shareholders (except for Ericsson and its subsidiaries, in the event they hold shares in Ericsson) have a primary preferential right to subscribe for new shares of the same type in relation to the number of shares previously held by them. Shares not subscribed for through a preferential right shall be offered to all shareholders for subscription on a pro rata basis. If we decide to issue new shares of only one series by means of a cash issue or an issue against payment through set-off of claims, all shareholders, regardless of whether their shares are Class A, Class B or Class C, are entitled to a preferential right to subscribe for new shares in proportion to the number of shares previously held by them. Shareholders may vote to waive shareholders preferential rights at a general meeting.
If we decide to issue warrants or convertibles through a cash issue or an issue against payment through set-off of claims, the shareholders have preemptive rights to subscribe to warrants as if the issue were of the shares that may be subscribed to pursuant to the warrant and, respectively, preemptive rights to subscribe to convertibles as if the issue were of the shares that the convertibles may be converted to.
The above does not constitute any restriction to waive the shareholders preferential rights when deciding on either a cash issue, an issue against payment through set-off of claims, an issue of warrants or an issue of convertibles.
Dividends
Our Class A and Class B shareholders have the same right to dividends, while Class C shareholders have a right to a yearly dividend as described in article 15 of our Articles of Association. No Class C shares are currently outstanding.
Under Swedish law, only a general meeting of shareholders may decide on payment of dividends, which may not exceed the amount proposed by the Board of Directors (except in certain limited circumstances), and may only be paid from funds legally available for that purpose. Under Swedish law, no interim dividends may be paid in respect of any fiscal period for which audited financial statements of the company have not yet been adopted by the annual general meeting of shareholders. The market practice in Sweden is for dividends to be paid annually. Under the Swedish Companies Act, dividends to shareholders and other transfers of value from a companysuch as purchases of own shares (see below)may only be made in case the companys restricted equity remains fully covered after the transfer of value has been made. The calculation shall be based upon the most recently adopted balance sheet, and any changes in the restricted equity that has occurred after the balance sheet date shall be taken into account. In addition, dividends to shareholders and other transfers of value from the company may only be made if this is justifiable taken into account the type of business activities of the company, their scope and risks related thereto and the companys need for financial resources, its liquidity and position. In respect of parent companies, also the business activities of the group, their scope and risks related thereto and the groups need for financial resources, its liquidity and position should be taken into account.
190
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
The Companys shares are registered in the computerized book-entry share registration system administered by VPC AB (VPC). The rights attached to shares eligible for dividends accrue to those persons whose names are recorded in the register of shareholders on the record day. The dividends are then sent to a specified account as directed by the person registered with VPC, or to the address of that person. The relevant record day must, in most circumstances, be specified in the resolution declaring a dividend or resolving upon a capital increase or any similar matter in which shareholders have preferential rights, or the Board of Directors must be authorized to determine the relevant record day.
Where the registered holder is a nominee, the nominee receives, for the account of the beneficial owner, dividends and, on issues of shares with preferential rights for the shareholders, shares, as well as rights. Dividends are remitted in a single payment to the nominee who is responsible for the distribution of such dividends to the beneficial owner. A similar procedure is adopted for share issues. Specific authority to act as a nominee must be obtained from VPC. The nominee must issue a public report to the VPC every six months, listing all beneficial holders of more than 500 shares. VPC is required to keep a register with regard to any holding on behalf of a single beneficial owner in excess of 500 shares in any one company. This list must reveal the names of the beneficial owner and must be open to public inspection.
Voting
In a general meeting of Ericsson, each Class A share shall carry one vote, each Class B share one tenth of one vote and each Class C share one-thousandth of one vote.
We are required to publish notices to attend annual general meetings no earlier than six weeks and no later than four weeks prior to the general meeting and the same notice period requirements apply regarding extraordinary general meetings concerning changes in our articles of association. Notices to attend other types of extraordinary general meetings must be published no earlier than six weeks and no later than two weeks prior to the general meeting.
Directors are elected during the annual general meeting for a period of one year at a time and do not stand for reelection at staggered intervals.
A shareholder may attend and vote at the meeting in person or by proxy. Proxies are not valid for longer than a year from the date of issuance. Any shareholder wishing to attend a general meeting must notify us no later than 4:00 p.m. (CET) on the day specified in the notice. We are required to accept all notifications of attendance received at least five business days (Saturdays normally included) prior to the meeting. A person designated in the register as a nominee (including the depositary of the ADSs) is not entitled to vote at a general meeting, nor is a beneficial owner whose share is registered in the name of a nominee (including the depositary of the ADSs) unless the beneficial owner first arranges to have such owners own name entered in the register of shareholders maintained by VPC no later than the designated record day.
Under the Swedish Companies Act, resolutions are passed by a simple majority of votes cast at the meeting with the chairman of the meeting having a decisive vote (except in respect of elections), unless otherwise required by law or a companys articles of association. Under the Swedish Companies Act, certain resolutions require special quorums and majorities, including, but not limited to, the following:
A a resolution to amend the articles of association requires a majority of two-thirds of the votes cast as well as two-thirds of the shares represented at the meeting, except in those circumstances described in BD below;
B a resolution to amend the articles of association which reduces any shareholders rights to profits or assets, restricts the transferability of shares or alters the legal relationship between shares, normally requires the unanimous approval of the shareholders present at the meeting and who hold nine-tenths of all outstanding shares;
191
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
C a resolution to amend the articles of association for the purpose of limiting the number of shares with which a shareholder may vote at a general meeting or allocating part of the net profit for the fiscal year to a restricted fund or limiting the use of the companys profits or assets in a liquidation or dissolution, normally requires the approval of shareholders representing two-thirds of the votes cast and nine-tenths of the shares represented at the meeting;
D a resolution of the kind referred to under B or C above may, however, be taken with a lower supermajority requirement if the amendments referred to therein will only adversely affect specific shares or classes of shares. In such cases, the requirement under a above will apply together with the following separate supermajority: (a) where only a class of shares is adversely affected, approval of the owners of one-half of all shares of such class and nine-tenths of the shares of such class represented at the meeting, or (b) where the shares adversely affected do not constitute a class of shares, the unanimous approval of all such affected outstanding shares present at the meeting and who hold nine-tenths of all outstanding shares adversely affected;
E a resolution to issue, approve or authorize the issuance for cash of new shares, warrants or convertibles with a deviation from the preferential right for existing shareholders requires a two-thirds majority of votes cast at the meeting as well as two-thirds of the shares represented at the meeting;
F a resolution to reduce the outstanding share capital requires a two-thirds majority of votes cast at the meeting as well as two-thirds of the shares represented at the meeting. In case there are several classes of shares in a company, the above described majority requirement shall apply also within each share class represented at the meeting and for which the rights of the shares are adversely affected; and
G a resolution to approve a merger requires a two-thirds majority of the votes cast at the meeting and two-thirds of the shares represented at the meeting.
At a general meeting of shareholders, a shareholder or proxy for one or more shareholders may cast full number of votes represented by the holders shares.
Purchase of Own Shares
A public Swedish limited liability company whose shares are traded on a securities exchange, an authorized market place or another regulated market place is entitled to purchase its own shares under certain conditions. A purchase by us of our own shares may take place only if (a) the purchase has been decided upon by a general meeting of shareholders or the Board has been authorized by a general meeting of shareholders, in both cases by a two thirds majority of votes cast at the meeting as well as two-thirds of the shares present or represented at the meeting, (b) the purchase is effected on a securities exchange or in some other regulated market either in the European Economic Area (EEA) or outside the EEA (in the latter case with the approval of the Swedish Financial Supervisory Authority the SFSA) or pursuant to an offer to all shareholders or holders of a specific class of shares, (c) the Companys restricted equity will still be fully covered and the purchase is justifiable taken into account the type of business activities of the Company and the group, their scope and risks related thereto and the Companys and the groups need for financial resources, its liquidity and position, and (d) we and our subsidiaries do not hold or, as a result of purchase, will not hold in excess of 10 percent of all our outstanding shares. As of December 31, 2005, the Company held an aggregate of 268,065,241 repurchased Class B shares.
Investment Restrictions
There are no limitations imposed by Swedish law or by our Articles of Association in respect of the rights of non-residents or foreign persons to purchase, own or sell securities issued by us.
192
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
There are however certain flagging and ownership examination rules that apply, irrespective of nationality.
Pursuant to recommendations concerning the disclosure of acquisition and transfer of shares issued by Näringslivets Börskommitté (the Swedish Industry and Commerce Stock Exchange Committee), any seller or purchaser of securities including shares of stock, convertible debt instruments, warrants, non-standardized options and futures of a Swedish company listed on Stockholmsbörsen, must report to Stockholmsbörsen and to the company transactions in which the purchaser or seller acquires or disposes of 5 percent of any subsequent percentage that is a multiple of five, up to and including 90 percent of either the voting rights of all shares or the total number of shares in the company. These changes in ownership should also be reported to an established news agency and to a nationally published newspaper in Sweden no later than 9:00 a.m. on the day after which trading has been conducted on Stockholmsbörsen.
In addition, according to the Swedish Financial Instruments Trading Act, if a natural or legal person acquires or disposes of shareholdings in a Swedish company that has its shares listed on a stock exchange situated or operating within one or more EEA countries and, as a result of such acquisition or disposition, holds voting rights equal to, in excess of or less than one of the thresholds of 10 percent, 20 percent, 33 percent, 50 percent or 66 percent, the person is required to notify the company in writing at the same time it notifies the stock exchange or, if the shares are not listed in Sweden, the SFSA within seven calendar days of the acquisition or disposition.
In addition, the Act on Reporting Obligations Regarding Certain Holdings of Financial Instruments requires, among other things, that certain individuals who own shares representing 10 percent or more of the share capital or the voting rights in a publicly traded company report such ownership to the SFSA, which keeps a public register based on the information contained in such reports, and also to report any changes in such ownership within five business days (Saturdays normally included).
EXCHANGE CONTROLS
There is no Swedish legislation affecting a) the import or export of capital or b) the remittance of dividends, interest or other payments to non-resident holders of our securities except that, subject to the provisions in any tax treaty, dividends are subject to withholding tax.
193
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
TAXATION
General
The taxation discussion set forth below does not purport to be a complete analysis or listing of all potential tax effects relevant to the acquisition, ownership or disposition of Class B shares or ADSs. The statements of United States and Swedish tax laws set forth below are based on the laws in force as of the date of this report and may be subject to any changes in United States or Swedish law, and in any double taxation convention or treaty between the United States and Sweden, occurring after that date, which changes may then have retroactive effect.
Specific tax provisions may apply for certain categories of tax payers. Your tax treatment if you are a holder of Class B shares or ADSs depends in part on your particular situation. If you are a holder of Class B shares or ADSs, you should therefore consult a tax advisor as to the tax consequences relating to your particular circumstances resulting from the ownership of Class B shares or ADSs.
The tax consequences to holders of ADSs, as discussed below, apply equally to holders of Class B shares.
Certain Swedish Tax Considerations
This section describes the material Swedish income and net wealth tax consequences for a holder of ADSs or Class B shares who is not considered to be a Swedish resident for Swedish tax purposes. This section applies to you only if you are a holder of portfolio investments representing less than 10 percent of capital and votes and is not applicable if the ADSs or Class B shares pertain to a permanent establishment or fixed base of business in Sweden.
Taxation on Capital Gains
Generally, non-residents of Sweden are not liable for Swedish capital gains taxation with respect to the sale of ADSs or Class B shares. However, under Swedish tax law, capital gains from the sale of shares in Swedish companies and certain other securities by an individual may be taxed in Sweden at a rate of 30 percent if the seller has been a resident of Sweden or has lived permanently in Sweden at any time during the year of the sale or the 10 calendar years preceding the year of the sale (absent treaty provisions to the contrary). The provision is applicable on ADSs or Class B shares.
This provision may, however, be limited by tax treaties that Sweden has concluded with other countries. Under the tax treaty between Sweden and the United States (the U.S. Tax Treaty), this provision applies for ten years from the date the individual became a nonresident of Sweden.
Taxation on Dividends
A Swedish dividend withholding tax at a rate of 30 percent is imposed on dividends paid by a Swedish corporation, such as us, to non-residents of Sweden. The same withholding tax applies to certain other payments made by a Swedish corporation, including payments as a result of redemption of shares and repurchase of stock through an offer directed to its shareholders. Exemption from the withholding tax or a lower tax rate may apply by virtue of a tax treaty. Under the U.S. Tax Treaty, the withholding tax on dividends paid on portfolio investments to eligible U.S. holders is reduced to 15 percent.
Under all Swedish tax treaties, except the tax treaty with Switzer-land, withholding tax at the applicable treaty rate should be withheld by the payer of the dividends. With regard to dividends paid from shares in corporations registered with the VPC (such as our shares), a reduced rate of dividend withholding tax under a tax treaty is generally applied at the source by the VPC or, if the shares are registered with a nominee, the nominee, as long as the person entitled to the dividend is registered as a non-resident and sufficient information regarding the tax residency of the beneficial owner is available to the VPC or the nominee.
194
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
In those cases where Swedish withholding tax is withheld at the rate of 30 percent and the person who received the dividends is entitled to a reduced rate of withholding tax under a tax treaty, a refund may be claimed from the Swedish tax authorities before the end of the fifth calendar year following the year that the distribution was made.
Taxation on Interest
No Swedish withholding tax is payable on interest paid to non-residents of Sweden.
Net Wealth Taxation
The ADSs and Class B shares are not subject to Swedish net wealth taxation in the hands of a holder that is not resident in Sweden for tax purposes.
Certain United States Federal Income Tax Consequences
The following discussion is a summary of the material United States federal income tax consequences relevant to the ownership and disposition of ADSs or Class B shares. This discussion is based on the tax laws of the United States (including the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the Code), its legislative history, existing and proposed regulations thereunder, published rulings and court decisions) as in effect on the date hereof, all of which are subject to change, possibly with retroactive effect. The discussion is not a full discussion of all tax considerations that may be relevant to the ownership and disposition of ADSs or Class B shares. The discussion applies only if you will hold the ADSs and/or the Class B shares as capital assets and you use the USD as your functional currency. It does not deal with the tax treatment of investors subject to special rules, such as grantor trusts, real estate investment trusts, regulated investment companies, banks, brokers or dealers in securities, traders in securities or currencies that elect to use a mark-to-market method of recording for their securities holdings, financial institutions, insurance companies, tax-exempt entities, investors liable for alternative minimum tax, holders (either actually or constructively) of 10 percent or more of our Class B shares, persons holding ADSs and/or Class B shares as part of a hedging, straddle, conversion or constructive sale transaction and persons who are resident or ordinarily resident in Sweden. In addition, investors holding ADSs and/or Class B shares indirectly through partnerships are subject to special rules not discussed below. You should consult your own tax advisers about the United States federal, state, local and foreign tax consequences to you of the ownership and disposition of the ADSs or Class B shares.
The discussion below applies to you only if you are a beneficial owner of ADSs and/or Class B shares not resident in Sweden for purposes of the U.S. Tax Treaty and you are, for United States federal income tax purposes, (1) a citizen or resident of the United States, (2) a corporation or any other entity treated as a corporation that is organized in or under the laws of the United States or its political subdivisions, (3) a trust if all of the trusts substantial decisions are subject to the control of one or more United States persons and the primary supervision of the trust is subject to a United States court or if a valid election is in effect with respect to the trust to be taxed as a United States person, or (4) an estate the income of which is subject to United States federal income taxation regardless of its source.
The discussion below assumes that the representations contained in the deposit agreement are true and that the obligations in the deposit agreement and any related agreement will be complied with in accordance with the terms. If you hold ADSs, you will be treated as the holder of the underlying Class B shares represented by those ADSs for United States federal income tax purposes.
195
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Taxation of ADSs or Class B shares
Dividends
Subject to the passive foreign investment company rules discussed below, the gross amount of dividends paid (before reduction for any Swedish withholding taxes) with respect to the ADSs or Class B shares generally will be included in your gross income as ordinary income from foreign sources to the extent paid out of our current or accumulated earnings and profits (as determined for United States federal income tax purposes). Distributions in excess of earnings and profits will be treated as a non-taxable return of capital to the extent of your adjusted tax basis in the ADSs or Class B shares and thereafter as capital gain. The dividends will not be eligible for the dividends received deduction available to corporations in respect of dividends received from other U.S. corporations. The amount of any dividend paid in SEK will be the U.S. dollar value of the dividend payment based on the exchange rate in effect on the date of receipt by you, in the case of Class B shares or by the depositary, in the case of ADSs, whether or not the payment is converted into USD at that time. Your tax basis in the SEK received will equal such USD amount. Gain or loss, if any, recognized on a subsequent sale or conversion of the SEK will be U.S. source ordinary income or loss.
If you are a non-corporate holder of ADSs or Class B shares, dividends you receive on the ADSs or Class B shares for taxable years beginning before January 1, 2011, may be taxed at the lower applicable capital gains rate provided that (1) we are not a passive foreign investment company (as discussed below) for either our taxable year in which the dividend was paid or the preceding taxable year, (2) certain holding period requirements are met and (3) either (a) our ADSs continue to be listed on the Nasdaq Stock Market (or a national securities exchange that is registered under section 6 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended) or (b) we are eligible for the benefits of the U.S. Tax Treaty. You should consult your own tax advisors regarding the availability of the lower rate for dividends paid with respect to ADSs or Class B shares.
Subject to certain limitations, you will generally be entitled to receive credit against your United States federal income tax liability (or a deduction against your United States federal taxable income) with respect to any Swedish tax withheld in accordance with the U.S. Tax Treaty and paid over to Sweden. If a refund of the tax withheld is available to you under the laws of Sweden or under the U.S. Tax Treaty, the amount of tax withheld that is refundable will not be eligible for such credit against your United States federal income tax liability (and will not be eligible for the deduction against your United States federal taxable income). For foreign tax credit limitation purposes, the dividend will be income from sources without the United States, and will generally be treated as passive income (or, in the case of certain holders, financial services income). For taxable years beginning after December 31, 2006, dividends will generally be treated as passive category income (or, in the case of certain holders, general category income).
Sale or Exchange of ADSs or Class B shares
Subject to the passive foreign investment company rules discussed below, you will generally recognize capital gain or loss on the sale or other disposition of the ADSs or Class B shares equal to the difference between the USD value of the amount realized and your adjusted tax basis (determined in USD) in the ADSs or Class B shares. Such gain or loss will be capital gain or loss and will generally be treated as arising from U.S. sources for foreign tax credit limitation purposes.
The amount realized on a disposition of ADSs or Class B shares will generally be the amount of cash you receive for the ADSs or Class B shares (which, in the case of payment in a non-U.S. currency, will equal the USD value of the payment received determined on (a) the date of receipt of payment if you are a cash basis taxpayer and (b) the date of disposition if you are an accrual basis taxpayer). If the ADSs or Class B shares are treated as traded on an established securities market, if you are a cash basis taxpayer (or, if you are an accrual basis taxpayer, if you so elect) you will determine the USD value of the amount realized by translating the amount received at the spot rate of exchange on the settlement date of the sale.
196
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
You will have a tax basis in any foreign currency received equal to the USD amount realized. Any gain or loss you realize on a subsequent conversion of foreign currency will be U.S. source ordinary income or loss.
Passive Foreign Investment Company Status
A non-U.S. corporation is a passive foreign investment company (a PFIC) in any taxable year in which, after taking into account the income and assets of certain subsidiaries, either (a) at least 75 percent of its gross income is passive income or (b) at least 50 percent of the quarterly average value of its assets is attributable to assets that produce or are held to produce passive income. Based on the market value of our shares, the composition of our assets and income and our operations, we believe we were not a PFIC during the year 2006. However, whether or not we will be considered a PFIC will depend on the nature and source of our income and the value of our assets, as determined from time to time. If we are treated as a PFIC, we will not provide information necessary for the qualified electing fund election as the term is defined in the relevant provisions of the Code. You should consult your own tax advisors about the consequences of our classification as a PFIC.
If we were a PFIC, for any taxable year in which you held ADSs or Class B shares, you would be subject to special rules with respect to:
| any gain realized on the sale or other disposition of ADSs or Class B shares; and |
| any excess distribution made to you (generally, any distributions to you in respect of ADSs or Class B shares during a single taxable year that are, in the aggregate, greater than 125 percent of the average annual distributions received by you in respect of ADSs or Class B shares during the three preceding taxable years or, if shorter, your holding period for ADSs or Class B shares). |
Under these rules:
| the gain or excess distribution would be allocated ratably over your holding period for ADSs or Class B shares; |
| the amount allocated to the taxable year in which the gain or excess distribution was realized and any year before we became a PFIC would be taxable as ordinary income and |
| the amount allocated to each prior year, other than the current year and any taxable year prior to the first taxable year in which we were a PFIC, would be subject to tax at the highest applicable marginal tax rate in effect for each such year; and an interest charge would be imposed to cover the deemed benefit for the deferred payment of the tax attributable to each such year. |
As an alternative to the special rules described above, holders of marketable stock in a PFIC may elect mark-to-market treatment with respect to their ADSs or Class B shares. ADSs or Class B shares will not be considered marketable stock unless the Class B shares are regularly traded on a qualified exchange or other market. If the mark-to-market election is available and you elect mark-to-market treatment you will, in general, include as ordinary income each year an amount equal to the increase in value of your ADSs or Class B shares for that year (measured at the close of your taxable year) and will generally be allowed a deduction for any decrease in the value of your Class B shares for the year, but only to the extent of previously included mark-to-market income.
If you own ADSs or Class B shares during any year in which we are a PFIC, you are required to make an annual return on IRS Form 8621 regarding distributions received with respect to Class B shares and any gain realized on the disposition of your ADSs or Class B shares.
197
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
Information reporting and backup withholding
In general, information reporting requirements may apply to dividends paid in respect of ADSs or Class B shares and the proceeds received on the sale or exchange of the ADSs or Class B shares within the United States or by a broker with certain United States connections. Backup withholding, at a rate of 28 percent through 2010, and 31 percent thereafter, may apply to payments to you of dividends paid in respect of ADSs or Class B shares or the proceeds of a sale or other disposition of ADSs or Class B shares if you fail to provide an accurate taxpayer identification number (certified on IRS Form W-9) or, upon request, to certify that you are not subject to backup withholding, or otherwise to comply with the applicable requirements of backup withholding. The amount of any backup withholding from a payment to you will be allowed as a credit against your United States federal income tax liability and a refund of any excess amount withheld under the backup withholding rules may be obtained by filing the appropriate claim for refund with the IRS and furnishing any required information.
FIVE-YEAR SUMMARY
US GAAP
SEK million |
2006 | 2005 | 2004 | 2003 | 2002 | |||||
Net Sales |
177,783 | 151,821 | 131,972 | 117,738 | 145,773 | |||||
Net Income |
26,080 | 24,495 | 14,386 | -10,597 | -19,918 | |||||
Net income net of discontinued operations |
23,260 | 24,312 | 14,228 | -10,930 | -19,577 | |||||
Earnings per share basic after cumulative effect of accounting change (SEK per share)1) |
1.64 | 1.55 | 0.91 | -0.68 | -1.58 | |||||
Earnings per share basic net of discontinued operations1) |
1.47 | 1.53 | 0.90 | -0.69 | -1.56 | |||||
Earnings per share diluted after cumulative effect of accounting change (SEK per share)2) |
1.64 | 1.54 | 0.91 | -0.68 | -1.58 | |||||
Earnings per share diluted net of discontinued operations2) |
1.46 | 1.53 | 0.90 | -0.69 | -1.54 | |||||
Total assets |
217,037 | 211,042 | 192,863 | 195,611 | 226,480 | |||||
Stockholders equity |
121,898 | 104,638 | 84,369 | 69,963 | 83,202 | |||||
Capital Stock |
16,132 | 16,132 | 16,132 | 16,132 | 15,974 | |||||
Number of shares |
||||||||||
Average basic |
15,871 | 15,843 | 15,829 | 15,823 | 12,573 | |||||
Average diluted |
15,943 | 15,907 | 15,855 | 15,831 | 12,684 |
1) | Earnings per share, basic, are calculated by dividing net income by average number of shares outstanding, basic |
2) | Diluted earnings per share are calculated by dividing net income (loss), after cumulative effect of accounting change, by the sum of the average number of shares outstanding plus all additional shares that would have been outstanding if all convertible debentures were converted, stock options were exercised and matching shares issued under stock purchase plans. Potential ordinary shares are not considered when their conversion to ordinary shares would increase earnings per share. |
198
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
INVESTMENTS
The following listing shows certain shareholdings owned directly and indirectly by the Parent Company as of December 31, 2006. A complete listing of shareholdings, prepared in accordance with the Swedish Annual Accounts Act and filed with the Swedish Companies Registration Office (Bolagsverket), may be obtained upon request to: Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, External & Management Information, SE-164 83 Stockholm, Sweden.
SHARES OWNED DIRECTLY BY THE PARENT COMPANY
Type |
Company |
Reg. No. | Domicile |
Percentage of ownership |
Par value in local currency, million |
Carrying value, SEK m. | |||||||
Subsidiary companies |
|||||||||||||
I |
Ericsson AB | 556056-6258 | Sweden | 100 | 50 | 20,645 | |||||||
I |
Ericsson Shared Services AB | 556251-3266 | Sweden | 100 | 361 | 5,716 | |||||||
I |
Ericsson Enterprise AB | 556090-3212 | Sweden | 100 | 360 | 335 | |||||||
I |
Ericsson Sverige AB | 556329-5657 | Sweden | 100 | 100 | 102 | |||||||
I |
Netwise AB | 556404-4286 | Sweden | 99 | 2 | 305 | |||||||
II |
AB Aulis | 556030-9899 | Sweden | 100 | 14 | 6 | |||||||
II |
LM Ericsson Holding AB | 556381-7666 | Sweden | 100 | 105 | 131 | |||||||
III |
Ericsson Gämsta AB | 556381-7609 | Sweden | 100 | 162 | 324 | |||||||
III |
Ericsson Credit AB | 556326-0552 | Sweden | 100 | 5 | 5 | |||||||
Other (Sweden) | | | 1,152 | ||||||||||
I |
Ericsson Austria GmbH | Austria | 100 | 4 | 665 | ||||||||
I |
Ericsson Danmark A/S | Denmark | 100 | 90 | 216 | ||||||||
I |
Oy LM Ericsson Ab | Finland | 100 | 13 | 196 | ||||||||
II |
Ericsson Participations France SAS | France | 100 | 26 | 524 | ||||||||
I |
Ericsson GmbH | Germany | 100 | 20 | 796 | ||||||||
I |
Ericsson Hungary Ltd. | Hungary | 100 | 1,301 | 120 | ||||||||
II |
LM Ericsson Holdings Ltd. | Ireland | 100 | 2 | 15 | ||||||||
II |
Ericsson S.r.l. | Italy | 53 | 1) | | 3,151 | |||||||
II |
Ericsson Holding International B.V. | The Netherlands | 100 | 222 | 3,200 | ||||||||
I |
Ericsson A/S | Norway | 100 | 156 | 237 | ||||||||
I |
Ericsson Corporatia AO | Russia | 100 | 5 | 5 | ||||||||
I |
Ericsson AG | Switzerland | 100 | | | ||||||||
II |
Ericsson Holding Ltd. | United Kingdom | 100 | 74 | 758 | ||||||||
Other (Europe, excluding Sweden) | | | 218 | ||||||||||
II |
Ericsson Holding II Inc. | United States | 100 | | 9,531 | ||||||||
I |
Cía Ericsson S.A.C.I. | Argentina | 12 | 2) | 13 | 10 | |||||||
I |
Ericsson Telecommunicações S.A. | Brazil | 9 | 3) | n/a | 123 | |||||||
I |
Ericsson Telecom S.A. de C.V. | Mexico | 100 | n/a | 1,550 | ||||||||
Other (United States, Latin America) | | | 60 | ||||||||||
II |
Teleric Pty Ltd. | Australia | 100 | 20 | 100 | ||||||||
I |
Ericsson Ltd. | China | 100 | 2 | 2 | ||||||||
I |
Ericsson (China) Company Ltd. | China | 100 | 65 | 475 | ||||||||
I |
Nanjing Ericsson Panda Communication Co. Ltd. | China | 25 | 4) | 5 | 37 | |||||||
I |
Ericsson India Private Ltd. | India | 100 | 725 | 147 | ||||||||
I |
Ericsson (Malaysia) Sdn. Bhd. | Malaysia | 70 | 2 | 4 | ||||||||
I |
Ericsson Telecommunications Pte. Ltd. | Singapore | 100 | | 1 | ||||||||
I |
Ericsson Taiwan Ltd. | Taiwan | 80 | 240 | 20 | ||||||||
I |
Ericsson (Thailand) Ltd. | Thailand | 49 | 5) | 90 | 17 | |||||||
Other countries (the rest of the world) | | | 225 | ||||||||||
Total | | 51,124 | |||||||||||
199
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
SHARES OWNED DIRECTLY BY THE PARENT COMPANY (CONTINUED)
Type |
Company |
Reg. No. | Domicile | Percentage of ownership |
Par value in local currency, million |
Carrying value, SEK m. | ||||||
Joint ventures and associated companies |
||||||||||||
I |
Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications AB | 556615-6658 | Sweden | 50 | 50 | 4,136 | ||||||
I |
Ericsson Nikola Tesla d.d. | Croatia | 49 | 65 | 330 | |||||||
Other | | | 3 | |||||||||
Total | | 4,469 | ||||||||||
SHARES OWNED BY SUBSIDIARY COMPANIES
Type |
Company |
Reg. No. | Domicile | Percentage of ownership | ||||
Subsidiary companies |
||||||||
I |
Ericsson Network Technologies AB | 556000-0365 | Sweden | 100 | ||||
II |
Ericsson Cables Holding AB | 556044-9489 | Sweden | 100 | ||||
I |
Ericsson France SAS | France | 100 | |||||
I |
LM Ericsson Ltd. | Ireland | 100 | |||||
I |
Ericsson Telecommunicazioni S.p.A. | Italy | 100 | |||||
II |
Ericsson Nederland B.V. | The Netherlands | 100 | |||||
I |
Ericsson Telecommunicatie B.V. | The Netherlands | 100 | |||||
I |
Ericsson España S.A. | Spain | 100 | |||||
I |
Ericsson Telekomunikasyon A.S. | Turkey | 100 | |||||
I |
Ericsson Ltd. | United Kingdom | 100 | |||||
I |
Ericsson Canada Inc. | Canada | 100 | |||||
I |
Ericsson Inc. | United States | 100 | |||||
I |
Ericsson NetQual Inc. | United States | 100 | |||||
I |
Ericsson IP Infrastructure Inc. | United States | 100 | |||||
I |
Ericsson Amplified Technologies Inc. | United States | 100 | |||||
I |
Ericsson Servicos de Telecomunicações Ltda. | Brazil | 100 | |||||
I |
Ericsson Australia Pty. Ltd. | Australia | 100 | |||||
I |
Ericsson (China) Communications Co. Ltd. | China | 100 | |||||
I |
Nippon Ericsson K.K. | Japan | 100 | |||||
I |
Ericsson Consumer Products Asia Pacific Pte Ltd. | Singapore | 100 |
Key to type of company
I | Manufacturing, distribution and development companies |
II | Holding companies |
III | Finance companies |
1) |
Through subsidiary holdings, total holdings amount to 100% of Ericsson S.r.l. |
2) |
Through subsidiary holdings, total holdings amount to 100% of Cia Ericsson S.A.C.I. |
3) |
Through subsidiary holdings, total holdings amount to 100% of Ericsson Telecommunicações S.A. |
4) |
Through subsidiary holdings, total holdings amount to 51% of Nanjing Ericsson Panda Communication Co. Ltd. |
5) |
Through subsidiary holdings, total holdings amount to 100% of Ericsson (Thailand) Ltd. |
200
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
RECENTLY ISSUED ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS NOT YET IMPLEMENTED
FIN 48: ACCOUNTING FOR UNCERTAINTY IN INCOME TAXESAN INTERPRETATION OF FASB STATEMENT NO. 109
FIN 48 was issued in June 2006 and is effective for the Groups annual reporting period beginning January 1, 2007. FIN 48 clarifies the accounting for uncertainty in income taxes recognized in an enterprises financial statements in accordance with FASB Statement No. 109, Accounting for Income Taxes. FIN 48 prescribes a recognition threshold and measurement attribute for the financial statement recognition and measurement of a tax position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return. FIN 48 also provides guidance on derecognition, classification, interest and penalties, accounting in interim periods, disclosure, and transition. The Group has not yet determined the impact but is currently assessing the effect of the adoption of FIN 48 on its financial position, the results of operations or cash flows of the Group under US GAAP.
FAS 157: FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS
FAS 157 was issued in September 2006 and is effective for the Groups annual reporting period beginning January 1, 2008. This statement defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value where that measurement attribute is permitted or required by other accounting pronouncements, and expands disclosures about fair value measurements. The Group will assess the impact this standard will have on future acquisitions and impairment reviews. No impact on the current financial position, the results of operations or cash flows of the Group under US GAAP is anticipated due to prospective implementation of the standard.
FAS 159: THE FAIR VALUE OPTION FOR FINANCIAL ASSETS AND FINANCIAL LIABILITIES, INCLUDING AN AMENDMENT OF FASB STATEMENT NO. 115 (FAS 159)
FAS 159 permits an entity to measure many types of financial instruments and certain other assets and liabilities at fair value on an instrument by instrument basis. This standard is effective for annual periods beginning after November 15, 2007. The Group is currently evaluating the potential impact of the adoption of FAS 159 on its consolidated financial statements.
201
ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 20-F 2006
SIGNATURES
The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this Annual Report on its behalf.
TELEFONAKTIEBOLAGET LM ERICSSON
June 7, 2007
By: |
/s/ ROLAND HAGMAN | |
Roland Hagman Vice President Group Function Financial Control | ||
By: |
/s/ CARL OLOF BLOMQVIST | |
Carl Olof Blomqvist Senior Vice President and General Counsel | ||
202